Nothing Special   »   [go: up one dir, main page]

US20110237578A1 - Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof - Google Patents

Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20110237578A1
US20110237578A1 US13/119,947 US200913119947A US2011237578A1 US 20110237578 A1 US20110237578 A1 US 20110237578A1 US 200913119947 A US200913119947 A US 200913119947A US 2011237578 A1 US2011237578 A1 US 2011237578A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
substituted
unsubstituted
methyl
canceled
alkyl
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US13/119,947
Inventor
Zhi-Liang Wei
Sumithra Gowlugari
Carl Kaub
Zhan Wang
Yeyu Cao
John Kincaid
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Evotec OAI AG
Original Assignee
Individual
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Individual filed Critical Individual
Priority to US13/119,947 priority Critical patent/US20110237578A1/en
Assigned to EVOTEC AG reassignment EVOTEC AG ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: KAUB, CARL, WANG, ZHAN, GOWLUGARI, SUMITHRA, KINCAID, JOHN, WEI, ZHI-LIANG, CAO, YEYU
Publication of US20110237578A1 publication Critical patent/US20110237578A1/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D213/00Heterocyclic compounds containing six-membered rings, not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom and three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D213/02Heterocyclic compounds containing six-membered rings, not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom and three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D213/04Heterocyclic compounds containing six-membered rings, not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom and three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having no bond between the ring nitrogen atom and a non-ring member or having only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom
    • C07D213/24Heterocyclic compounds containing six-membered rings, not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom and three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having no bond between the ring nitrogen atom and a non-ring member or having only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D213/36Radicals substituted by singly-bound nitrogen atoms
    • C07D213/40Acylated substituent nitrogen atom
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/16Amides, e.g. hydroxamic acids
    • A61K31/165Amides, e.g. hydroxamic acids having aromatic rings, e.g. colchicine, atenolol, progabide
    • A61K31/166Amides, e.g. hydroxamic acids having aromatic rings, e.g. colchicine, atenolol, progabide having the carbon of a carboxamide group directly attached to the aromatic ring, e.g. procainamide, procarbazine, metoclopramide, labetalol
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/40Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having five-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. sulpiride, succinimide, tolmetin, buflomedil
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/02Stomatological preparations, e.g. drugs for caries, aphtae, periodontitis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/12Antidiarrhoeals
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/14Prodigestives, e.g. acids, enzymes, appetite stimulants, antidyspeptics, tonics, antiflatulents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • A61P11/02Nasal agents, e.g. decongestants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • A61P11/06Antiasthmatics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • A61P11/08Bronchodilators
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P13/00Drugs for disorders of the urinary system
    • A61P13/08Drugs for disorders of the urinary system of the prostate
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P13/00Drugs for disorders of the urinary system
    • A61P13/10Drugs for disorders of the urinary system of the bladder
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P13/00Drugs for disorders of the urinary system
    • A61P13/12Drugs for disorders of the urinary system of the kidneys
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P17/00Drugs for dermatological disorders
    • A61P17/02Drugs for dermatological disorders for treating wounds, ulcers, burns, scars, keloids, or the like
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P17/00Drugs for dermatological disorders
    • A61P17/04Antipruritics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P17/00Drugs for dermatological disorders
    • A61P17/06Antipsoriatics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P19/00Drugs for skeletal disorders
    • A61P19/02Drugs for skeletal disorders for joint disorders, e.g. arthritis, arthrosis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/04Centrally acting analgesics, e.g. opioids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/06Antimigraine agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/08Antiepileptics; Anticonvulsants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/20Hypnotics; Sedatives
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/22Anxiolytics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/24Antidepressants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/28Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating neurodegenerative disorders of the central nervous system, e.g. nootropic agents, cognition enhancers, drugs for treating Alzheimer's disease or other forms of dementia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P29/00Non-central analgesic, antipyretic or antiinflammatory agents, e.g. antirheumatic agents; Non-steroidal antiinflammatory drugs [NSAID]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • A61P3/04Anorexiants; Antiobesity agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • A61P37/06Immunosuppressants, e.g. drugs for graft rejection
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/08Antiallergic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P7/00Drugs for disorders of the blood or the extracellular fluid
    • A61P7/10Antioedematous agents; Diuretics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P7/00Drugs for disorders of the blood or the extracellular fluid
    • A61P7/12Antidiuretics, e.g. drugs for diabetes insipidus
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • A61P9/10Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system for treating ischaemic or atherosclerotic diseases, e.g. antianginal drugs, coronary vasodilators, drugs for myocardial infarction, retinopathy, cerebrovascula insufficiency, renal arteriosclerosis
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07CACYCLIC OR CARBOCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07C233/00Carboxylic acid amides
    • C07C233/64Carboxylic acid amides having carbon atoms of carboxamide groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings
    • C07C233/67Carboxylic acid amides having carbon atoms of carboxamide groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings having the nitrogen atom of at least one of the carboxamide groups bound to a carbon atom of a hydrocarbon radical substituted by singly-bound oxygen atoms
    • C07C233/68Carboxylic acid amides having carbon atoms of carboxamide groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings having the nitrogen atom of at least one of the carboxamide groups bound to a carbon atom of a hydrocarbon radical substituted by singly-bound oxygen atoms with the substituted hydrocarbon radical bound to the nitrogen atom of the carboxamide group by an acyclic carbon atom
    • C07C233/69Carboxylic acid amides having carbon atoms of carboxamide groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings having the nitrogen atom of at least one of the carboxamide groups bound to a carbon atom of a hydrocarbon radical substituted by singly-bound oxygen atoms with the substituted hydrocarbon radical bound to the nitrogen atom of the carboxamide group by an acyclic carbon atom of an acyclic saturated carbon skeleton
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07CACYCLIC OR CARBOCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07C233/00Carboxylic acid amides
    • C07C233/64Carboxylic acid amides having carbon atoms of carboxamide groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings
    • C07C233/67Carboxylic acid amides having carbon atoms of carboxamide groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings having the nitrogen atom of at least one of the carboxamide groups bound to a carbon atom of a hydrocarbon radical substituted by singly-bound oxygen atoms
    • C07C233/68Carboxylic acid amides having carbon atoms of carboxamide groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings having the nitrogen atom of at least one of the carboxamide groups bound to a carbon atom of a hydrocarbon radical substituted by singly-bound oxygen atoms with the substituted hydrocarbon radical bound to the nitrogen atom of the carboxamide group by an acyclic carbon atom
    • C07C233/70Carboxylic acid amides having carbon atoms of carboxamide groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings having the nitrogen atom of at least one of the carboxamide groups bound to a carbon atom of a hydrocarbon radical substituted by singly-bound oxygen atoms with the substituted hydrocarbon radical bound to the nitrogen atom of the carboxamide group by an acyclic carbon atom of a saturated carbon skeleton containing rings
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07CACYCLIC OR CARBOCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07C255/00Carboxylic acid nitriles
    • C07C255/49Carboxylic acid nitriles having cyano groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings of a carbon skeleton
    • C07C255/57Carboxylic acid nitriles having cyano groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings of a carbon skeleton containing cyano groups and carboxyl groups, other than cyano groups, bound to the carbon skeleton
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D213/00Heterocyclic compounds containing six-membered rings, not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom and three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D213/02Heterocyclic compounds containing six-membered rings, not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom and three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D213/04Heterocyclic compounds containing six-membered rings, not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom and three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having no bond between the ring nitrogen atom and a non-ring member or having only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom
    • C07D213/24Heterocyclic compounds containing six-membered rings, not condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom and three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having three double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members having no bond between the ring nitrogen atom and a non-ring member or having only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D213/54Radicals substituted by carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals
    • C07D213/56Amides
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D227/00Heterocyclic compounds containing rings having one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom, according to more than one of groups C07D203/00 - C07D225/00
    • C07D227/02Heterocyclic compounds containing rings having one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom, according to more than one of groups C07D203/00 - C07D225/00 with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom
    • C07D227/04Heterocyclic compounds containing rings having one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom, according to more than one of groups C07D203/00 - C07D225/00 with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom with only hydrogen atoms, hydrocarbon or substituted hydrocarbon radicals, attached to ring carbon atoms
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D227/00Heterocyclic compounds containing rings having one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom, according to more than one of groups C07D203/00 - C07D225/00
    • C07D227/02Heterocyclic compounds containing rings having one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom, according to more than one of groups C07D203/00 - C07D225/00 with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom
    • C07D227/06Heterocyclic compounds containing rings having one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom, according to more than one of groups C07D203/00 - C07D225/00 with only hydrogen or carbon atoms directly attached to the ring nitrogen atom with hetero atoms or with carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals, directly attached to ring carbon atoms
    • C07D227/08Oxygen atoms
    • C07D227/087One doubly-bound oxygen atom in position 2, e.g. lactams
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D239/00Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,3-diazine or hydrogenated 1,3-diazine rings
    • C07D239/02Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,3-diazine or hydrogenated 1,3-diazine rings not condensed with other rings
    • C07D239/24Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,3-diazine or hydrogenated 1,3-diazine rings not condensed with other rings having three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
    • C07D239/26Heterocyclic compounds containing 1,3-diazine or hydrogenated 1,3-diazine rings not condensed with other rings having three or more double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members with only hydrogen atoms, hydrocarbon or substituted hydrocarbon radicals, directly attached to ring carbon atoms
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D295/00Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms
    • C07D295/04Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring nitrogen atoms
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D295/00Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms
    • C07D295/04Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring nitrogen atoms
    • C07D295/10Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring nitrogen atoms substituted by doubly bound oxygen or sulphur atoms
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D401/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom
    • C07D401/02Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom containing two hetero rings
    • C07D401/12Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom containing two hetero rings linked by a chain containing hetero atoms as chain links
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D401/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom
    • C07D401/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom containing three or more hetero rings
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D413/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms
    • C07D413/02Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms containing two hetero rings
    • C07D413/12Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms containing two hetero rings linked by a chain containing hetero atoms as chain links

Definitions

  • heterocyclic compounds and pharmaceutical compositions comprising such compounds.
  • methods for preventing and/or treating conditions in mammals such as (but not limited to) arthritis, Parkinson's disease, Alzheimer's disease, asthma, myocardial infarction, pain syndromes (acute and chronic or neuropathic), neurodegenerative disorders, schizophrenia, cognitive disorders, anxiety, depression, inflammatory bowel disease and autoimmune disorders, and promoting neuroprotection, using the compounds and pharmaceutical compositions provided herein.
  • WO 06/119504 describes fused heterocyclic compounds as P2X 3 and P2X 2/3 modulators for use in the treatment of various diseases.
  • WO04/56774 describes certain substituted biphenyl-4-carboxylic acid arylamide analogues having possible application as receptor modulators.
  • WO 08/119,773 describes amide derivatives as inhibitors of aspartyl proteases and their use in the treatment of Alzheimer's disease.
  • WO 09/058,298 and WO 09/058,299 describe benzamide derivatives as P2X 3 receptor antagonists for treatment of pain.
  • WO 05/065195 describes certain phenylamides and pyridylamides as ⁇ -secretase inhibitors.
  • WO 02/070469 describes certain substituted sulfonylalkylcarboxamides as selective pde3b inhibitors
  • WO 04/039753 describes certain benzoic acids and related compounds as EP1 receptor antagonists for the treatment of prostaglandin mediated diseases.
  • WO03/104230 describes certain bicyclic pyrimidine derivatives
  • US Published Application Serial No. 20030092908 and WO02/087513 describe fused heterocyclic PDE7 inhibitors.
  • U.S. Pat. Nos. 3,424,760 and 3,424,761 both describe a series of 3-ureidopyrrolidines that are said to exhibit analgesic, central nervous system, and pyschopharmacologic activities. These patents specifically disclose the compounds 1-(1-phenyl-3-pyrrolidinyl)-3-phenyl urea and 1-(1-phenyl-3-pyrrolidinyl)-3-(4-methoxyphenyl)urea respectively.
  • International Patent Applications, Publication Numbers WO 01/62737 and WO 00/69849 disclose a series of pyrazole derivatives which are stated to be useful in the treatment of disorders and diseases associated with the NPY receptor subtype Y5, such as obesity.
  • WO 01/62737 specifically discloses the compound 5-amino-N-isoquinolin-5-yl-1-[3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide.
  • WO 00/69849 specifically discloses the compounds 5-methyl-N-quinolin-8-yl-1-[3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, 5-methyl-N-quinolin-7-yl-1-[3-trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, 5-methyl-N-quinolin-3-yl-1-[3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, N-isoquinolin-5-yl-5-methyl-1-[3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, 5-methyl-N-quinolin-5-yl-1-[3-(trifluoromethyl)
  • German Patent Application Number 2502588 describes a series of piperazine derivatives. This application specifically discloses the compound N-[3-[2-(diethylamino)ethyl]-1,2-dihydro-4-methyl-2-oxo-7-quinolinyl]-4-phenyl-1-piperazinecarboxamide.
  • Fused heterocylic compounds, and pharmaceutical compositions thereof, having potency and selectivity in the prevention and treatment of conditions that have been associated with neurological and inflammatory disorders and dysfunctions are provided herein.
  • compounds, pharmaceutical compositions and methods provided are useful to treat, prevent or ameliorate a range of conditions in mammals such as, but not limited to, pain of various genesis or etiology, for example acute, chronic, inflammatory and neuropathic pain, dental pain and headache (such as migraine, cluster headache and tension headache).
  • compounds, pharmaceutical compositions and methods provided are useful for the treatment of inflammatory pain and associated hyperalgesia and allodynia.
  • compounds, pharmaceutical compositions and methods provided are useful for the treatment of neuropathic pain and associated hyperalgesia and allodynia (e.g.
  • compounds, pharmaceutical compositions and methods provided are useful as anti-inflammatory agents for the treatment of arthritis, and as agents to treat Parkinson's Disease, Alzheimer's Disease, asthma, myocardial infarction, neurodegenerative disorders, inflammatory bowel disease and autoimmune disorders, renal disorders, obesity, eating disorders, cancer, schizophrenia, epilepsy, sleeping disorders, cognitive disorders, depression, anxiety, blood pressure, and lipid disorders.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted aryl, or heteroaryl;
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted 4-7 membered heterocycloalkyl.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl.
  • one of A, B, and W is N; and the rest are independently selected from CR 4 .
  • each A, B, and W is independently selected from CR 4 .
  • each A, B, and W is CH.
  • the compound is according to formula 2:
  • compositions comprising a fused heterocyclic compound provided herein, and a pharmaceutical carrier, excipient or diluent.
  • the pharmaceutical composition can comprise one or more of the compounds described herein.
  • methods for preventing, treating or ameliorating a condition from among those listed herein, and particularly, such condition as may be associated with, e.g., arthritis, asthma, myocardial infarction, lipid disorders, cognitive disorders, anxiety, schizophrenia, depression, memory dysfunctions such as Alzheimers disease, inflammatory bowel disease and autoimmune disorders, which method comprises administering to a mammal in need thereof an amount of one or more of the compounds as provided herein, or pharmaceutical composition thereof, effective to prevent, treat or ameliorate the condition.
  • methods for preventing, treating or ameliorating a condition that gives rise to pain responses or that relates to imbalances in the maintenance of basal activity of sensory nerves in a mammal.
  • the compounds provided herein have use as analgesics for the treatment of pain of various geneses or etiology, for example acute, inflammatory pain (such as pain associated with osteoarthritis and rheumatoid arthritis); various neuropathic pain syndromes (such as post-herpetic neuralgia, trigeminal neuralgia, reflex sympathetic dystrophy, diabetic neuropathy, Guillian Barre syndrome, fibromyalgia, phantom limb pain, post-masectomy pain, peripheral neuropathy, HIV neuropathy, and chemotherapy-induced and other iatrogenic neuropathies); visceral pain, (such as that associated with gastroesophageal reflex disease, irritable bowel syndrome, inflammatory bowel disease, pancreatitis, and various gynecological and urological disorders), dental
  • a neurodegenerative disease or disorder can, for example, be Parkinson's disease, Alzheimer's disease and multiple sclerosis; diseases and disorders which are mediated by or result in neuroinflammation such as, for example, encephalitis; centrally-mediated neuropsychiatric diseases and disorders such as, for example, depression mania, bipolar disease, anxiety, schizophrenia, eating disorders, sleep disorders and cognition disorders; epilepsy and seizure disorders; prostate, bladder and bowel dysfunction such as, for example urinary incontinence, urinary hesitancy, rectal hypersensitivity, fecal incontinence, benign prostatic hypertrophy and inflammatory bowel disease; respiratory and airway disease and disorders such as, for example, allergic rhinitis, asthma and reactive airway disease and chronic obstructive pulmonary disease; diseases and disorders which are mediated by or result in inflammation such as, for example rheumatoid arthritis and osteoarthritis
  • the present invention extends to the use of any of the compounds of the invention for the preparation of medicaments that may be administered for such treatments, as well as to such compounds for the treatments disclosed and specified.
  • methods are provided for synthesizing the compounds described herein, with representative synthetic protocols and pathways described below.
  • provided are methods of making enantiomerically pure compounds according to formula 1 by asymmetric synthesis.
  • provided are methods of making enantiomerically pure compounds according to formula 1 by chiral resolution.
  • a still further object of this invention is to provide pharmaceutical compositions that are effective in the treatment or prevention of a variety of disease states, including the diseases associated with the central nervous system, cardiovascular conditions, chronic pulmonary obstructive disease COPD), inflammatory bowel disease, rheumatoid arthritis, osteoarthritis, and other diseases where an inflammatory component is present.
  • diseases associated with the central nervous system including the diseases associated with the central nervous system, cardiovascular conditions, chronic pulmonary obstructive disease COPD), inflammatory bowel disease, rheumatoid arthritis, osteoarthritis, and other diseases where an inflammatory component is present.
  • analogue means one analogue or more than one analogue.
  • ‘Acyl’ or ‘Alkanoyl’ refers to a radical —C(O)R 20 , where R 20 is hydrogen, C 1 -C 8 alkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkylmethyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl as defined herein.
  • Representative examples include, but are not limited to, formyl, acetyl, cyclohexylcarbonyl, cyclohexylmethylcarbonyl, benzoyl and benzylcarbonyl.
  • acyl groups are —C(O)H, —C(O)—C 1 -C 8 alkyl, —C(O)—(CH 2 ) t (C 6 -C 10 aryl), —C(O)—(CH 2 ) t (5-10 membered heteroaryl), —C(O)—(CH 2 ) t (C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), and —C(O)—(CH 2 ) t (4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4.
  • Substituted Acyl or ‘Substituted Alkanoyl’ refers to a radical —C(O)R 21 , wherein R 21 is independently
  • Acylamino refers to a radical —NR 22 C(O)R 23 , where R 22 is hydrogen, C 1 -C 8 alkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C 6 -C 10 aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl and R 23 is hydrogen, C 1 -C 8 alkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C 6 -C 10 aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl, as defined herein.
  • acylamino include, but are not limited to, formylamino, acetylamino, cyclohexylcarbonylamino, cyclohexylmethyl-carbonylamino, benzoylamino and benzylcarbonylamino.
  • Particular exemplary ‘acylamino’ groups are —NR 24 C(O)—C 1 -C 8 alkyl, —NR 24 C(O)—(CH 2 ) t (C 6 -C 10 aryl), —NR 24 C(O)—(CH 2 ) t (5-10 membered heteroaryl), —NR 24 C(O)—(CH 2 ) t (C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), and —NR 24 C(O)—(CH 2 ) t (4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4, and each R 24 independently represents H or C 1 -C 8 alkyl.
  • Substituted Acylamino refers to a radical —NR 25 C(O)R 26 , wherein:
  • R 25 is independently
  • R 26 is independently
  • R 25 and R 26 is other than H.
  • Acyloxy refers to a radical —OC(O)R 27 , where R 27 is hydrogen, C 1 -C 8 alkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkylmethyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl as defined herein.
  • Representative examples include, but are not limited to, formyl, acetyl, cyclohexylcarbonyl, cyclohexylmethylcarbonyl, benzoyl and benzylcarbonyl.
  • acyl groups are —C(O)H, —C(O)—C 1 -C 8 alkyl, —C(O)—(CH 2 ) t (C 6 -C 10 aryl), —C(O)—(CH 2 ) t (5-10 membered heteroaryl), —C(O)—(CH 2 ) t (C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), and —C(O)—(CH 2 ) t (4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4.
  • Substituted Acyloxy refers to a radical —OC(O)R 28 , wherein R 28 is independently
  • Alkoxy refers to the group —OR 29 where R 29 is C 1 -C 8 alkyl.
  • Particular alkoxy groups are methoxy, ethoxy, n-propoxy, isopropoxy, n-butoxy, tert-butoxy, sec-butoxy, n-pentoxy, n-hexoxy, and 1,2-dimethylbutoxy.
  • Particular alkoxy groups are lower alkoxy, i.e. with between 1 and 6 carbon atoms. Further particular alkoxy groups have between 1 and 4 carbon atoms.
  • Substituted alkoxy refers to an alkoxy group substituted with one or more of those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to an alkoxy group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, in particular 1 substituent, selected from the group consisting of amino, substituted amino, C 6 -C 10 aryl, aryloxy, carboxyl, cyano, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, halogen, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, hydroxyl, nitro, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thiol, alkyl-S(O)—, aryl-S(O)—, alkyl-S(O) 2 — and aryl-S(O) 2 —.
  • Exemplary ‘substituted alkoxy’ groups are —O—(CH 2 ) t (C 6 -C 10 aryl), —O—(CH 2 ) t (5-10 membered heteroaryl), —O—(CH 2 ) t (C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), and —O—(CH 2 ) t (4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4 and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • Particular exemplary ‘substituted alkoxy’ groups are OCF 3 , OCH 2 CF 3 , OCH 2 Ph, OCH 2 -cyclopropyl, OCH 2 CH 2 OH, and OCH 2 CH 2 NMe 2 .
  • Alkoxycarbonyl refers to a radical —C(O)—OR 30 where R 30 represents an C 1 -C s alkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkylalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkylalkyl, aralkyl, or 5-10 membered heteroarylalkyl as defined herein.
  • alkoxycarbonyl groups are C(O)O—C 1 -C 8 alkyl, —C(O)O—(CH 2 ) t (C 6 -C 10 aryl), —C(O)O—(CH 2 ) t (5-10 membered heteroaryl), —C(O)O—(CH 2 ) t (C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), and —C(O)O—(CH 2 ) t (4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 1 to 4.
  • Substituted Alkoxycarbonyl refers to a radical —C(O)—OR 31 where R 31 represents:
  • Aryloxycarbonyl refers to a radical —C(O)—OR 32 where R 32 represents an C 6 -C 10 aryl, as defined herein.
  • exemplary “aryloxycarbonyl” groups is —C(O)O—(C 6 -C 10 aryl).
  • Substituted Aryloxycarbonyl refers to a radical —C(O)—OR 33 where R 33 represents
  • Heteroaryloxycarbonyl refers to a radical —C(O)—OR 34 where R 34 represents a 5-10 membered heteroaryl, as defined herein.
  • An exemplary “aryloxycarbonyl” group is —C(O)O-(5-10 membered heteroaryl).
  • Substituted Heteroaryloxycarbonyl refers to a radical —C(O)—OR 35 where R 35 represents:
  • Alkoxycarbonylamino refers to the group —NR 36 C(O)OR 32 , where R 36 is hydrogen, C 1 -C 8 alkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkylmethyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl as defined herein, and R 37 is C 1 -C 8 alkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkylmethyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl as defined herein.
  • Alkyl means straight or branched aliphatic hydrocarbon having 1 to 20 carbon atoms. Particular alkyl has 1 to 12 carbon atoms. More particular is lower alkyl which has 1 to 6 carbon atoms. A further particular group has 1 to 4 carbon atoms. Exemplary straight chained groups include methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, and n-butyl. Branched means that one or more lower alkyl groups such as methyl, ethyl, propyl or butyl is attached to a linear alkyl chain, exemplary branched chain groups include isopropyl, iso-butyl, t-butyl and isoamyl.
  • Substituted alkyl refers to an alkyl group as defined above substituted with one or more of those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to an alkyl group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, in particular 1 substituent, selected from the group consisting of acyl, acylamino, acyloxy (—O-acyl or —OC(O)R 20 ), alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxycarbonylamino (—NR′′-alkoxycarbonyl or —NH—C(O)—OR 27 ), amino, substituted amino, aminocarbonyl (carbamoyl or amido or —C(O)—NR′′ 2 ), aminocarbonylamino (—NR′′—C(O)—NR′′ 2 ), aminocarbonyloxy (—O—C(O)—NR′′ 2 ), aminosulfonyl,
  • substituted alkyl refers to a C 1 -C s alkyl group substituted with halo, cyano, nitro, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, azido, —NR′′′SO 2 R′′, —SO 2 NR′′R′′′, —C(O)R′′, —C(O)OR′′, —OC(O)R′′, —NR′′′C(O)R′′, —C(O)NR′′R′′′, —NR′′R′′′, or —(CR′′′R′′′′) m OR′′′; wherein each R′′ is independently selected from H, C 1 -C 8 alkyl, —(CH 2 ) t (C 6 -C 10 aryl), —(CH 2 ) t (5-10 membered heteroaryl), —(CH 2 ) t (C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), and —(CH 2 ) t (4-10 membere
  • Alkylene refers to divalent saturated alkene radical groups having 1 to 11 carbon atoms and more particularly 1 to 6 carbon atoms which can be straight-chained or branched. This term is exemplified by groups such as methylene (—CH 2 —), ethylene (—CH 2 CH 2 —), the propylene isomers (e.g., —CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 — and —CH(CH 3 )CH 2 —) and the like.
  • Substituted alkylene refers to those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to an alkylene group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, selected from the group consisting of acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxycarbonylamino, amino, substituted amino, aminocarbonyl, amino-carbonylamino, aminocarbonyloxy, aryl, aryloxy, azido, carboxyl, cyano, halogen, hydroxyl, keto, nitro, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioketo, thiol, alkyl-S(O)—, aryl-S(O)—, alkyl-S(O) 2 — and aryl-S(O) 2 —.
  • Alkenyl refers to monovalent olefinically unsaturated hydrocarbyl groups preferably having 2 to 11 carbon atoms, particularly, from 2 to 8 carbon atoms, and more particularly, from 2 to 6 carbon atoms, which can be straight-chained or branched and having at least 1 and particularly from 1 to 2 sites of olefinic unsaturation.
  • Particular alkenyl groups include ethenyl (—CH ⁇ CH 2 ), n-propenyl (—CH 2 CH ⁇ CH 2 ), isopropenyl (—C(CH 3 ) ⁇ CH 2 ), vinyl and substituted vinyl, and the like.
  • Substituted alkenyl refers to those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to an alkenyl group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, selected from the group consisting of acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxycarbonylamino, amino, substituted amino, aminocarbonyl, aminocarbonylamino, aminocarbonyloxy, aryl, aryloxy, azido, carboxyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, substituted cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, keto, nitro, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioketo, thiol, alkyl-S(O)—, aryl-S(O)—, alkyl-S(O)
  • Alkenylene refers to divalent olefinically unsaturated hydrocarbyl groups particularly having up to about 11 carbon atoms and more particularly 2 to 6 carbon atoms which can be straight-chained or branched and having at least 1 and particularly from 1 to 2 sites of olefinic unsaturation. This term is exemplified by groups such as ethenylene (—CH ⁇ CH—), the propenylene isomers (e.g., —CH ⁇ CHCH 2 — and —C(CH 3 ) ⁇ CH— and —CH ⁇ C(CH 3 )—) and the like.
  • Alkynyl refers to acetylenically or alkynically unsaturated hydrocarbyl groups particularly having 2 to 11 carbon atoms, and more particularly 2 to 6 carbon atoms which can be straight-chained or branched and having at least 1 and particularly from 1 to 2 sites of alkynyl unsaturation.
  • alkynyl groups include acetylenic, ethynyl (—C ⁇ CH), propargyl (—CH 2 C ⁇ CH), and the like.
  • Substituted alkynyl refers to those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to an alkynyl group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, selected from the group consisting of acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxycarbonylamino, amino, substituted amino, aminocarbonyl, aminocarbonylamino, aminocarbonyloxy, aryl, aryloxy, azido, carboxyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, substituted cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, keto, nitro, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioketo, thiol, alkyl-S(O)—, aryl-S(O)—, alkyl-S
  • Amino refers to the radical —NH 2 .
  • Substituted amino refers to an amino group substituted with one or more of those groups recited in the definition of ‘substituted’ herein, and particularly refers to the group —N(R 38 ) 2 where each R 38 is independently selected from:
  • Alkylamino refers to the group —NHR 40 , wherein R 40 is C 1 -C 8 alkyl.
  • Substituted Alkylamino refers to the group —NHR 41 , wherein R 41 is C 1 -C 8 alkyl; and the alkyl group is substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, hydroxy, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C 6 -C 10 aryl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, aralkyl or heteroaralkyl; and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • Alkylarylamino refers to the group —NR 42 R 43 , wherein R 42 is aryl and R 43 is C 1 -C 8 alkyl.
  • Substituted Alkylarylamino refers to the group —NR 44 R 45 , wherein R 44 is aryl and R 45 is C 1 -C 8 alkyl; and the alkyl group is substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, hydroxy, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C 6 -C 10 aryl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, aralkyl or heteroaralkyl; and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo, cyano, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C 1 -C 4
  • Arylamino means a radical —NHR 46 where R 46 is selected from C 6 -C 10 aryl and 5-10 membered heteroaryl as defined herein.
  • Substituted Arylamino refers to the group —NHR 47 , wherein R 47 is independently selected from C 6 -C 10 aryl and 5-10 membered heteroaryl; and any aryl or heteroaryl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo, cyano, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • Dialkylamino refers to the group —NR 48 R 49 , wherein each of R 48 and R 49 are independently selected from C 1 -C 8 alkyl.
  • Substituted Dialkylamino refers to the group —NR 50 R 51 , wherein each of R 59 and R 51 are independently selected from C 1 -C 8 alkyl; and at least one of the alkyl groups is independently substituted with halo, hydroxy, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C 6 -C 10 aryl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, aralkyl or heteroaralkyl; and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C 1-4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • Diarylamino refers to the group —NR 52 R 53 , wherein each of R 52 and R 53 are independently selected from C 6 -C 10 aryl.
  • aminosulfonyl or ‘Sulfonamide’ refers to the radical —S(O 2 )NH 2 .
  • Substituted aminosulfonyl or ‘substituted sulfonamide’ refers to a radical such as —S(O 2 )N(R 54 ) 2 wherein each R 548 is independently selected from:
  • Exemplary ‘substituted aminosulfonyl’ or ‘substituted sulfonamide’ groups are —S(O 2 )N(R 55 )—C 1 -C 8 alkyl, —S(O 2 )N(R 55 )—(CH 2 ) t (C 6 -C 10 aryl), —S(O 2 )N(R 55 )—(CH 2 ) t (5-10 membered heteroaryl), —S(O 2 )N(R 55 )—(CH 2 ) t (C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), and —S(O 2 )N(R 55 )—(CH 2 ) t (4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4; each R 55 independently represents H or C 1 -C 8 alkyl; and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by
  • Aralkyl or ‘arylalkyl’ refers to an alkyl group, as defined above, substituted with one or more aryl groups, as defined above. Particular aralkyl or arylalkyl groups are alkyl groups substituted with one aryl group.
  • Substituted Aralkyl or ‘substituted arylalkyl’ refers to an alkyl group, as defined above, substituted with one or more aryl groups; and at least one of the aryl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo, cyano, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • Aryl refers to a monovalent aromatic hydrocarbon group derived by the removal of one hydrogen atom from a single carbon atom of a parent aromatic ring system.
  • aryl refers to an aromatic ring structure, mono-cyclic or poly-cyclic that includes from 5 to 12 ring members, more usually 6 to 10. Where the aryl group is a monocyclic ring system it preferentially contains 6 carbon atoms.
  • Typical aryl groups include, but are not limited to, groups derived from aceanthrylene, acenaphthylene, acephenanthrylene, anthracene, azulene, benzene, chrysene, coronene, fluoranthene, fluorene, hexacene, hexaphene, hexylene, as-indacene, s-indacene, indane, indene, naphthalene, octacene, octaphene, octalene, ovalene, penta-2,4-diene, pentacene, pentalene, pentaphene, perylene, phenalene, phenanthrene, picene, pleiadene, pyrene, pyranthrene, rubicene, triphenylene and trinaphthalene.
  • Particularly aryl groups include phenyl
  • ‘Substituted Aryl’ refers to an aryl group substituted with one or more of those groups recited in the definition of ‘substituted’ herein, and particularly refers to an aryl group that may optionally be substituted with 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, particularly 1 to 3 substituents, in particular 1 substituent. Particularly, ‘Substituted Aryl’ refers to an aryl group substituted with one or more of groups selected from halo, C 1 -C 8 alkyl, C 1 -C 8 haloalkyl, cyano, hydroxy, C 1 -C 8 alkoxy, and amino.
  • R 56 and R 57 may be hydrogen and at least one of R 56 and R 57 is each independently selected from C 1 -C 8 alkyl, C 1 -C 8 haloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, alkanoyl, C 1 -C 8 alkoxy, heteroaryloxy, alkylamino, arylamino, heteroarylamino, NR 58 COR 59 , NR 58 SOR 59 NR 58 SO 2 R 59 , COOalkyl, COOaryl, CONR 58 R 59 , CONR 58 OR 59 , NR 58 R 59 , SO 2 NR 58 R 59 , S-alkyl, SOalkyl, SO 2 alkyl, Saryl, SOaryl, SO 2 aryl; or R 56 and R 57 may be joined to form a cyclic ring (saturated or unsaturated) from 5 to 8 atoms, optionally containing one or
  • R 60 and R 61 are independently hydrogen, C 1 -C 8 alkyl, C 1 -C 4 haloalkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C 6 -C 10 aryl, substituted aryl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl.
  • Fused Aryl refers to an aryl having two of its ring carbon in common with a second aryl ring or with an aliphatic ring.
  • Arylalkyloxy refers to an —O-alkylaryl radical where alkylaryl is as defined herein.
  • Substituted Arylalkyloxy refers to an —O-alkylaryl radical where alkylaryl is as defined herein; and any aryl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo, cyano, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C 1-4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • Carbamoyl or amido refers to the radical —C(O)NH 2 .
  • Substituted Carbamoyl or substituted amido refers to the radical —C(O)N(R 62 ) 2 wherein each R 62 is independently
  • Carboxy refers to the radical —C(O)OH.
  • Cycloalkyl refers to cyclic non-aromatic hydrocarbyl groups having from 3 to 10 carbon atoms. Such cycloalkyl groups include, by way of example, single ring structures such as cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, and cyclooctyl.
  • Substituted cycloalkyl refers to a cycloalkyl group as defined above substituted with one or more of those groups recited in the definition of ‘substituted’ herein, and particularly refers to a cycloalkyl group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, in particular 1 substituent
  • Cyano refers to the radical —CN.
  • Halo or ‘halogen’ refers to fluoro (F), chloro (Cl), bromo (Br) and iodo (I). Particular halo groups are either fluoro or chloro.
  • Hetero when used to describe a compound or a group present on a compound means that one or more carbon atoms in the compound or group have been replaced by a nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur heteroatom. Hetero may be applied to any of the hydrocarbyl groups described above such as alkyl, e.g. heteroalkyl, cycloalkyl, e.g. heterocycloalkyl, aryl, e.g. heteroaryl, cycloalkenyl, e.g. cycloheteroalkenyl, and the like having from 1 to 5, and particularly from 1 to 3 heteroatoms.
  • Heteroaryl means an aromatic ring structure, mono-cyclic or polycyclic, that includes one or more heteroatoms and 5 to 12 ring members, more usually 5 to 10 ring members.
  • the heteroaryl group can be, for example, a five membered or six membered monocyclic ring or a bicyclic structure formed from fused five and six membered rings or two fused six membered rings or, by way of a further example, two fused five membered rings.
  • Each ring may contain up to four heteroatoms typically selected from nitrogen, sulphur and oxygen.
  • the heteroaryl ring will contain up to 4 heteroatoms, more typically up to 3 heteroatoms, more usually up to 2, for example a single heteroatom.
  • the heteroaryl ring contains at least one ring nitrogen atom.
  • the nitrogen atoms in the heteroaryl rings can be basic, as in the case of an imidazole or pyridine, or essentially non-basic as in the case of an indole or pyrrole nitrogen. In general the number of basic nitrogen atoms present in the heteroaryl group, including any amino group substituents of the ring, will be less than five.
  • Examples of five membered monocyclic heteroaryl groups include but are not limited to pyrrole, furan, thiophene, imidazole, furazan, oxazole, oxadiazole, oxatriazole, isoxazole, thiazole, isothiazole, pyrazole, triazole and tetrazole groups.
  • Examples of six membered monocyclic heteroaryl groups include but are not limited to pyridine, pyrazine, pyridazine, pyrimidine and triazine.
  • bicyclic heteroaryl groups containing a five membered ring fused to another five membered ring include but are not limited to imidazothiazole and imidazoimidazole.
  • bicyclic heteroaryl groups containing a six membered ring fused to a five membered ring include but are not limited to benzfuran, benzthiophene, benzimidazole, benzoxazole, isobenzoxazole, benzisoxazole, benzthiazole, benzisothiazole, isobenzofuran, indole, isoindole, isoindolone, indolizine, indoline, isoindoline, purine (e.g., adenine, guanine), indazole, pyrazolopyrimidine, triazolopyrimidine, benzodioxole and pyrazolopyridine groups.
  • bicyclic heteroaryl groups containing two fused six membered rings include but are not limited to quinoline, isoquinoline, chroman, thiochroman, chromene, isochromene, chroman, isochroman, benzodioxan, quinolizine, benzoxazine, benzodiazine, pyridopyridine, quinoxaline, quinazoline, cinnoline, phthalazine, naphthyridine and pteridine groups.
  • Particular heteroaryl groups are those derived from thiophene, pyrrole, benzothiophene, benzofuran, indole, pyridine, quinoline, imidazole, oxazole and pyrazine.
  • heteroaryls examples include the following:
  • each Y is selected from carbonyl, N, NR 65 , O and S; and R 65 is independently hydrogen, C 1 -C 8 alkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C 6 -C 10 aryl, and 5-10 membered heteroaryl.
  • Examples of representative aryl having hetero atoms containing substitution include the following:
  • each W is selected from C(R 66 ) 2 , NR 66 , O and S; and each Y is selected from carbonyl, NR 66 , O and S; and R 66 is independently hydrogen, C 1 -C 8 alkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C 6 -C 10 aryl, and 5-10 membered heteroaryl.
  • heterocycloalkyl refers to a 4-10 membered, stable heterocyclic non-aromatic ring and/or including rings containing one or more heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S, fused thereto.
  • a fused heterocyclic ring system may include carbocyclic rings and need only include one heterocyclic ring.
  • heterocyclic rings include, but are not limited to, morpholine, piperidine (e.g. 1-piperidinyl, 2-piperidinyl, 3-piperidinyl and 4-piperidinyl), pyrrolidine (e.g.
  • thiomorpholine and its S-oxide and S,S-dioxide particularly thiomorpholine
  • Still further examples include azetidine, piperidone, piperazone, and N-alkyl piperidines such as N-methyl piperidine.
  • heterocycloalkyl groups are shown in the following illustrative examples:
  • each W is selected from CR 67 , C(R 67 ) 2 , NR 67 , O and S; and each Y is selected from NR 67 , O and S; and R 67 is independently hydrogen, C 1 -C 8 alkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C 6 -C 10 aryl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl,
  • These heterocycloalkyl rings may be optionally substituted with one or more groups selected from the group consisting of acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxycarbonylamino, amino, substituted amino, aminocarbonyl (carbamoyl or amido), aminocarbonylamino, aminosulfonyl, sulfonylamino, aryl, aryloxy, azido, carboxyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxy,
  • Hydrophilicity refers to the radical —OH.
  • Niro refers to the radical —NO 2 .
  • Substituted refers to a group in which one or more hydrogen atoms are each independently replaced with the same or different substituent(s). Typical substituents may be selected from the group consisting of:
  • substituent group or groups are selected from halo, cyano, nitro, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, azido, —NR 72 SO 2 R 73 , —SO 2 NR 73 R 72 , —C(O)R 73 , —C(O)OR 73 , —OC(O)R 73 , —NR 72 C(O)R 73 , —C(O)NR 73 R 72 , —NR 73 R 72 , —(CR 72 R 72 ) m OR 72 , wherein, each R 73 is independently selected from H, C 1 -C 8 alkyl, —(CH 2 ) t (C 6 -C 10 aryl), —(CH 2 ) t (5-10 membered heteroaryl), —(CH 2 ) t (C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), and —(CH 2 ) t (4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl),
  • Substituted sulfanyl refers to the group —SR 74 , wherein R 74 is selected from:
  • Exemplary ‘substituted sulfanyl’ groups are —S—(C 1 -C 8 alkyl) and —S—(C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), —S—(CH 2 ) t (C 6 -C 10 aryl), —S—(CH 2 ) t (5-10 membered heteroaryl), —S—(CH 2 ) t (C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), and —S—(CH 2 ) t (4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4 and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4
  • substituted sulfanyl includes the groups ‘alkylsulfanyl’ or ‘alkylthio’, ‘substituted alkylthio’ or ‘substituted alkylsulfanyl’, ‘cycloalkylsulfanyl’ or ‘cycloalkylthio’, ‘substituted cycloalkylsulfanyl’ or ‘substituted cycloalkylthio’, ‘arylsulfanyl’ or ‘arylthio’ and ‘heteroarylsulfanyl’ or ‘heteroarylthio’ as defined below.
  • Alkylthio or ‘Alkylsulfanyl’ refers to a radical —SR 75 where R 75 is a C 1 -C 8 alkyl or group as defined herein. Representative examples include, but are not limited to, methylthio, ethylthio, propylthio and butylthio.
  • Substituted Alkylthio or ‘substituted alkylsulfanyl’ refers to the group —SR 76 where R 76 is a C 1 -C 8 alkyl, substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy.
  • Cycloalkylthio or ‘Cycloalkylsulfanyl’ refers to a radical —SR 77 where R 77 is a C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl or group as defined herein. Representative examples include, but are not limited to, cyclopropylthio, cyclohexylthio, and cyclopentylthio.
  • Substituted cycloalkylthio or ‘substituted cycloalkylsulfanyl’ refers to the group —SR 78 where R 78 is a C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy.
  • Arylthio or ‘Arylsulfanyl’ refers to a radical —SR 79 where R 79 is a C 6 -C 10 aryl group as defined herein.
  • Heteroarylthio or ‘Heteroarylsulfanyl’ refers to a radical —SR 80 where R 80 is a 5-10 membered heteroaryl group as defined herein.
  • Substituted sulfinyl refers to the group —S(O)R 81 , wherein R 81 is selected from:
  • Exemplary ‘substituted sulfinyl’ groups are —S(O)—(C 1 -C 8 alkyl) and —S(O)—(C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), —S(O)—(CH 2 ) t (C 6 -C 10 aryl), —S(O)—(CH 2 ) t (5-10 membered heteroaryl), —S(O)—(CH 2 ) t (C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), and —S(O)—(CH 2 ) t (4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4 and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4
  • substituted sulfinyl includes the groups ‘alkylsulfinyl’, ‘substituted alkylsulfinyl’, ‘cycloalkylsulfinyl’, ‘substituted cycloalkylsulfinyl’, ‘arylsulfinyl’ and ‘heteroarylsulfinyl’ as defined herein.
  • Alkylsulfinyl refers to a radical —S(O)R 82 where R 82 is a C 1 -C 8 alkyl group as defined herein. Representative examples include, but are not limited to, methylsulfinyl, ethylsulfinyl, propylsulfinyl and butylsulfinyl.
  • Substituted Alkylsulfinyl refers to a radical —S(O)R 83 where R 83 is a C 1 -C 8 alkyl group as defined herein, substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy.
  • Cycloalkylsulfinyl refers to a radical —S(O)R 84 where R 84 is a C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl or group as defined herein. Representative examples include, but are not limited to, cyclopropylsulfinyl, cyclohexylsulfinyl, and cyclopentylsulfinyl. Exemplary ‘cycloalkylsulfinyl’ groups are S(O)—C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl.
  • Substituted cycloalkylsulfinyl refers to the group —S(O)R 85 where R 85 is a C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy.
  • Arylsulfinyl refers to a radical —S(O)R 86 where R 86 is a C 6 -C 10 aryl group as defined herein.
  • Heteroarylsulfinyl refers to a radical —S(O)R 87 where R 87 is a 5-10 membered heteroaryl group as defined herein.
  • Substituted sulfonyl refers to the group —S(O) 2 R 88 , wherein R 88 is selected from:
  • Exemplary ‘substituted sulfonyl’ groups are —S(O) 2 —(C 1 -C 8 alkyl) and —S(O) 2 —(C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), —S(O) 2 —(CH 2 ) t (C 6 -C 10 aryl), —S(O) 2 —(CH 2 ) t (5-10 membered heteroaryl), —S(O) 2 —(CH 2 ) t (C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), and —S(O) 2 —(CH 2 ) t (4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4 and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkoxy, un
  • substituted sulfonyl includes the groups alkylsulfonyl, substituted alkylsulfonyl, cycloalkylsulfonyl, substituted cycloalkylsulfonyl, arylsulfonyl and heteroarylsulfonyl.
  • Alkylsulfonyl refers to a radical —S(O) 2 R 89 where R 89 is an C 1 -C 8 alkyl group as defined herein. Representative examples include, but are not limited to, methylsulfonyl, ethylsulfonyl, propylsulfonyl and butylsulfonyl.
  • Substituted Alkylsulfonyl refers to a radical —S(O) 2 R 90 where R 90 is an C 1 -C 8 alkyl group as defined herein, substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy.
  • Cycloalkylsulfonyl refers to a radical —S(O) 2 R 91 where R 90 is a C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl or group as defined herein.
  • Representative examples include, but are not limited to, cyclopropylsulfonyl, cyclohexylsulfonyl, and cyclopentylsulfonyl.
  • Substituted cycloalkylsulfonyl refers to the group —S(O) 2 R 92 where R 92 is a C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy.
  • Arylsulfonyl refers to a radical —S(O) 2 R 93 where R 93 is an C 6 -C 10 aryl group as defined herein.
  • Heteroarylsulfonyl refers to a radical —S(O) 2 R 94 where R 94 is an 5-10 membered heteroaryl group as defined herein.
  • “Sulfo’ or ‘sulfonic acid’ refers to a radical such as —SO 3 H.
  • Substituted sulfo or ‘sulfonic acid ester’ refers to the group —S(O) 2 OR 95 , wherein R 95 is selected from:
  • Exemplary ‘Substituted sulfo’ or ‘sulfonic acid ester’ groups are —S(O) 2 —O—(C 1 -C 8 alkyl) and —S(O) 2 —O—(C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), —S(O) 2 —O—(CH 2 ) t (C 6 -C 10 aryl), —S(O) 2 —O—(CH 2 ) t (5-10 membered heteroaryl), —S(O) 2 —O—(CH 2 ) t (C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl), and —S(O) 2 —O—(CH 2 ) t (4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4 and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C 1 -C 4 alkyl,
  • Thiol refers to the group —SH.
  • Aminocarbonylamino refers to the group —NR 96 C(O)NR 96 R 96 where each R 96 is independently hydrogen C 1 -C 3 alkyl, C 3 -C 10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C 6 -C 10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, and heteroaralkyl, as defined herein; or where two R 96 groups, when attached to the same N, are joined to form an alkylene group.
  • Bicycloaryl refers to a monovalent aromatic hydrocarbon group derived by the removal of one hydrogen atom from a single carbon atom of a parent bicycloaromatic ring system.
  • Typical bicycloaryl groups include, but are not limited to, groups derived from indane, indene, naphthalene, tetrahydronaphthalene, and the like. Particularly, an aryl group comprises from 8 to 11 carbon atoms.
  • Bicycloheteroaryl refers to a monovalent bicycloheteroaromatic group derived by the removal of one hydrogen atom from a single atom of a parent bicycloheteroaromatic ring system.
  • Typical bicycloheteroaryl groups include, but are not limited to, groups derived from benzofuran, benzimidazole, benzindazole, benzdioxane, chromene, chromane, cinnoline, phthalazine, indole, indoline, indolizine, isobenzofuran, isochromene, isoindole, isoindoline, isoquinoline, benzothiazole, benzoxazole, naphthyridine, benzoxadiazole, pteridine, purine, benzopyran, benzpyrazine, pyridopyrimidine, quinazoline, quinoline, quinolizine, quinoxaline
  • the bicycloheteroaryl group is between 9-11 membered bicycloheteroaryl, with 5-10 membered heteroaryl being particularly preferred.
  • Particular bicycloheteroaryl groups are those derived from benzothiophene, benzofuran, benzothiazole, indole, quinoline, isoquinoline, benzimidazole, benzoxazole and benzdioxane.
  • Cycloalkylalkyl refers to a radical in which a cycloalkyl group is substituted for a hydrogen atom of an alkyl group.
  • Typical cycloalkylalkyl groups include, but are not limited to, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, cyclohexylmethyl, cycloheptylmethyl, cyclooctylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, cyclobutylethyl, cyclopentylethyl, cyclohexylethyl, cycloheptylethyl, and cyclooctylethyl, and the like.
  • Heterocycloalkylalkyl refers to a radical in which a heterocycloalkyl group is substituted for a hydrogen atom of an alkyl group.
  • Typical heterocycloalkylalkyl groups include, but are not limited to, pyrrolidinylmethyl, piperidinylmethyl, piperazinylmethyl, morpholinylmethyl, pyrrolidinylethyl, piperidinylethyl, piperazinylethyl, morpholinylethyl, and the like.
  • Cycloalkenyl refers to cyclic hydrocarbyl groups having from 3 to 10 carbon atoms and having a single cyclic ring or multiple condensed rings, including fused and bridged ring systems and having at least one and particularly from 1 to 2 sites of olefinic unsaturation.
  • Such cycloalkenyl groups include, by way of example, single ring structures such as cyclohexenyl, cyclopentenyl, cyclopropenyl, and the like.
  • Substituted cycloalkenyl refers to those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to a cycloalkenyl group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, selected from the group consisting of acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxycarbonylamino, amino, substituted amino, aminocarbonyl, aminocarbonylamino, aminocarbonyloxy, aryl, aryloxy, azido, carboxyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, substituted cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, keto, nitro, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioketo, thiol, alkyl-S(O)—, aryl-S(O)—,
  • Fused Cycloalkenyl refers to a cycloalkenyl having two of its ring carbon atoms in common with a second aliphatic or aromatic ring and having its olefinic unsaturation located to impart aromaticity to the cycloalkenyl ring.
  • Ethenyl refers to substituted or unsubstituted —(C ⁇ C)—.
  • Ethylene refers to substituted or unsubstituted —(C—C)—.
  • ‘Hydrogen bond donor’ group refers to a group containing O—H, or N—H functionality.
  • Examples of ‘hydrogen bond donor’ groups include —OH, —NH 2 , and —NH—R 97 and wherein R 97 is alkyl, acyl, cycloalkyl, aryl, or heteroaryl.
  • Dihydroxyphosphoryl refers to the radical —PO(OH) 2 .
  • Substituted dihydroxyphosphoryl refers to those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to a dihydroxyphosphoryl radical wherein one or both of the hydroxyl groups are substituted. Suitable substituents are described in detail below.
  • Aminohydroxyphosphoryl refers to the radical —PO(OH)NH 2 .
  • Substituted aminohydroxyphosphoryl refers to those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to an aminohydroxyphosphoryl wherein the amino group is substituted with one or two substituents. Suitable substituents are described in detail below. In certain embodiments, the hydroxyl group can also be substituted.
  • ‘Nitrogen-Containing Heterocycloalkyl’ group means a 4 to 7 membered non-aromatic cyclic group containing at least one nitrogen atom, for example, but without limitation, morpholine, piperidine (e.g. 2-piperidinyl, 3-piperidinyl and 4-piperidinyl), pyrrolidine (e.g. 2-pyrrolidinyl and 3-pyrrolidinyl), azetidine, pyrrolidone, imidazoline, imidazolidinone, 2-pyrazoline, pyrazolidine, piperazine, and N-alkyl piperazines such as N-methyl piperazine. Particular examples include azetidine, piperidone and piperazone.
  • Thioketo refers to the group ⁇ S.
  • heterocyclic ring may have one to four heteroatoms so long as the heteroaromatic ring is chemically feasible and stable.
  • ‘Pharmaceutically acceptable’ means approved or approvable by a regulatory agency of the Federal or a state government or the corresponding agency in countries other than the United States, or that is listed in the U.S. Pharmacopoeia or other generally recognized pharmacopoeia for use in animals; and more particularly, in humans.
  • ‘Pharmaceutically acceptable salt’ refers to a salt of a compound of the invention that is pharmaceutically acceptable and that possesses the desired pharmacological activity of the parent compound.
  • such salts are non-toxic may be inorganic or organic acid addition salts and base addition salts.
  • such salts include: (1) acid addition salts, formed with inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, nitric acid, phosphoric acid, and the like; or formed with organic acids such as acetic acid, propionic acid, hexanoic acid, cyclopentanepropionic acid, glycolic acid, pyruvic acid, lactic acid, malonic acid, succinic acid, malic acid, maleic acid, fumaric acid, tartaric acid, citric acid, benzoic acid, 3-(4-hydroxybenzoyl)benzoic acid, cinnamic acid, mandelic acid, methanesulfonic acid, ethanesulfonic acid, 1,2-ethane-disulfonic acid, 2-hydroxyethanesulfonic acid, benzenesulfonic acid, 4-chlorobenzenesulfonic acid, 2-naphthalenesulfonic acid, 4-toluenesulfonic acid
  • Salts further include, by way of example only, sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, ammonium, tetraalkylammonium, and the like; and when the compound contains a basic functionality, salts of non toxic organic or inorganic acids, such as hydrochloride, hydrobromide, tartrate, mesylate, acetate, maleate, oxalate and the like.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable cation refers to an acceptable cationic counter-ion of an acidic functional group. Such cations are exemplified by sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, ammonium, tetraalkylammonium cations, and the like.
  • ‘Pharmaceutically acceptable vehicle’ refers to a diluent, adjuvant, excipient or carrier with which a compound of the invention is administered.
  • Prodrugs refers to compounds, including derivatives of the compounds of the invention, which have cleavable groups and become by solvolysis or under physiological conditions the compounds of the invention which are pharmaceutically active in vivo. Such examples include, but are not limited to, choline ester derivatives and the like, N-alkylmorpholine esters and the like.
  • Solvate refers to forms of the compound that are associated with a solvent, usually by a solvolysis reaction. This physical association includes hydrogen bonding.
  • Conventional solvents include water, ethanol, acetic acid and the like.
  • the compounds of the invention may be prepared e.g. in crystalline form and may be solvated or hydrated.
  • Suitable solvates include pharmaceutically acceptable solvates, such as hydrates, and further include both stoichiometric solvates and non-stoichiometric solvates. In certain instances the solvate will be capable of isolation, for example when one or more solvent molecules are incorporated in the crystal lattice of the crystalline solid.
  • ‘Solvate’ encompasses both solution-phase and isolable solvates.
  • Representative solvates include hydrates, ethanolates and methanolates.
  • Subject includes humans.
  • the terms ‘human’, ‘patient’ and ‘subject’ are used interchangeably herein.
  • “Therapeutically effective amount’ means the amount of a compound that, when administered to a subject for treating a disease, is sufficient to effect such treatment for the disease.
  • the “therapeutically effective amount” can vary depending on the compound, the disease and its severity, and the age, weight, etc., of the subject to be treated.
  • Preventing refers to a reduction in risk of acquiring or developing a disease or disorder (i.e., causing at least one of the clinical symptoms of the disease not to develop in a subject that may be exposed to a disease-causing agent, or predisposed to the disease in advance of disease onset.
  • prophylaxis is related to ‘prevention’, and refers to a measure or procedure the purpose of which is to prevent, rather than to treat or cure a disease.
  • prophylactic measures may include the administration of vaccines; the administration of low molecular weight heparin to hospital patients at risk for thrombosis due, for example, to immobilization; and the administration of an anti-malarial agent such as chloroquine, in advance of a visit to a geographical region where malaria is endemic or the risk of contracting malaria is high.
  • Treating’ or ‘treatment’ of any disease or disorder refers, in one embodiment, to ameliorating the disease or disorder (i.e., arresting the disease or reducing the manifestation, extent or severity of at least one of the clinical symptoms thereof). In another embodiment ‘treating’ or ‘treatment’ refers to ameliorating at least one physical parameter, which may not be discernible by the subject. In yet another embodiment, ‘treating’ or ‘treatment’ refers to modulating the disease or disorder, either physically, (e.g., stabilization of a discernible symptom), physiologically, (e.g., stabilization of a physical parameter), or both. In a further embodiment, “treating” or “treatment” relates to slowing the progression of the disease.
  • Prodrugs include acid derivatives well know to practitioners of the art, such as, for example, esters prepared by reaction of the parent acid with a suitable alcohol, or amides prepared by reaction of the parent acid compound with a substituted or unsubstituted amine, or acid anhydrides, or mixed anhydrides. Simple aliphatic or aromatic esters, amides and anhydrides derived from acidic groups pendant on the compounds of this invention are particular prodrugs.
  • double ester type prodrugs such as (acyloxy)alkyl esters or ((alkoxycarbonyl)oxy)alkylesters.
  • double ester type prodrugs such as (acyloxy)alkyl esters or ((alkoxycarbonyl)oxy)alkylesters.
  • an ‘isotopic variant’ of a compound can contain one or more non-radioactive isotopes, such as for example, deuterium ( 2 H or D), carbon-13 ( 13 C), nitrogen-15 ( 15 N), or the like.
  • non-radioactive isotopes such as for example, deuterium ( 2 H or D), carbon-13 ( 13 C), nitrogen-15 ( 15 N), or the like.
  • the invention may include the preparation of isotopic variants with radioisotopes, in the instance for example, where the resulting compounds may be used for drug and/or substrate tissue distribution studies.
  • the radioactive isotopes tritium, i.e. 3 H, and carbon-14, i.e. 14 C, are particularly useful for this purpose in view of their ease of incorporation and ready means of detection.
  • compounds may be prepared that are substituted with positron emitting isotopes, such as 11 C, 18 F, 15 O, and 13 N, and would be useful in Positron Emission Topography (PET) studies for examining substrate receptor occupancy.
  • PET Positron Emission Topography
  • stereoisomers that are not mirror images of one another are termed ‘diastereomers’ and those that are non-superimposable mirror images of each other are termed ‘enantiomers’.
  • enantiomers When a compound has an asymmetric center, for example, it is bonded to four different groups, a pair of enantiomers is possible.
  • An enantiomer can be characterized by the absolute configuration of its asymmetric center and is described by the R- and S-sequencing rules of Cahn and Prelog, or by the manner in which the molecule rotates the plane of polarized light and designated as dextrorotatory or levorotatory (i.e., as (+) or ( ⁇ )-isomers respectively).
  • a chiral compound can exist as either individual enantiomer or as a mixture thereof. A mixture containing equal proportions of the enantiomers is called a ‘racemic mixture’.
  • Tautomers refer to compounds that are interchangeable forms of a particular compound structure, and that vary in the displacement of hydrogen atoms and electrons. Thus, two structures may be in equilibrium through the movement of ⁇ electrons and an atom (usually H). For example, enols and ketones are tautomers because they are rapidly interconverted by treatment with either acid or base. Another example of tautomerism is the aci- and nitro-forms of phenylnitromethane, that are likewise formed by treatment with acid or base.
  • Tautomeric forms may be relevant to the attainment of the optimal chemical reactivity and biological activity of a compound of interest.
  • a pure enantiomeric compound is substantially free from other enantiomers or stereoisomers of the compound (i.e., in enantiomeric excess).
  • an “S” form of the compound is substantially free from the “R” form of the compound and is, thus, in enantiomeric excess of the “R” form.
  • enantiomerically pure or “pure enantiomer” denotes that the compound comprises more than 75% by weight, more than 80% by weight, more than 85% by weight, more than 90% by weight, more than 91% by weight, more than 92% by weight, more than 93% by weight, more than 94% by weight, more than 95% by weight, more than 96% by weight, more than 97% by weight, more than 98% by weight, more than 98.5% by weight, more than 99% by weight, more than 99.2% by weight, more than 99.5% by weight, more than 99.6% by weight, more than 99.7% by weight, more than 99.8% by weight or more than 99.9% by weight, of the enantiomer.
  • the weights are based upon total weight of all enantiomers or stereoisomers of the compound.
  • the term “enantiomerically pure R-compound” refers to at least about 80% by weight R-compound and at most about 20% by weight S-compound, at least about 90% by weight R-compound and at most about 10% by weight S-compound, at least about 95% by weight R-compound and at most about 5% by weight S-compound, at least about 99% by weight R-compound and at most about 1% by weight S-compound, at least about 99.9% by weight R-compound or at most about 0.1% by weight S-compound.
  • the weights are based upon total weight of compound.
  • the term “enantiomerically pure S-compound” or “S-compound” refers to at least about 80% by weight S-compound and at most about 20% by weight R-compound, at least about 90% by weight S-compound and at most about 10% by weight R-compound, at least about 95% by weight S-compound and at most about 5% by weight R-compound, at least about 99% by weight S-compound and at most about 1% by weight R-compound or at least about 99.9% by weight S-compound and at most about 0.1% by weight R-compound.
  • the weights are based upon total weight of compound.
  • an enantiomerically pure compound or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, hydrate or prodrug thereof can be present with other active or inactive ingredients.
  • a pharmaceutical composition comprising enantiomerically pure R-compound can comprise, for example, about 90% excipient and about 10% enantiomerically pure R-compound.
  • the enantiomerically pure R-compound in such compositions can, for example, comprise, at least about 95% by weight R-compound and at most about 5% by weight S-compound, by total weight of the compound.
  • a pharmaceutical composition comprising enantiomerically pure S-compound can comprise, for example, about 90% excipient and about 10% enantiomerically pure S-compound.
  • the enantiomerically pure S-compound in such compositions can, for example, comprise, at least about 95% by weight S-compound and at most about 5% by weight R-compound, by total weight of the compound.
  • the active ingredient can be formulated with little or no excipient or carrier.
  • the compounds of this invention may possess one or more asymmetric centers; such compounds can therefore be produced as individual (R)- or (S)-stereoisomers or as mixtures thereof. Unless indicated otherwise, the description or naming of a particular compound in the specification and claims is intended to include both individual enantiomers and mixtures, racemic or otherwise, thereof. The methods for the determination of stereochemistry and the separation of stereoisomers are well-known in the art.
  • provided herein are compounds useful for preventing and/or treating a broad range of conditions, among them, arthritis, Parkinson's disease, Alzheimer's disease, stroke, uveitis, asthma, myocardial infarction, the treatment and prophylaxis of pain syndromes (acute and chronic or neuropathic), traumatic brain injury, acute spinal cord injury, neurodegenerative disorders, alopecia (hair loss), inflammatory bowel disease and autoimmune disorders or conditions in mammals.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted 4-7 membered heterocycloalkyl.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl.
  • R 4 is other than hydroxy, alkoxy, aryloxy, or heteroaryloxy.
  • the invention does not include compounds wherein R 4 is hydroxy, alkoxy, aryloxy, or heteroaryloxy.
  • one of A, B, and W is N; and the rest are independently selected from CR 4 .
  • each A, B, and W is independently selected from CR 4 .
  • each A, B, and W is CH.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted 4-7 membered heterocycloalkyl
  • the compound is according to formula 2:
  • L is selected from —CH 2 —, —CHMe-, —CMe 2 -, —(CH 2 ) 2 —, —CMe 2 -CH 2 —, —(CH 2 ) 3 —, —(CH 2 ) 4 —, —CH(CH 3 )CH 2 —, —(CH 2 ) 2 SCH 2 —, —(CH 2 ) 2 —SO 2 CH 2 —, —CH(CH 2 CH 3 )CH 2 OCH 2 —, —CH 2 CHF—, —CH 2 CF 2 —, —CH 2 CH(OH)—, —CH(CH 2 OH)—, —CH(CH 2 CH 2 OH)—, and —CH 2 CO—.
  • L is selected from —CH 2 —, —CHMe-, —CMe 2 -, —(CH 2 ) 2 —, —CMe 2 -CH 2 —)—, —CH(CH 2 OH)—, —CH(CH 2 CH 2 OH)—, and —(CH 2 ) 3 —.
  • L is selected from —CH 2 —, —(CH 2 ) 2 —, —CHMe-, and —C(Me)H—CH 2 —.
  • each R 4a , and R 4b is independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyloxy, substituted or unsubstituted amino, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsub
  • L is selected from —CH 2 —, —CHMe-, —CMe 2 -, —(CH 2 ) 2 —, —CMe 2 -CH 2 —, —(CH 2 ) 3 —, —(CH 2 ) 4 —, —CH(CH 3 )CH 2 —, —(CH 2 ) 2 SCH 2 —, —(CH 2 ) 2 —SO 2 CH 2 —, —CH(CH 2 CH 3 ) CH 2 OCH 2 —, —CH 2 CHF—, —CH 2 CF 2 —, —CH 2 CH(OH)—, —CH(CH 2 OH)—, —CH(CH 2 CH 2 OH)—, and —CH 2 CO—.
  • L is selected from —CH 2 —, —CHMe-, —(CH 2 ) 2 —, —CMe 2 -CH 2 —)—, —CH(CH 2 OH)—, —CH(CH 2 CH 2 OH)—, and —(CH 2 ) 3 —.
  • L is selected from —CH 2 —, and —CHMe-.
  • R 3 is substituted or unsubstituted azetidine, pyrrolidine, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl.
  • R 3 is azetidine, pyrrolidine, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 3 is azetidine, pyrrolidine, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • R 3 is
  • R 3a is independently selected from hydrogen, or substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.
  • the compound is according to formula 3aa, 4aa, 5aa, 6aa, 7aa, or 8aa:
  • m′ is 1, 2 or 3.
  • the compound is according to formula 9aa, 10aa, 11aa, 12aa, 13aa, or 14aa:
  • R 3a is H or alkyl.
  • R 3a is H, Me, Et, or i-Pr.
  • X′ is CR 4a .
  • X′ is N.
  • X′ is CR 4a ; and R 4a is independently H, C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo C 1 -C 4 alkyl, CN, NO 2 , or halo.
  • X′ is CR 4a ; and R 4a is H, Me, CF 3 , Cl, F, CN or NO 2 .
  • X′ is CR 4a ; and R 4a is Cl or CN.
  • R 4b is H, C 1 -C 4 alkyl or halo C 1 -C 4 alkyl or halo.
  • R 4b is H, Me, CF 3 , Cl or F.
  • each of R 2a and R 2b is hydrogen.
  • one of R 2a and R 2b is methyl, hydroxymethyl or hydroxyethyl.
  • each of R 2a and R 2b is methyl.
  • R 2a and R 2b join together to form a cycloalkyl ring.
  • R 2a and R 2b join together to form a cyclopropyl ring.
  • R 2a is selected from Me, Et, n-Pr, t-Bu, CF 3 , CH 2 OH, CH 2 CH 2 OH, CH 2 CH 2 OAc, CH 2 (CH 2 ) 2 OH, CH 2 CH 2 NHMe, CH 2 NMe 2 , CH 2 CH 2 NMe 2 , CH 2 CONH 2 , CH 2 CONMe 2 , CH 2 COOH, CH 2 CH 2 COOH, CH 2 (CH 2 ) 2 COOH, CH 2 OMe, and CH 2 CH 2 OMe; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is selected from CH 2 NR 2′ R 2′′ , CH 2 CH 2 NR 2′ R 2′′ , CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 NR 2′ R 2′′ and wherein R 2′ and R 2′′ can join together to form a heterocyclic ring; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is selected from cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl or cyclohexyl; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is CH 2 OH or CH 2 CH 2 OH; and R 2b is H.
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.
  • R 1 is Me, Et, i-Pr, or t-Bu.
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted aryl or heteroaryl.
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted bicycloaryl, bicycloalkyl, or bicycloheteroaryl.
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted phenyl.
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted pyridyl, pyrimidinyl or pyrazinyl.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, methylenedioxyphenyl, imidazopyridyl, benzoxazolyl, and indolyl.
  • R 1 is
  • each R 5b is independently selected from hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, aryloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, substituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, arylalkyloxy, substituted arylalkyloxy, amino, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted sulfinyl, substituted or unsubstituted sulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted
  • R 1 is as described above and the subscript n2 is 1, 2 or 3.
  • R 1 is as described above and the subscript n2 is 1 or 2.
  • R 1 is
  • each R 5b is independently selected from H, alkyl, halo, cyano, alkoxy, and haloalkyl.
  • R 1 is as described above and each R 5b is independently selected from H, Me, Et, Pr, iso-Pr, Ph, Cl, F, Br, CN, OH, OMe, OEt, OPh, COPh, CO 2 Me, CH 2 —N-morpholino, CH 2 —N-(4-Me-piperidino), NH 2 , CONH 2 , CF 3 , CHF 2 , OCF 3 , OCHF 2 , t-Bu, SMe, CH ⁇ CH—CO 2 H, SOMe, SO 2 Me, SO 2 CF 3 , SO 2 NH2, SO 3 H, SO 3 Me, cyclopropyl, triazolyl, morpholinyl, and pyridyl.
  • each R 5b is independently selected from H, Cl, F, Me, or CF 3 .
  • the compound is selected from the group consisting of
  • R 3 is substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered aryl.
  • R 3 is substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered heteroaryl.
  • the invention does not include 5 membered heteroaryls, for example pyrrolyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, oxazolyl, thiazolyl and the like.
  • R 3 is substituted or unsubstituted bicycloaryl, bicycloalkyl, or bicycloheteroaryl.
  • R 3 is substituted or unsubstituted phenyl.
  • R 3 is substituted or unsubstituted pyridyl, pyrazinyl or unsubstituted pyrimidinyl.
  • R 3 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, methylenedioxyphenyl, imidazopyridyl, benzoxazolyl, and indolyl.
  • R 3 is
  • R 1 is unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.
  • R 1 substituted heterocycloalkyl
  • R 1 is heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 1 is heterocycloalkyl, substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted aryl, and heteroaryl; or
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted aryl, and heteroaryl; or
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl
  • the compound is according to formulae 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, or 11:
  • n2 0.
  • n2 is 1.
  • each R 4a is independently H, C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo C 1 -C 4 alkyl, CN, NO 2 , or halo.
  • each R 4a is H, Me, CF 3 , Cl, F, CN or NO 2 .
  • R 4a is Cl or CN.
  • R 4b is H, C 1 -C 4 alkyl or halo C 1 -C 4 alkyl or halo.
  • R 4b is H, Me, CF 3 , Cl or F.
  • subscript n1 is 1, 2 or 3.
  • subscript n1 is 1 or 2.
  • subscript n1 is 1.
  • each R 5a is independently selected from H, alkyl, halo, cyano, alkoxy, and haloalkyl.
  • each R 5a is independently selected from H, Me, Et, Pr, iso-Pr, Ph, Cl, F, Br, CN, OH, OMe, OEt, OPh, COPh, CO 2 Me, CH 2 —N-morpholino, CH 2 —N-(4-Me-piperidino), NH 2 , CONH 2 , CF 3 , CHF 2 , OCF 3 , OCHF 2 , t-Bu, SMe, CH ⁇ CH—CO 2 H, SOMe, SO 2 Me, SO 2 CF 3 , SO 2 NH 2 , SO 3 H, SO 3 Me, cyclopropyl, triazolyl, morpholinyl, and pyridyl.
  • each R 5a is independently selected from H, Cl, F, Me, or CF 3 .
  • each R 5a is H.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted aryl, and heteroaryl.
  • R 1 is selected from alkyl, and hydroxyalkyl; or R 1 is heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 1 is heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 1 is other than aryl or heteroaryl.
  • R 1 is unsubstituted aryl or heteroaryl.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, aryl, and heteroaryl.
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.
  • R 1 is alkyl
  • R 1 is hydroxyalkyl
  • R 1 is unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.
  • R 1 is heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, haloalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 1 is heterocycloalkyl, substituted with one or more groups selected from alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, and dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 1 is heterocycloalkyl, substituted with alkylsulfonylalkyl.
  • each of R 2a and R 2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C 2 -C 4 alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, and halo. In another embodiment, each of R 2a and R 2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C 2 -C 4 alkyl, and hydroxyalkyl.
  • R 2a and R 2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms.
  • R 2a and R 2b join together to form a cycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms.
  • R 2a and R 2b join together to form a cyclopropyl ring.
  • n2 is 1; and R 1 is unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.
  • n2 is 1; and R 1 substituted heterocycloalkyl.
  • the subscript n2 is 1; and R 1 is heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 1 is heterocycloalkyl, substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • R 1 is selected from morpholinyl, and 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl.
  • the subscript n2 is 1; and R 1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • the subscript n2 is 1; and R 1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with alkyl.
  • n2 is 1; and R 1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • n2 is 1; and R 1 is selected from morpholinyl, and 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl.
  • R 3 is unsubstituted N containing heterocycloalkyl; and the heterocycloalkyl is attached to the core group via the N.
  • R 3 is N containing heterocycloalkyl, substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo; and the heterocycloalkyl is attached to the core group via the N.
  • R 3 is N containing heterocycloalkyl, substituted with one or more groups selected from hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 3 is N containing heterocycloalkyl, substituted with hydroxyalkyl.
  • R 3 is N containing heterocycloalkyl, substituted with oxo.
  • R 3 is unsubstituted azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl.
  • R 3 is azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 3 is azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl, substituted with one or more groups selected from hydroxyalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 3 is azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • R 3 is azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl, substituted with hydroxyalkyl.
  • R 3 is
  • the compound is according to formula 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, or 17:
  • the subscript m′ is 1, 2 or 3.
  • the compound is according to formulae 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, or 23:
  • each of R 2a and R 2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C 1 -C 4 alkyl, and halo. In another embodiment, each of R 2a and R 2b is independently selected from hydrogen, and C 1 -C 4 alkyl.
  • R 2a and R 2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms.
  • R 2a and R 2b join together to form a cycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms.
  • each of R 2a and R 2b is hydrogen.
  • one of R 2a and R 2b is hydrogen.
  • one of R 2a and R 2b is methyl, hydroxymethyl or hydroxyethyl.
  • each of R 2a and R 2b is methyl.
  • R 2a and R 2b join together to form a cycloalkyl ring.
  • R 2a and R 2b join together to form a cyclopropyl ring.
  • R 2a is selected from Me, Et, n-Pr, t-Bu, CF 3 , CH 2 OH, CH 2 CH 2 OH, CH 2 (CH 2 ) 2 OH, CH 2 CH 2 NHMe, CH 2 NMe 2 , CH 2 CH 2 NMe 2 , CH 2 OMe, and CH 2 CH 2 OMe; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is selected from Me, Et, n-Pr, t-Bu; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is selected from CH 2 OH, CH 2 CH 2 OH, CH 2 (CH 2 ) 2 OH, CH 2 OMe, and CH 2 CH 2 OMe; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is selected from CF 3 , and CH 2 CF 3 ; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is selected from CH 2 NR 2′ R 2′′ , CH 2 CH 2 NR 2′ R 2′′ , CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 NR 2′ R 2′′ and wherein R 2′ and R 2′′ can join together to form a heterocyclic ring; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is selected from cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl or cyclohexyl; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is CH 2 OH or CH 2 CH 2 OH; and R 2b is H.
  • n2 is 1.
  • R 3a is H or alkyl.
  • R 3a is H, Me, Et, or i-Pr.
  • X′ is CR 4a .
  • X′ is N.
  • X′ is CR 4a ; and R 4a is independently H, C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo C 1 -C 4 alkyl, CN, NO 2 , or halo.
  • X′ is CR 4a ; and R 4a is H, Me, CF 3 , Cl, F, CN or NO 2 .
  • X′ is CR 4a ; and R 4a is Cl or CN.
  • R 4b is H, C 1 -C 4 alkyl or halo C 1 -C 4 alkyl or halo.
  • R 4b is H, Me, CF 3 , Cl or F.
  • R 1 is other than aryl or heteroaryl.
  • R 1 is aryl or heteroaryl.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, aryl, and heteroaryl.
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.
  • R 1 is hydroxyalkyl
  • R 1 is alkyl
  • R 1 is Et, i-Pr, or t-Bu.
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl.
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl.
  • R 1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • R 1 is selected from morpholinyl, and 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl.
  • n2 is 1; and R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl.
  • n2 is 1; and R 1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • n2 is 1; and R 1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • n2 is 1; and R 1 is selected from morpholinyl, and 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted bicycloaryl, bicycloalkyl, or bicycloheteroaryl.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted pyridyl, pyrazinyl or unsubstituted pyrimidinyl.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, methylenedioxyphenyl, imidazopyridyl, benzoxazolyl, and indolyl.
  • R1 is
  • n3 is 1, 2 or 3.
  • n3 is 1 or 2.
  • R 1 is
  • each R 5b is independently selected from H, alkyl, halo, cyano, alkoxy, and haloalkyl.
  • each R 5b is independently selected from H, Me, Et, Pr, iso-Pr, Ph, Cl, F, Br, CN, OH, OMe, OEt, OPh, COPh, CO 2 Me, CH 2 —N-morpholino, CH 2 —N-(4-Me-piperidino), NH 2 , CONH 2 , CF 3 , CHF 2 , OCF 3 , OCHF 2 , t-Bu, SMe, CH ⁇ CH—CO 2 H, SOMe, SO 2 Me, SO 2 CF 3 , SO 2 NH 2 , SO 3 H, SO 3 Me, cyclopropyl, triazolyl, morpholinyl, and pyridyl.
  • each R 5b is independently selected from H, Cl, F, Me, or CF 3 .
  • the compound is according to formulae 3a, 4a, or 5a:
  • the compound is according to formulae 6a, 7a, 8a, 9a, 10a, or 11a:
  • the compound is according to formula 12a, 13a, 14a, 15a, 16a, or 17a:
  • the compound is according to formulae 18a, 19a, 20a, 21a, 22a, or 23a:
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl.
  • nd R 1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • R 1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • R 1 is selected from morpholinyl, and 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl.
  • R 3a is H or alkyl.
  • R 3 a is H, Me, Et, or i-Pr.
  • X′ is CR 4a .
  • X′ is N.
  • X′ is CR 4a ; and R 4a is independently H, C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo C 1 -C 4 alkyl, CN, NO 2 , or halo.
  • X′ is CR 4a ; and R 4a is H, Me, CF 3 , Cl, F, CN or NO 2 .
  • X′ is CR 4a ; and R 4a is Cl or CN.
  • R 4b is H, C 1 -C 4 alkyl or halo C 1 -C 4 alkyl or halo.
  • R 4b is H, Me, CF 3 , Cl or F.
  • each of R 2a and R 2b is hydrogen.
  • each of R 2a and R 2b is hydrogen.
  • one of R 2a and R 2b is methyl, hydroxymethyl or hydroxyethyl.
  • each of R 2a and R 2b is methyl.
  • R 2a and R 2b join together to form a cycloalkyl ring.
  • R 2a and R 2b join together to form a cyclopropyl ring.
  • R 2a is selected from Me, Et, n-Pr, t-Bu, CF 3 , CH 2 OH, CH 2 CH 2 OH, CH 2 CH 2 OAc, CH 2 (CH 2 ) 2 OH, CH 2 CH 2 NHMe, CH 2 NMe 2 , CH 2 CH 2 NMe 2 , CH 2 CONH 2 , CH 2 CONMe 2 , CH 2 COOH, CH 2 CH 2 COOH, CH 2 (CH 2 ) 2 COOH, CH 2 OMe, and CH 2 CH 2 OMe; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is selected from CH 2 NR 2′ R 2′′ , CH 2 CH 2 NR 2′ R 2′′ , CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 NR 2′ R 2′′ and wherein R 2′ and R 2′′ can join together to form a heterocyclic ring; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is selected from cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl or cyclohexyl; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is CH 2 OH or CH 2 CH 2 OH; and R 2b is H.
  • R 1 is Me. E t , i-Pr, or t-Bu.
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted aryl or heteroaryl.
  • the compound is according to formula 3b, 4b, 5b, 6b, 7b, or 8b:
  • the subscript m′ is 1, 2 or 3.
  • the compound is according to formula 9b, 10b, 11b, 12b, 13b, or 14b:
  • R 3a is H or alkyl.
  • R 3a is H, Me, Et, or i-Pr.
  • the compound is according to formula 3c, 4c, or 5c:
  • the compound is according to formula 6c, 7c, 8c, 9c, 10c or 11c:
  • X′ is CR 4a .
  • X′ is N.
  • X′ is CR 4a ; and R 4a is independently H, C 1 -C 4 alkyl, halo C 1 -C 4 alkyl, CN, NO 2 , or halo.
  • X′ is CR 4a ; and R 4a is H, Me, CF 3 , Cl, F, CN or NO 2 .
  • X′ is CR 4a ; and R 4a is Cl or CN.
  • R 4b is H, C 1 -C 4 alkyl or halo C 1 -C 4 alkyl or halo.
  • R 4b is H, Me, CF 3 , Cl or F.
  • each of R 2a and R 2b is hydrogen.
  • one of R 2a and R 2b is methyl, hydroxymethyl or hydroxyethyl.
  • each of R 2a and R 2b is methyl.
  • R 2a and R 2b join together to form a cycloalkyl ring.
  • R 2a and R 2b join together to form a cyclopropyl ring.
  • R 2a is selected from Me, Et, n-Pr, t-Bu, CF 3 , CH 2 OH, CH 2 CH 2 OH, CH 2 CH 2 OAc, CH 2 (CH 2 ) 2 OH, CH 2 CH 2 NHMe, CH 2 NMe 2 , CH 2 CH 2 NMe 2 , CH 2 CONH 2 , CH 2 CONMe 2 , CH 2 COOH, CH 2 CH 2 COOH, CH 2 (CH 2 ) 2 COOH, CH 2 OMe, and CH 2 CH 2 OMe; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is selected from CH 2 NR 2′ R 2′′ , CH 2 CH 2 NR 2′ R 2′′ , CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 NR 2′ R 2′′ and wherein R 2′ and R 2′′ can join together to form a heterocyclic ring; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is selected from cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl or cyclohexyl; and R 2b is H.
  • R 2a is CH 2 OH or CH 2 CH 2 OH; and R 2b is H.
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted bicycloaryl, bicycloalkyl, or bicycloheteroaryl.
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted phenyl.
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted pyridyl, pyrimidinyl or pyrazinyl.
  • R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, methylenedioxyphenyl, imidazopyridyl, benzoxazolyl, and indolyl.
  • R 1 is
  • R 1 is as described above and the subscript n3 is 1, 2 or 3.
  • R 1 is as described above and the subscript n3 is 1 or 2.
  • R 1 is
  • each R 5b is independently selected from H, alkyl, halo, cyano, alkoxy, and haloalkyl.
  • R 1 is as described above and each R 5b is independently selected from H, Me, Et, Pr, iso-Pr, Ph, Cl, F, Br, CN, OH, OMe, OEt, OPh, COPh, CO 2 Me, CH 2 —N-morpholino, CH 2 —N-(4-Me-piperidino), NH 2 , CONH 2 , CF 3 , CHF 2 , OCF 3 , OCHF 2 , t-Bu, SMe, CH ⁇ CH—CO 2 H, SOMe, SO 2 Me, SO 2 CF 3 , SO 2 NH 2 , SO 3 H, SO 3 Me, cyclopropyl, triazolyl, morpholinyl, and pyridyl.
  • each R 5b is independently selected from H, Cl, F, Me, or CF 3 .
  • n2 is 0; and R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted aryl or heteroaryl.
  • the subscript n2 is 0; and R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted bicycloaryl, bicycloalkyl, or bicycloheteroaryl.
  • n2 is 0; and R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted phenyl.
  • n2 is 0; and R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted pyridyl, pyrimidinyl or pyrazinyl.
  • the subscript n2 is 0; and R 1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, methylenedioxyphenyl, imidazopyridyl, benzoxazolyl, and indolyl.
  • the subscript n2 is 0; and R 1 is as described above and the subscript n3 is 1, 2 or 3.
  • the subscript n2 is 0; and R 1 is as described above and the subscript n3 is 1 or 2.
  • each R 5b is independently selected from H, alkyl, halo, cyano, alkoxy, and haloalkyl.
  • n2 is 0; and R 1 is as described above and each R 5b is independently selected from H, Me, Et, Pr, iso-Pr, Ph, Cl, F, Br, CN, OH, OMe, OEt, OPh, COPh, CO 2 Me, CH 2 —N-morpholino, CH 2 —N-(4-Me-piperidino), NH 2 , CONH 2 , CF 3 , CHF 2 , OCF 3 , OCHF 2 , t-Bu, SMe, CH ⁇ CH—CO 2 H, SOMe, SO 2 Me, SO 2 CF 3 , SO 2 NH 2 , SO 3 H, SO 3 Me, cyclopropyl, triazolyl, morpholinyl, and pyridyl.
  • each R 5b is independently selected from H, Cl, F, Me, or CF 3 .
  • R 1 is substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl
  • said heterocycloalkyl is other than morpholino or piperidine; even more preferably R 1 is other than substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.
  • the compound is selected from the compounds exemplified in Table 1; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • the compound is selected from:
  • prodrugs and derivatives of the compounds according to the formulae above are derivatives of the compounds provided herein, which have metabolically cleavable groups and become by solvolysis or under physiological conditions the compounds provided herein, which are pharmaceutically active, in vivo.
  • Such examples include, but are not limited to, choline ester derivatives and the like, N-alkylmorpholine esters and the like.
  • Prodrugs include acid derivatives well know to practitioners of the art, such as, for example, esters prepared by reaction of the parent acid with a suitable alcohol, or amides prepared by reaction of the parent acid compound with a substituted or unsubstituted amine, or acid anhydrides, or mixed anhydrides. Simple aliphatic or aromatic esters, amides and anhydrides derived from acidic groups pendant on the compounds provided herein are preferred prodrugs.
  • double ester type prodrugs such as (acyloxy)alkyl esters or ((alkoxycarbonyl)oxy)alkylesters.
  • double ester type prodrugs such as (acyloxy)alkyl esters or ((alkoxycarbonyl)oxy)alkylesters.
  • Preferred are the C 1 to C 8 alkyl, C 2 -C 8 alkenyl, aryl, C 7 -C 12 substituted aryl, and C 7 -C 12 arylalkyl esters of the compounds provided herein.
  • compositions When employed as pharmaceuticals, the compounds provided herein are typically administered in the form of a pharmaceutical composition.
  • Such compositions can be prepared in a manner well known in the pharmaceutical art and comprise at least one active compound.
  • the compounds provided herein are administered in a therapeutically effective amount.
  • the amount of the compound actually administered will typically be determined by a physician, in the light of the relevant circumstances, including the condition to be treated, the chosen route of administration, the actual compound-administered, the age, weight, and response of the individual patient, the severity of the patient's symptoms, and the like.
  • compositions provided herein can be administered by a variety of routes including oral, rectal, transdermal, subcutaneous, intravenous, intramuscular, and intranasal.
  • routes including oral, rectal, transdermal, subcutaneous, intravenous, intramuscular, and intranasal.
  • the compounds provided herein are preferably formulated as either injectable or oral compositions or as salves, as lotions or as patches all for transdermal administration.
  • compositions for oral administration can take the form of bulk liquid solutions or suspensions, or bulk powders. More commonly, however, the compositions are presented in unit dosage forms to facilitate accurate dosing.
  • unit dosage forms refers to physically discrete units suitable as unitary dosages for human subjects and other mammals, each unit containing a predetermined quantity of active material calculated to produce the desired therapeutic effect, in association with a suitable pharmaceutical excipient.
  • Typical unit dosage forms include prefilled, premeasured ampules or syringes of the liquid compositions or pills, tablets, capsules or the like in the case of solid compositions.
  • the furansulfonic acid compound is usually a minor component (from about 0.1 to about 50% by weight or preferably from about 1 to about 40% by weight) with the remainder being various vehicles or carriers and processing aids helpful for forming the desired dosing form.
  • Liquid forms suitable for oral administration may include a suitable aqueous or nonaqueous vehicle with buffers, suspending and dispensing agents, colorants, flavors and the like.
  • Solid forms may include, for example, any of the following ingredients, or compounds of a similar nature: a binder such as microcrystalline cellulose, gum tragacanth or gelatin; an excipient such as starch or lactose, a disintegrating agent such as alginic acid, Primogel, or corn starch; a lubricant such as magnesium stearate; a glidant such as colloidal silicon dioxide; a sweetening agent such as sucrose or saccharin; or a flavoring agent such as peppermint, methyl salicylate, or orange flavoring.
  • a binder such as microcrystalline cellulose, gum tragacanth or gelatin
  • an excipient such as starch or lactose, a disintegrating agent such as alginic acid, Primogel, or corn starch
  • Injectable compositions are typically based upon injectable sterile saline or phosphate-buffered saline or other injectable carriers known in the art.
  • the active compound in such compositions is typically a minor component, often being from about 0.05 to 10% by weight with the remainder being the injectable carrier and the like.
  • Transdermal compositions are typically formulated as a topical ointment or cream containing the active ingredient(s), generally in an amount ranging from about 0.01 to about 20% by weight, preferably from about 0.1 to about 20% by weight, preferably from about 0.1 to about 10% by weight, and more preferably from about 0.5 to about 15% by weight.
  • the active ingredients When formulated as a ointment, the active ingredients will typically be combined with either a paraffinic or a water-miscible ointment base. Alternatively, the active ingredients may be formulated in a cream with, for example an oil-in-water cream base.
  • Such transdermal formulations are well-known in the art and generally include additional ingredients to enhance the dermal penetration of stability of the active ingredients or the formulation. All such known transdermal formulations and ingredients are included within the scope provided herein.
  • transdermal administration can be accomplished using a patch either of the reservoir or porous membrane type, or of a solid matrix variety.
  • the compounds of this invention can also be administered in sustained release forms or from sustained release drug delivery systems.
  • sustained release materials can be found in Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences.
  • a compound of the invention may be admixed as a dry powder with a dry gelatin binder in an approximate 1:2 weight ratio.
  • a minor amount of magnesium stearate may be added as a lubricant.
  • the mixture is formed into 240-270 mg tablets (80-90 mg of active amide compound per tablet) in a tablet press.
  • a compound of the invention may be admixed as a dry powder with a starch diluent in an approximate 1:1 weight ratio.
  • the mixture may be filled into 250 mg capsules (125 mg of active amide compound per capsule).
  • a compound of the invention (125 mg), sucrose (1.75 g) and xanthan gum (4 mg) may be admixed with sucrose (1.75 g) and xanthan gum (4 mg) and the resultant mixture may be blended, passed through a No. 10 mesh U.S. sieve, and then mixed with a previously made solution of microcrystalline cellulose and sodium carboxymethyl cellulose (11:89, 50 mg) in water.
  • Sodium benzoate (10 mg) flavor, and color are diluted with water and added with stirring. Sufficient water is then added to produce a total volume of 5 mL.
  • a compound of the invention may be admixed as a dry powder with a dry gelatin binder in an approximate 1:2 weight ratio.
  • a minor amount of magnesium stearate is added as a lubricant.
  • the mixture is formed into 450-900 mg tablets (150-300 mg of active amide compound) in a tablet press.
  • a compound of the invention may be dissolved or suspended in a buffered sterile saline injectable aqueous medium to a concentration of approximately 5 mg/ml.
  • Stearyl alcohol (250 g) and a white petrolatum (250 g) may be melted at about 75° C. and then a mixture of a compound of the invention (50 g) methylparaben (0.25 g), propylparaben (0.15 g), sodium lauryl sulfate (10 g), and propylene glycol (120 g) dissolved in water (about 370 g) is added and the resulting mixture is stirred until it congeals.
  • the present compounds are used as therapeutic agents for the treatment of conditions in mammals. Accordingly, the compounds and pharmaceutical compositions provided herein find use as therapeutics for preventing and/or treating neurodegenerative, autoimmune and inflammatory conditions in mammals including humans and non-human mammals.
  • the present invention includes within its scope, and extends to, the recited methods of treatment, as well as to the compounds for such methods, and to the use of such compounds for the preparation of medicaments useful for such methods.
  • a method of treating a mammal susceptible to or afflicted with a condition associated with arthritis, asthma, myocardial infarction, inflammatory bowel disease and autoimmune disorders comprises administering an effective amount of one or more of the pharmaceutical compositions just described.
  • a method of treating a mammal susceptible to or afflicted with a condition that gives rise to pain responses or that relates to imbalances in the maintenance of basal activity of sensory nerves The present compounds have use as analgesics for the treatment of pain of various geneses or etiology, for example acute, inflammatory pain (such as pain associated with osteoarthritis and rheumatoid arthritis); various neuropathic pain syndromes (such as post-herpetic neuralgia, trigeminal neuralgia, reflex sympathetic dystrophy, diabetic neuropathy, Guillian Barre syndrome, fibromyalgia, phantom limb pain, post-masectomy pain, peripheral neuropathy, HIV neuropathy, and chemotherapy-induced and other iatrogenic neuropathies); visceral pain, (such as that associated with gastroesophageal reflex disease, irritable bowel syndrome, inflammatory bowel disease, pancreatitis, and various gynecological and
  • neurodegenerative diseases and disorders such as, for example Parkinson's disease, Alzheimer's disease and multiple sclerosis; diseases and disorders which are mediated by or result in neuroinflammation such as, for example encephalitis; centrally-mediated neuropsychiatric diseases and disorders such as, for example depression mania, bipolar disease, anxiety, schizophrenia, eating disorders, sleep disorders and cognition disorders; epilepsy and seizure disorders; prostate, bladder and bowel dysfunction such as, for example urinary incontinence, urinary hesitancy, rectal hypersensitivity, fecal incontinence, benign prostatic hypertrophy and inflammatory bowel disease; respiratory and airway disease and disorders such as, for example, allergic rhinitis, asthma and reactive airway disease and chronic obstructive pulmonary disease; diseases and disorders which are mediated by or result in inflammation such as, for example rheumatoid arthritis and osteoarthritis, myocardial infar
  • the present compounds for use as a pharmaceutical especially in the treatment or prevention of the aforementioned conditions and diseases.
  • Injection dose levels range from about 0.1 mg/kg/hour to at least 10 mg/kg/hour, all for from about 1 to about 120 hours and especially 24 to 96 hours.
  • a preloading bolus of from about 0.1 mg/kg to about 10 mg/kg or more may also be administered to achieve adequate steady state levels.
  • the maximum total dose is not expected to exceed about 2 g/day for a 40 to 80 kg human patient.
  • each dose provides from about 0.01 to about 20 mg/kg of the compound provided herein, with preferred doses each providing from about 0.1 to about 10 mg/kg and especially about 1 to about 5 mg/kg.
  • Transdermal doses are generally selected to provide similar or lower blood levels than are achieved using injection doses.
  • the compounds provided herein When used to prevent the onset of a neurodegenerative, autoimmune or inflammatory condition, the compounds provided herein will be administered to a patient at risk for developing the condition, typically on the advice and under the supervision of a physician, at the dosage levels described above.
  • Patients at risk for developing a particular condition generally include those that have a family history of the condition, or those who have been identified by genetic testing or screening to be particularly susceptible to developing the condition.
  • the compounds provided herein can be administered as the sole active agent or they can be administered in combination with other agents, including other active amines and derivatives. Administration in combination can proceed by any technique apparent to those of skill in the art including, for example, separate, sequential, concurrent and alternating administration.
  • the compounds provided herein can be prepared from readily available starting materials using the following general methods and procedures. See, e.g., FIG. 1 and Synthetic Schemes 1-10 below. It will be appreciated that where typical or preferred process conditions (i.e., reaction temperatures, times, mole ratios of reactants, solvents, pressures, etc.) are given, other process conditions can also be used unless otherwise stated. Optimum reaction conditions may vary with the particular reactants or solvent used, but such conditions can be determined by one skilled in the art by routine optimization procedures.
  • protecting groups may be necessary to prevent certain functional groups from undergoing undesired reactions.
  • the choice of a suitable protecting group for a particular functional group as well as suitable conditions for protection and deprotection are well known in the art. For example, numerous protecting groups, and their introduction and removal, are described in T. W. Greene and P. G. M. Wuts, Protecting Groups in Organic Synthesis , Second Edition, Wiley, New York, 1991, and references cited therein.
  • the compounds provided herein may be prepared by the reaction of a chloro derivative with an appropriately substituted amine and the product isolated and purified by known standard procedures. Such procedures include (but are not limited to) recrystallization, column chromatography or HPLC. The following schemes are presented with details as to the preparation of representative fused heterocyclics that have been listed hereinabove.
  • the compounds provided herein may be prepared from known or commercially available starting materials and reagents by one skilled in the art of organic synthesis.
  • the enantiomerically pure compounds provided herein may be prepared according to any techniques known to those of skill in the art. For instance, they may be prepared by chiral or asymmetric synthesis from a suitable optically pure precursor or obtained from a racemate by any conventional technique, for example, by chromatographic resolution using a chiral column, TLC or by the preparation of diastereoisomers, separation thereof and regeneration of the desired enantiomer. See, e.g., “Enantiomers, Racemates and Resolutions,” by J. Jacques, A. Collet, and S. H. Wilen, (Wiley-Interscience, New York, 1981); S. H. Wilen, A. Collet, and J. Jacques, Tetrahedron, 2725 (1977); E.
  • an enantiomerically pure compound of formula 1 may be obtained by reaction of the racemate with a suitable optically active acid or base.
  • suitable acids or bases include those described in Bighley et al., 1995 , Salt Forms of Drugs and Adsorption, in Encyclopedia of Pharmaceutical Technology , vol. 13, Swarbrick & Boylan, eds., Marcel Dekker, New York; ten Hoeve & H. Wynberg, 1985 , Journal of Organic Chemistry 50:4508-4514; Dale & Mosher, 1973 , J. Am. Chem. Soc. 95:512; and CRC Handbook of Optical Resolution via Diastereomeric Salt Formation , the contents of which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entireties.
  • Enantiomerically pure compounds can also be recovered either from the crystallized diastereomer or from the mother liquor, depending on the solubility properties of the particular acid resolving agent employed and the particular acid enantiomer used.
  • the identity and optical purity of the particular compound so recovered can be determined by polarimetry or other analytical methods known in the art.
  • the diasteroisomers can then be separated, for example, by chromatography or fractional crystallization, and the desired enantiomer regenerated by treatment with an appropriate base or acid.
  • the other enantiomer may be obtained from the racemate in a similar manner or worked up from the liquors of the first separation.
  • enantiomerically pure compound can be separated from racemic compound by chiral chromatography.
  • Various chiral columns and eluents for use in the separation of the enantiomers are available and suitable conditions for the separation can be empirically determined by methods known to one of skill in the art.
  • Exemplary chiral columns available for use in the separation of the enantiomers provided herein include, but are not limited to CHIRALCEL® OB, CHIRALCEL® OB-H, CHIRALCEL® OD, CHIRALCEL® OD-H, CHIRALCEL® OF, CHIRALCEL® OG, CHIRALCEL® OJ and CHIRALCEL® OK.
  • a pressure vial was charged with 3-bromo-5-iodo-benzoic acid (7.60 g, 23.2 mmol), p-tolylboronic acid (3.16 g, 23.2 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (1.34 g, 1.16 mmol), cesium carbonate (8.33 g, 25.6 mmol), toluene (99.0 mL, 930 mmol), ethanol (27.1 mL, 465 mmol) and water (12.6 mL, 697 mmol) and the reaction stirred at 85° C. over nights. The reaction mixture was filtered over celite and the solvent removed to get the crude product as a brown solid.
  • a microwave vial was charged with methyl 3-bromo-5-iodobenzoate (2.00 g, 5.87 mmol), 5-methyl-2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine (2.24 g, 5.87 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (339 mg, 0.29 mmol) and 1,4-dioxane (30 mL).
  • the reaction mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation at 120° C. for 1 hour.
  • the reaction was filtered through Celite and the filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography to afford the product as a white solid.
  • a microwave vial was charged with methyl 3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate (100 mg, 0.33 mmol), morpholin-3-one (42 mg, 0.41 mmol), palladium acetate (4 mg), cesium carbonate (169 mg, 0.52 mmol), xantphos (3 mg), and 1,4-dioxane (1 mL).
  • the reaction mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation at 110° C. for 15 min.
  • the reaction mixture was filtered and the filterate was concentrated under reduced pressure.
  • the resultant residue was purified by preparative HPLC to get the product as a yellow solid.
  • reaction mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation at 150° C. for 10 mins. After cooling, the reaction mixture was extracted with ethylacetate. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried, and concentrated under reduced pressure to give the residue which was purified by silica gel column to yield the title compound.
  • reaction mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation at 150° C. for 10 mins. After cooling, the reaction mixture was extracted with ethylacetate. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried, and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford the residue which was purified by silica gel column to yield the title compound.
  • a microwave vial was charged with methyl 3-bromo-5-iodobenzoate (2.00 g, 5.87 mmol), 5-methyl-2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine (2.24 g, 5.87 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (340 mg, 0.30 mmol) and 1,4-dioxane (30 mL).
  • the reaction mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation at 120° C. for 1 hour. After cooling, the mixture was filtered through Celite and the filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography to afford the product as a white solid.
  • Compounds provided herein can be evaluated using cell-based assays, such as calcium influx or electrophysiological assays, using biochemical assays, such as binding assays to P2X 2 and P2X 3 receptors, or can be evaluated in animal models of pain or urinary function. Examples of assays are described below.
  • the purinergic receptors P2X 2 and P2X 3 are expressed in a variety of tissues including various sensory and sympathetic ganglia, such as the dorsal root (DRG), nodose (ND), trigeminal (TG), and superior cervical ganglia (SCG) and also in smooth muscle cells (Burnstock, Trends Pharmacol. Sci. 27:166-76, 2006). In several regions, P2X 2 and P2X 3 receptors are coexpressed and functional studies have demonstrated the presence of heteromeric P2X 2/3 receptors whose properties differ from those of either homomeric receptor.
  • DDG dorsal root
  • ND nodose
  • TG trigeminal
  • SCG superior cervical ganglia
  • chimeric P2X 2/3 receptors containing the N-terminal cytoplasmic domain of P2X 2 fused to the first transmembrane domain of P2X 3 have been described; these chimeric channels retain the pharmacological profile of homomeric P2X 3 receptors, while gaining the non-desensitizing phenotype of the homomeric P2X 2 receptor (Neelands et al., Br. J. Pharmacol. 140:202-10, 2003).
  • the non-desensitizing behavior of the chimeric receptor is especially useful for screening.
  • ligand-gated non-selective cation channels whose activity can be characterized by using electrophysiological methods, or by measuring calcium ion influx using calcium-sensitive fluorescent dyes.
  • Applications of agonists such as ATP, or an ATP analog such as ⁇ , ⁇ -Methyleneadenosine 5′-triphosphate ( ⁇ MeATP, Sigma-Aldrich) causes channel opening, resulting in current flow and calcium influx (Bianchi et al., Eur. J. Pharmacol. 376:127-38, 1999).
  • the compounds provided herein can be tested for antagonist activity at P2X 3 and P2X 2/3 receptors by measuring their ability to affect channel opening by ATP, ⁇ MeATP, or other agonists.
  • Functional tests of receptor activity include but are not limited to: (i) calcium ion influx measured by fluorescence of a calcium-sensitive dye and; (ii) ion flux resulting from channel opening measured by electrophysiological methods. These methods can be used to evaluate channel function when the relevant receptor is heterologously expressed in mammalian or amphibian cells. These methods can also be used to evaluate compounds provided herein in rodent primary neurons and other mammalian primary cells and cell lines that normally express the receptor of interest.
  • Compounds can further be evaluated for their ability to bind P2X 3 and P2X 2/3 receptors using biochemical approaches.
  • Compounds can also be evaluated for their ability to modify sensory and autonomic nervous system signaling where the receptors are known to have a role (e.g., urinary bladder afferent signaling, sensory nerve pain sensation).
  • a role e.g., urinary bladder afferent signaling, sensory nerve pain sensation.
  • compounds provided herein can be tested in vivo in relevant animal models known to one skilled in the art, such as, for example, models of neuropathic, inflammatory, or visceral pain, or models of urinary incontinence.
  • Human P2X 3 (Accession no. NM — 002559), P2X 2 (Accession no. NM — 170682) and Rat P2X 3 (Accession no. NM — 031075) and P2X 2 (Accession no. NM — 053656) are cloned into a mammalian expression vector (e.g., pcDNA5/TO or pcDNA3 Invitrogen).
  • the human P2X 2/3 chimera clone is created as described by Neelands et al, and then cloned into an expression vector as above.
  • Receptors are expressed in cells (e.g., HEK293 or 1321N1 (obtained from the ECACC)) via transient transfection using standard lipid mediated transfection, or by creation of stable transfectants for each receptor.
  • the P2X 3 expression vector is stably transfected into a cell line already stably expressing P2X 2 .
  • P2X 2/3 heteromer function is isolated using pharmacological methods. Cell lines are maintained in DMEM+5% Glutamax, the appropriate level of selective antibiotic, and 10% heat inactivated FBS.
  • Functional activity of compounds at the P2X receptor is determined by measuring their ability to inhibit agonist-induced calcium influx. Compounds are tested for antagonist activity against the P2X 2/3 chimera, the P2X 3 homomer, or the P2X 2/3 heteromer. At the start of each screening day, the agonist EC 50 is determined. Compound % inhibition or IC50s are subsequently determined using a pre-determined agonist concentration (EC 50-90 depending on cell line) as a stimulus. The agonists used are ⁇ MeATP, ATP, or other ATP analogs. Compounds may be tested at concentrations ranging from 1 pM to 10 ⁇ M.
  • cells expressing the appropriate receptor are seeded onto 96 or 384 well plates 18-24 hours prior to assay.
  • cells are loaded with calcium-sensitive fluorescent dye (e.g., Fluo-4 no wash reagent-Invitrogen cat# F36206, or the BDTM PBX Calcium Assay Kit-BD cat# 640175) in Hank's Buffered Salt Solution (HBSS) with up to 10 mM supplemental CaCl 2 . Plates are incubated at 37° C. and then equilibrated at room temperature.
  • Antagonism of agonist-induced calcium influx is measured using a fluorescent imaging plate reader (e.g. FLIPR TETRA , Molecular Devices, Sunnyvale, Calif.).
  • the assay comprises two stages: a pre-treatment phase followed by a treatment phase.
  • Compounds may be tested as follows: For the pre-treatment phase, 50 ⁇ L of 3 ⁇ concentration of test compound in HBSS is added to cells containing 100 ⁇ L of dye loading media to achieve a final concentration of 1 ⁇ test compound.
  • For the treatment phase at a set interval after pre-treatment (1-30 minutes), 50 ⁇ L of 1 ⁇ test compound plus 4 ⁇ agonist solution is added, resulting in a final concentration of 1 ⁇ compound and 1 ⁇ agonist. Fluorescence is measured at 0.1-3 second intervals—with an excitation wavelength of 494 nM and an emission wavelength of 515 nM. Responses are measured as (peak fluorescence after agonist addition) minus (baseline fluorescence prior to treatment). Percent inhibition is calculated as follows:
  • Percentage ⁇ ⁇ inhibition 1 - ( Compound ⁇ ⁇ Response - Control ⁇ ⁇ Resonse ) ( Agonist ⁇ ⁇ Response - Control ⁇ ⁇ Response ) ⁇ 100
  • IC 50 values are determined by analyzing dose response data in a 4 parameter logistic fit using GraphPad Prizm.
  • Whole cell recordings are made using the Multiclamp700A patch-clamp amplifier and Clampex acquisition program (Molecular Devices Corporation).
  • Whole-cell recordings are obtained from 1321N1 or HEK cells stably or transiently transfected with P2X 3 and/or P2X 2 expression vectors. Solutions are either applied for periods of 1 to 3s by a gravity flow, 8-valve delivery system, or for periods of milliseconds using the quick-change Dynaflow perfusion system (Cellectricon Inc.).
  • the internal pipette solution may include 140 mM Cesium-Chloride, 10 mM EGTA, and 5 mM Hepes at pH 7.2; normal external solution is 140 mM NaCl, 5 mM KCl, 1 mM CaCl 2 , 2 mM MgCl 2 , 25 mM Hepes, and 10 mM glucose.
  • Concentration-response curves are obtained by recording currents in response to brief applications of agonist at 1-3 min intervals where regular external solution is perfused during the intervals. To obtain inhibition curves, antagonists are pre-applied to the cells for a defined time period before a short application of the agonist+ antagonist.
  • the periods of antagonist pre-application and agonist+ antagonist applications are constant for the entire test concentration series.
  • Agonist evoked currents are measured in cells that are voltage clamped at ⁇ 60 or ⁇ 80 millivolts.
  • IC 50 values are determined by analyzing dose response data in a 4 parameter logistic fit using GraphPad Prizm or Origin.
  • Xenopus oocytes are isolated by enzymatic dissociation using collagenase (Worthington, 2 mg/ml). Oocytes are then individually injected with P2X 3 , P2X 2 , or a combination of P2X 2 and P2X 3 mRNA. Each oocyte receives ⁇ 64 nl of RNA solution in water at a concentration of ⁇ 0.01 ⁇ g/ ⁇ l. Injected oocytes are stored in standard oocyte incubation solution, ND96, containing (in mM) 96 NaCl, 2 KCl, 1 MgCl 2 , 1-5 CaCl 2 and 50 ⁇ g/ml Gentamicin at 16° C.
  • Agonist-induced-current caused by P2X channel opening is observed in oocytes 1-5 days after injection.
  • 8 oocytes are placed in the recording chambers. Each oocyte is impaled by 2 glass electrodes having resistances of 0.5 to 1 MOhm when filled with a 3 M KCl solution. Electrode advancement and oocyte impalement are under software control (OPUSXPRESS 1.1, Molecular devices Corporation). The solutions are prepared in 96 well plates and robotically pipetted into the oocyte recording chambers by an 8 channel pipettor. Inhibition by antagonists is determined by calculating % current remaining when oocytes are stimulated with agonist in the presence of test compound compared to the peak current in the presence of agonist alone.
  • the sequence of solution application to the oocyte is as follows: a specific concentration (e.g., EC 50 , EC 80 , or EC 90 ) of the agonist is added first to elicit the maximal response. After the pulse, oocytes are washed for several minutes with ND96. The test compound is then added at a particular concentration, followed by the compound at the same concentration along with the agonist. Concentrations for the compounds may range from 0.3 to 10,000 nM. IC 50 values are determined by analyzing dose response data using a 4 parameter logistic fit using GraphPad Prizm or Origin software.
  • oocytes are impaled manually with 2 electrodes and agonist evoked current are measured using an Oocyte clamp amplifier (Warner Instrument Corp.) and Clampex (Molecular Devices Corporation) acquisition software. Solutions are delivered using gravity flow and applied as above. The agonist induced current is measured in the absence and presence of antagonist. Antagonists are tested in a concentration series to obtain an inhibition curve as described above.
  • P2X 3 and/or P2X 2/3 activation will be tested for activity against other P2X receptors to determine their selectivity for specific P2X family members.
  • the list of receptors to be assayed includes, but is not restricted to P2X1, P2X 2 , P2X4, P2X5, P2X6, and P2X7.
  • the types of assay used for selectivity determination may include: 1) Agonist-induced Calcium influx in cells heterologously expressing the relevant receptor, 2) Electrophysiological determination of receptor inhibition in either mammalian cells or Xenopus oocytes heterologously expressing the receptor of interest. Methods and data analysis are similar to those described above for P2X 3 and P2X 2/3 .
  • Radioligand experiments are done to determine the affinity of test compounds for P2X 3 homomeric and P2X 2/3 heteromeric receptors. These studies also provide valuable insights into the mechanism of action of antagonism.
  • the general methodologies used for radioligand binding experiments for P2X 3 and P2X 2/3 receptors are described by Jarvis et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 10:407-16, 2004.
  • cell membranes are prepared from cells transiently or stably expressing P2X 3 or P2X 2/3 receptors. Cells are grown to confluence, washed, isolated, and stored as pellets at ⁇ 80° C. until use. Some studies may require the addition of Apyrase or hexokinase (Sigma-Aldrich) during membrane preparation to minimize ATP-mediated receptor desensitization during membrane preparation. Membranes are prepared by resuspending the cell pellet in homogenization buffer, homogenizing, and centrifuging to obtain a membrane pellet. Total protein concentrations are determined using standard methods.
  • Displacement binding studies are conducted using procedures adapted from Jarvis et al. Under optimized conditions, ligand competition experiments are conducted using radioligand ([3H]A-317491, Abbott), or other high affinity radioligands and a range of different concentrations of test compounds in binding buffer. Ligand saturation studies are conducted using a range of concentrations of radioligand. All binding reactions are terminated by rapid filtration through a glass fiber filter. Membranes are washed, incubated in scintillant, and counted in a scintillation counter. IC 50 values are determined using a four-parameter logistic Hill equation.
  • Caco-2 permeability is measured according to the method described in Yee, Pharm. Res. 14:763-6, 1997. Caco-2 cells are grown on filter supports (Falcon HTS multiwell insert system) for 14 days. Culture medium is removed from both the apical and basolateral compartments and the monolayers are preincubated with pre-warmed 0.3 ml apical buffer and 1.0 ml basolateral buffer for 0.75 hour at 37° C. in a shaker water bath at 50 cycles/min.
  • the apical buffer consists of Hanks Balanced Salt Solution, 25 mM D-glucose monohydrate, 20 mM MES Biological Buffer, 1.25 mM CaCl 2 and 0.5 in M MgCl 2 (pH 6.5).
  • the basolateral buffer consists of Hanks Balanced Salt Solution, 25 mM D-glucose monohydrate, 20 mM HEPES Biological Buffer, 1.25 mM CaCl 2 and 0.5 mM MgCl 2 (pH 7.4).
  • test compound solution (10 ⁇ M) in buffer is added to the apical compartment.
  • the inserts are moved to wells containing fresh basolateral buffer and incubated for 1 hr. Drug concentration in the buffer is measured by LC/MS analysis.
  • Flux rate (F, mass/time) is calculated from the slope of cumulative appearance of substrate on the receiver side and apparent permeability coefficient (Papp) is calculated from the following equation:
  • Cell paste of HEK-293 cells expressing the HERG product can be suspended in 10-fold volume of 50 mM Tris buffer adjusted at pH 7.5 at 25° C. with 2 M HCl containing 1 mM MgCl 2 , 10 mM KCl.
  • the cells are homogenized using a Polytron homogenizer (at the maximum power for 20 seconds) and centrifuged at 48,000 g for 20 minutes at 4° C.
  • the pellet is resuspended, homogenized and centrifuged once more in the same manner.
  • the resultant supernatant is discarded and the final pellet was resuspended (10-fold volume of 50 mM Tris buffer) and homogenized at the maximum power for 20 seconds.
  • the membrane homogenate is aliquoted and stored at ⁇ 80° C. until use. An aliquot is used for protein concentration determination using a Protein Assay Rapid Kit and ARVO SX plate reader (Wallac). All the manipulation, stock solution and equipment are kept on ice at all time. For saturation assays, experiments are conducted in a total volume of 200 ⁇ l. Saturation is determined by incubating 20 ⁇ l of [ 3 H]-dofetilide and 160 ⁇ l of membrane homogenates (20-30 ⁇ g protein per well) for 60 min at room temperature in the absence or presence of 10 ⁇ M dofetilide at final concentrations (20 ⁇ l) for total or nonspecific binding, respectively.
  • compounds are diluted in 96 well polypropylene plates as 4-point dilutions in semi-log format. All dilutions are performed in DMSO first and then transferred into 50 mM Tris buffer (pH 7.5 at 25° C.) containing 1 mM MgCl 2 , 10 mM KCl so that the final DMSO concentration became equal to 1%.
  • Compounds are dispensed in triplicate in assay plates (4 ⁇ l). Total binding and nonspecific binding wells are set up in 6 wells as vehicle and 10 ⁇ M dofetilide at final concentration, respectively. The radioligand was prepared at 5.6 ⁇ final concentration and this solution is added to each well (36 ⁇ l).
  • the assay is initiated by addition of YSi poly-L-lysine Scintillation Proximity Assay (SPA) beads (50 ⁇ l, 1 mg/well) and membranes (110 ⁇ A, 20 ⁇ g/well). Incubation is continued for 60 min at room temperature. Plates are incubated for a further 3 hours at room temperature for beads to settle. Receptor-bound radioactivity is quantified by counting WALLAC MICROBETA plate counter.
  • SPA YSi poly-L-lysine Scintillation Proximity Assay
  • HEK 293 cells which stably express the HERG potassium channel are used for electrophysiological study.
  • the methodology for stable transfection of this channel in HEK cells can be found elsewhere (Zhou et al., Biophys. J. 74:230-41, 1998).
  • MEM Minimum Essential Medium
  • FCS Fetal Calf Serum
  • HERG currents are studied using standard patch clamp techniques in the whole-cell mode.
  • the cells are superfused with a standard external solution of the following composition (mM); NaCl, 130; KCl, 4; CaCl 2 , 2; MgCl 2 , 1; Glucose, 10; HEPES, 5; pH 7.4 with NaOH.
  • Whole-cell recordings are made using a patch clamp amplifier and patch pipettes which have a resistance of 1-3 MOhm when filled with the standard internal solution of the following composition (mho); KCl, 130; MgATP, 5; MgCl 2 , 1.0; HEPES, 10; EGTA 5, pH 7.2 with KOH.
  • the voltage protocol is applied to a cell continuously throughout the experiment every 4 seconds (0.25 Hz).
  • the amplitude of the peak current elicited around ⁇ 40 mV during the ramp is measured.
  • vehicle (0.5% DMSO in the standard external solution) is applied for 10-20 min by a peristalic pump.
  • the test compound of either 0.3, 1, 3, or 10 mM is applied for a 10 min period.
  • the 10 min period included the time which supplying solution was passing through the tube from solution reservoir to the recording chamber via the pump.
  • Exposing time of cells to the compound solution was more than 5 min after the drug concentration in the chamber well reached the attempting concentration. There is a subsequent wash period of a 10-20 min to assess reversibility. Finally, the cells is exposed to high dose of dofetilide (5 mM), a specific IKr blocker, to evaluate the insensitive endogenous current.
  • dofetilide 5 mM
  • Test compounds (1 ⁇ M) are incubated with 3.3 mM MgCl 2 and 0.78 mg/mL HLM (HL101) in 100 mM potassium phosphate buffer (pH 7.4) at 37° C. on the 96-deep well plate.
  • the reaction mixture is split into two groups, a non-P450 and a P450 group.
  • NADPH is only added to the reaction mixture of the P450 group.
  • An aliquot of samples of P450 group is collected at 0, 10, 30, and 60 min time point, where 0 min time point indicated the time when NADPH was added into the reaction mixture of P450 group.
  • An aliquot of samples of non-P450 group is collected at ⁇ 10 and 65 min time point.
  • Half-life ln 2 /k.
  • P2X 3 , P2X 2/3 antagonists may be tested in various animal models of human diseases, including models of neuropathic, inflammatory, and visceral pain, and models of bladder function. P2X 3 antagonists may be administered prior to or post-induction of the model depending upon the specific model and the compound PK characteristics.
  • the route of administration may include intraperitoneal, (i.p.), subcutaneous (s.c.), oral (p.o.), intravenous (i.v.), intrathecal (i.t.), or intraplantar.
  • the endpoints for these studies may include mechanical allodynia, thermal hyperalgesia, cold allodynia, decreased formalin-induced pain responses, decreased writhing and contractions or altered bladder mechanosensation as appropriate for the model as described below.
  • Test compounds are administered at various times prior to intraplantar administration of formalin.
  • a dilute solution of formalin (25-50 ⁇ L of 1-2.5% formaldehyde/saline) is administered s.c. into the plantar surface of the left hind paw under light restraint.
  • animals are placed on a mesh stand inside a clear observation chamber large enough to allow for free movement of the animals during the study. Behaviors are scored using manual scoring or automated scoring.
  • Automated scoring A small metal band weighing 0.5 g is placed on the left paw. Formalin is administered and the animal placed unrestrained inside an observation chamber over an electromagnetic detector system (Automated Nociception Analyzer, University of California, San Diego). The number of paw flinches is electronically recorded.
  • Rats are administered up to 1 ⁇ Mol ⁇ meATP, ATP, adenosine, or PBS in a volume up to 100 ⁇ L subcutaneously into the dorsal surface of the hindpaw.
  • animals are placed on a stand inside a clear observation chamber large enough to allow for free movement of the animals.
  • the duration of flinching and licking are recorded over a 20 minute interval to evaluate nocifensive behavior. Responses are measured using the either the manual or automated methods described above for the Formalin test. Additional behavioral testing may include assessment of mechanical allodynia and thermal hyperalgesia.
  • compounds are administered prior to agonist injection.
  • CFA Complete Freund's Adjuvant Model
  • Animals receive an s.c. injection of 100 ⁇ L complete Freund's adjuvant containing 100 ⁇ g Mycobacterium tuberculosis strain H37Ra into the plantar surface of the right hind paw under isoflurane anesthesia. Swelling and inflammation are visible within 1 h after administration. Nociceptive testing may begin 24 h post CFA administration. Compounds are generally administered 0.5-12 hrs before testing.
  • CCI Chronic Constriction Injury Model
  • the CCI model is performed according to the method described by Bennett and Xie, Pain, 33:87-107, 1988. Briefly, under isoflurane anesthesia, the right sciatic nerve is exposed at mid-thigh level via blunt dissection through the biceps femoris. Proximal to the bifurcation of the sciatic nerve, about 7 mm of nerve is freed of adhering tissue and 4 loose ligatures of 4.0 chromic gut are tied around the nerve. Spacing between ligatures is approximately 1 mm. The wound is closed in layers, and the skin closed with staples or non-silk sutures. Sham operated animals are treated identically with the exception that the sciatic nerve will not be ligated. Nociceptive testing can be done 7-21 days post surgery. Compounds are generally administered 0.5-12 hrs before testing.
  • rats Under anesthesia, rats are placed in a prone position on a flat, sterile surface. A midline incision from L4-S2 is made and the left paraspinal muscles are separated from the spinous processes.
  • the L5 and L6 spinal nerves are tightly ligated with a 4-0 silicon-treated silk suture, according to the method described by Kim and Chung, Pain, 50:355-363, 1992.
  • the L4 spinal nerve is carefully preserved from being surgically injured.
  • the skin is closed with wound clips and animals are returned to their home cages. Rats exhibiting prolonged postoperative neurological deficits or poor grooming are excluded from the experiments.
  • the animals are assessed for nociceptive responses prior to surgery (baseline), then at various timepoints after administration of test compounds. Nociceptive testing can be done 7-21 days post surgery. Compounds are generally administered 0.5-12 hrs before testing.
  • Hind paw withdrawal latencies to a noxious thermal stimulus are determined using a plantar test apparatus (Ugo Basile) following the technique described by Hargreaves et al., Pain 32: 77-88, 1988.
  • the radiant heat sourced is focused onto the plantar surface of the ipsilateral paw, and the paw withdrawal latency is determined.
  • An increase latency of paw withdrawal demonstrates reversal of hyperalgesia.
  • the paw pressure assay can be used to assess mechanical hyperalgesia.
  • hind paw withdrawal thresholds (PWT) to a noxious mechanical stimulus are determined using an analgesymeter (Ugo Basile) as described in Stein et al., Pharmacol. Biochem. Behav. 31:451-455, 1988.
  • the maximum weight that can be applied to the hind paw is set at 250 g and the end point is taken as complete withdrawal of the paw.
  • PWT is determined once for each rat at each time point.
  • Cold allodynia To measure cold allodynia, a drop of acetone is applied to the plantar surface of the paw through the underside of the grating on which the animals are standing using a 50 Hamilton syringe. The process is performed 5 times with a 3 min interval between each time. Vigorous shaking will be recorded as a positive response, and the time spent shaking is recorded.
  • cold allodynia may be tested using the cold water bath method in which animals are placed into a cold water bath with water at a depth of 1.5-2.0 cm and at a temperature of 3-4 degrees centigrade and the number of paw lifts counted.
  • a 5 cm latex balloon is attached to a barostat system composed of a flow meter and pressure control program by a length of tubing. Under isoflurane anesthesia, the balloon is inserted into the distal colon via the anus at a distance of 5 cm from the anus and taped to the base of the tail. Post-anesthesia, the animal is placed unrestrained into a clean polypropylene cage and allowed to acclimate for 30 mins. The balloon is progressively inflated from 0-75 mmHg in 5 mm increments every 30 s.
  • the colonic reaction threshold is defined as the pressure inducing the first abdominal contraction. Abdominal contraction indicative of visceral pain correlates with hunching, hump-backed position, licking of the lower abdomen, repeated waves of contraction of the ipsilateral oblique musculature with inward turning of the ipsilateral hindlimb, stretching, squashing of the lower abdomen against the floor (Wesselman, Neurosci. Lett., 246:73-76, 1998). Alternatively, electrodes may be placed into the external oblique musculature for eletromyographic recordings of abdominal contractions. In this case, EMG activity is quantified during colonic balloon inflation. Compounds are generally administered 0.5-12 hrs before testing.
  • a 0.6% solution of acetic acid (10 ml/kg) is administered i.p. to rats and the number of abdominal constrictions within 30 min are counted.
  • Compounds are generally administered 0.5-12 hrs before testing.
  • test compounds will be examined for their ability to modulate afferent signaling from the urinary bladder.
  • Compounds are evaluated in the urinary bladder/pelvic nerve preparation described by Vlaskovska et al., J. Neuroscience, 21:5670-7, 2001, and Cockayne et al., J. Physiol. 567:621-39, 2005. Briefly, the whole urinary tract attached to the lower vertebrae and surrounding tissues is isolated en bloc and superfused in a recording chamber with oxygenated (5% CO 2 and 95% O 2 ) Krebs solution. The bladder is catheterized through the urethra for intraluminal infusion.
  • a second double lumen catheter is inserted into the bladder to measure intraluminal pressure and to drain the bladder.
  • the pelvic nerve exiting the vertebrae is dissected and impaled with a suction glass electrode. Nerve activity is measured using standard electrophysiological methods. Following a 60 min stabilization period, repeated ramp distensions are performed until the afferent response stabilizes. This stabilized afferent response was used for comparing mechanosensitivity of bladder afferents between different treatment groups.
  • Female Sprague dawley rats are anesthetized, tracheotomized, and cannulated in the carotid artery and femoral vein.
  • the urinary bladder is accessed via an abdominal incision, and the ureters ligated and transected. For fluid infusion and pressure measurements, the urinary bladder is cannulated.
  • the bladder is infused with saline until stable volume-induced bladder contractions are elicited. Once stable threshold volumes and contraction frequencies are obtained, the animal is dosed with compound and contraction frequency is measured.
  • Each cystometrogram consists of slowly filling the bladder with normal saline via the transurethral catheter, and then recording the pressure associated with filling via a pressure transducer. Contractions greater than a predetermined threshold value are interpreted as micturition contractions. For each cystometrogram, the volume at which active contractions occurred (micturition threshold) and the number of contractions per cystometrogram are recorded. The effects of compounds are then determined.
  • Cystometrograms may also be obtained in animals cystitis models in which bladders are irritated by injection of cyclophosphamide (150 mg/kg, i.p.) 24 hrs prior to cystometry, or by infusion of up to 1% acetic acid during cystometry.

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Neurosurgery (AREA)
  • Neurology (AREA)
  • Biomedical Technology (AREA)
  • Pulmonology (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Pain & Pain Management (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Diabetes (AREA)
  • Urology & Nephrology (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Dermatology (AREA)
  • Rheumatology (AREA)
  • Psychiatry (AREA)
  • Cardiology (AREA)
  • Obesity (AREA)
  • Anesthesiology (AREA)
  • Hospice & Palliative Care (AREA)
  • Child & Adolescent Psychology (AREA)
  • Heart & Thoracic Surgery (AREA)
  • Vascular Medicine (AREA)
  • Transplantation (AREA)
  • Orthopedic Medicine & Surgery (AREA)
  • Physical Education & Sports Medicine (AREA)
  • Nutrition Science (AREA)
  • Otolaryngology (AREA)

Abstract

Compounds are provided according to formula (I), where A, B, W, X′, L, R1, R3, R4b, and m′ are as defined herein. Provided compounds and pharmaceutical compositions thereof are useful for the prevention and treatment of a variety of conditions in mammals including humans, including by way of non-limiting example, pain, inflammation, cognitive disorders, anxiety, depression, and others.
Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00001

Description

    FIELD
  • Provided herein are heterocyclic compounds and pharmaceutical compositions comprising such compounds. Also provided are methods for preventing and/or treating conditions in mammals, such as (but not limited to) arthritis, Parkinson's disease, Alzheimer's disease, asthma, myocardial infarction, pain syndromes (acute and chronic or neuropathic), neurodegenerative disorders, schizophrenia, cognitive disorders, anxiety, depression, inflammatory bowel disease and autoimmune disorders, and promoting neuroprotection, using the compounds and pharmaceutical compositions provided herein.
  • BACKGROUND
  • Therapeutic strategies for the effective management of pain and central nervous system disorders or diseases are sought.
  • International Patent Application, Publication Number WO 08/000,645 discloses tetrazole-substituted arylamides and related compounds which are said to be P2X2 and P2X2/3 receptor modulators.
  • International Patent Application, Publication Number WO 08/055,840 discloses thiazole and oxazole substituted arylamides and related compounds which are said to be P2X2 and P2X2/3 receptor modulators.
  • US 2007049609, US 2007049610, US 2007049758, and US 2007049534 describe certain diaminopyrimidines as P2X3 and P2X2/3 modulators.
  • US 2007037974 describes heterocyclic inhibitors of P2X3 useful for treating pain, genitourinary, gastrointestinal, and respiratory disorders.
  • WO 06/119504 describes fused heterocyclic compounds as P2X3 and P2X2/3 modulators for use in the treatment of various diseases. WO04/56774 describes certain substituted biphenyl-4-carboxylic acid arylamide analogues having possible application as receptor modulators.
  • WO 08/119,773 describes amide derivatives as inhibitors of aspartyl proteases and their use in the treatment of Alzheimer's disease.
  • WO 09/058,298 and WO 09/058,299 describe benzamide derivatives as P2X3 receptor antagonists for treatment of pain.
  • WO 05/065195 describes certain phenylamides and pyridylamides as β-secretase inhibitors.
  • WO 02/070469 describes certain substituted sulfonylalkylcarboxamides as selective pde3b inhibitors
  • WO 04/039753 describes certain benzoic acids and related compounds as EP1 receptor antagonists for the treatment of prostaglandin mediated diseases.
  • Also, WO03/104230 describes certain bicyclic pyrimidine derivatives, and US Published Application Serial No. 20030092908 and WO02/087513 describe fused heterocyclic PDE7 inhibitors.
  • U.S. Pat. Nos. 3,424,760 and 3,424,761 both describe a series of 3-ureidopyrrolidines that are said to exhibit analgesic, central nervous system, and pyschopharmacologic activities. These patents specifically disclose the compounds 1-(1-phenyl-3-pyrrolidinyl)-3-phenyl urea and 1-(1-phenyl-3-pyrrolidinyl)-3-(4-methoxyphenyl)urea respectively. International Patent Applications, Publication Numbers WO 01/62737 and WO 00/69849 disclose a series of pyrazole derivatives which are stated to be useful in the treatment of disorders and diseases associated with the NPY receptor subtype Y5, such as obesity. WO 01/62737 specifically discloses the compound 5-amino-N-isoquinolin-5-yl-1-[3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide. WO 00/69849 specifically discloses the compounds 5-methyl-N-quinolin-8-yl-1-[3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, 5-methyl-N-quinolin-7-yl-1-[3-trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, 5-methyl-N-quinolin-3-yl-1-[3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, N-isoquinolin-5-yl-5-methyl-1-[3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, 5-methyl-N-quinolin-5-yl-1-[3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, 1-(3-chlorophenyl)-N-isoquinolin-5-yl-5-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, N-isoquinolin-5-yl-1-(3-methoxyphenyl)-5-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, 1-(3-fluorophenyl)-N-isoquinolin-5-yl-5-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, 1-(2-chloro-5-trifluoromethylphenyl)-N-isoquinolin-5-yl-5-methyl-1N-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, 5-methyl-N-(3-methylisoquinolin-5-yl)-1-[3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1N-pyrazole-3-carboxamide, 5-methyl-N-(1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolin-5-yl)-1-[3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxamide.
  • German Patent Application Number 2502588 describes a series of piperazine derivatives. This application specifically discloses the compound N-[3-[2-(diethylamino)ethyl]-1,2-dihydro-4-methyl-2-oxo-7-quinolinyl]-4-phenyl-1-piperazinecarboxamide.
  • SUMMARY
  • Fused heterocylic compounds, and pharmaceutical compositions thereof, having potency and selectivity in the prevention and treatment of conditions that have been associated with neurological and inflammatory disorders and dysfunctions are provided herein.
  • In particular, compounds, pharmaceutical compositions and methods provided are useful to treat, prevent or ameliorate a range of conditions in mammals such as, but not limited to, pain of various genesis or etiology, for example acute, chronic, inflammatory and neuropathic pain, dental pain and headache (such as migraine, cluster headache and tension headache). In some embodiments, compounds, pharmaceutical compositions and methods provided are useful for the treatment of inflammatory pain and associated hyperalgesia and allodynia. In some embodiments, compounds, pharmaceutical compositions and methods provided are useful for the treatment of neuropathic pain and associated hyperalgesia and allodynia (e.g. trigeminal or herpetic neuralgia, diabetic neuropathy, causalgia, sympathetically maintained pain and deafferentation syndromes such as brachial plexus avulsion). In some embodiments, compounds, pharmaceutical compositions and methods provided are useful as anti-inflammatory agents for the treatment of arthritis, and as agents to treat Parkinson's Disease, Alzheimer's Disease, asthma, myocardial infarction, neurodegenerative disorders, inflammatory bowel disease and autoimmune disorders, renal disorders, obesity, eating disorders, cancer, schizophrenia, epilepsy, sleeping disorders, cognitive disorders, depression, anxiety, blood pressure, and lipid disorders.
  • Accordingly, in one aspect, compounds are provided that have formula 1:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00002
  • wherein
      • each of A, B, and W are independently selected from CR4 and N; provided that not all A, B, and W are N at the same time;
      • X′ is selected from CR4a and N;
      • L is substituted or unsubstituted C1-C9 alkylene or C1-C9 heteroalkylene;
      • R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, aryl, and heteroaryl;
      • R3 is substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered aryl, or substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered heteroaryl; or
        • R3 is substituted or unsubstituted N containing heterocycloalkyl; and the heterocycloalkyl is attached to the core group via the N;
      • each R4 is independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, substituted or unsubstituted amino, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, nitro, and thiol;
      • each R4a, and R4b is independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyloxy, substituted or unsubstituted amino, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol; and subscript m′ is selected from 0-4;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 1, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted aryl, or heteroaryl;
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 1, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted 4-7 membered heterocycloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 1, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 1, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 1, one of A, B, and W is N; and the rest are independently selected from CR4.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 1, each A, B, and W is independently selected from CR4.
  • In one particular embodiment, with respect to formula 1, each A, B, and W is CH.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 1, the compound is according to formula 2:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00003
  • wherein
      • X′, L, R1, R3, R4a; R4b, and m′ are as described for formula 1;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In another aspect, pharmaceutical compositions are provided comprising a fused heterocyclic compound provided herein, and a pharmaceutical carrier, excipient or diluent. The pharmaceutical composition can comprise one or more of the compounds described herein.
  • It will be understood that compounds provided herein useful in the pharmaceutical compositions and treatment methods disclosed herein, can be pharmaceutically acceptable as prepared and used.
  • In another aspect, methods are provided for preventing, treating or ameliorating a condition from among those listed herein, and particularly, such condition as may be associated with, e.g., arthritis, asthma, myocardial infarction, lipid disorders, cognitive disorders, anxiety, schizophrenia, depression, memory dysfunctions such as Alzheimers disease, inflammatory bowel disease and autoimmune disorders, which method comprises administering to a mammal in need thereof an amount of one or more of the compounds as provided herein, or pharmaceutical composition thereof, effective to prevent, treat or ameliorate the condition.
  • In yet another aspect, methods are provided for preventing, treating or ameliorating a condition that gives rise to pain responses or that relates to imbalances in the maintenance of basal activity of sensory nerves in a mammal. The compounds provided herein have use as analgesics for the treatment of pain of various geneses or etiology, for example acute, inflammatory pain (such as pain associated with osteoarthritis and rheumatoid arthritis); various neuropathic pain syndromes (such as post-herpetic neuralgia, trigeminal neuralgia, reflex sympathetic dystrophy, diabetic neuropathy, Guillian Barre syndrome, fibromyalgia, phantom limb pain, post-masectomy pain, peripheral neuropathy, HIV neuropathy, and chemotherapy-induced and other iatrogenic neuropathies); visceral pain, (such as that associated with gastroesophageal reflex disease, irritable bowel syndrome, inflammatory bowel disease, pancreatitis, and various gynecological and urological disorders), dental pain and headache (such as migraine, cluster headache and tension headache).
  • In one aspect, methods are provided for preventing, treating or ameliorating a neurodegenerative disease or disorder in a mammal. A neurodegenerative disease or disorder can, for example, be Parkinson's disease, Alzheimer's disease and multiple sclerosis; diseases and disorders which are mediated by or result in neuroinflammation such as, for example, encephalitis; centrally-mediated neuropsychiatric diseases and disorders such as, for example, depression mania, bipolar disease, anxiety, schizophrenia, eating disorders, sleep disorders and cognition disorders; epilepsy and seizure disorders; prostate, bladder and bowel dysfunction such as, for example urinary incontinence, urinary hesitancy, rectal hypersensitivity, fecal incontinence, benign prostatic hypertrophy and inflammatory bowel disease; respiratory and airway disease and disorders such as, for example, allergic rhinitis, asthma and reactive airway disease and chronic obstructive pulmonary disease; diseases and disorders which are mediated by or result in inflammation such as, for example rheumatoid arthritis and osteoarthritis, myocardial infarction, various autoimmune diseases and disorders; itch/pruritus such as, for example, psoriasis; obesity; lipid disorders; cancer; and renal disorders Typically, the methods comprise administering an effective condition-treating or condition-preventing amount of one or more of the compounds as provided herein, or pharmaceutical composition thereof, to the mammal in need thereof.
  • In addition to the methods of treatment set forth above, the present invention extends to the use of any of the compounds of the invention for the preparation of medicaments that may be administered for such treatments, as well as to such compounds for the treatments disclosed and specified.
  • In additional aspects, methods are provided for synthesizing the compounds described herein, with representative synthetic protocols and pathways described below. In certain embodiments, provided are methods of making enantiomerically pure compounds according to formula 1 by asymmetric synthesis. In certain embodiments, provided are methods of making enantiomerically pure compounds according to formula 1 by chiral resolution.
  • Accordingly, it is a principal object of this invention to provide a novel series of compounds, which can modify the activity of the P2X3 receptor and thus avert or treat any maladies that may be causally related thereto.
  • It is further an object of this invention to provide a series of compounds that can treat or alleviate maladies or symptoms of same, such as pain and inflammation, that may be causally related to the activation of the P2X3 receptor.
  • A still further object of this invention is to provide pharmaceutical compositions that are effective in the treatment or prevention of a variety of disease states, including the diseases associated with the central nervous system, cardiovascular conditions, chronic pulmonary obstructive disease COPD), inflammatory bowel disease, rheumatoid arthritis, osteoarthritis, and other diseases where an inflammatory component is present.
  • Other objects and advantages will become apparent to those skilled in the art from a consideration of the ensuing detailed description.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE PREFERRED EMBODIMENTS Definitions
  • The following terms are intended to have the meanings presented therewith below and are useful in understanding the description and intended scope of the present invention.
  • When describing the invention, which may include compounds, pharmaceutical compositions containing such compounds and methods of using such compounds and compositions, the following terms, if present, have the following meanings unless otherwise indicated. It should also be understood that when described herein any of the moieties defined forth below may be substituted with a variety of substituents, and that the respective definitions are intended to include such substituted moieties within their scope as set out below. Unless otherwise stated, the term “substituted” is to be defined as set out below. It should be further understood that the terms “groups” and “radicals” can be considered interchangeable when used herein.
  • The articles “a” and “an” may be used herein to refer to one or to more than one (i.e. at least one) of the grammatical objects of the article. By way of example “an analogue” means one analogue or more than one analogue.
  • ‘Acyl’ or ‘Alkanoyl’ refers to a radical —C(O)R20, where R20 is hydrogen, C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkylmethyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl as defined herein. Representative examples include, but are not limited to, formyl, acetyl, cyclohexylcarbonyl, cyclohexylmethylcarbonyl, benzoyl and benzylcarbonyl. Exemplary ‘acyl’ groups are —C(O)H, —C(O)—C1-C8 alkyl, —C(O)—(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —C(O)—(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —C(O)—(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —C(O)—(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4.
  • ‘Substituted Acyl’ or ‘Substituted Alkanoyl’ refers to a radical —C(O)R21, wherein R21 is independently
      • C1-C8 alkyl, substituted with halo or hydroxy; or
      • C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl, each of which is substituted with unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • ‘Acylamino’ refers to a radical —NR22C(O)R23, where R22 is hydrogen, C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl and R23 is hydrogen, C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl, as defined herein. Exemplary ‘acylamino’ include, but are not limited to, formylamino, acetylamino, cyclohexylcarbonylamino, cyclohexylmethyl-carbonylamino, benzoylamino and benzylcarbonylamino. Particular exemplary ‘acylamino’ groups are —NR24C(O)—C1-C8 alkyl, —NR24C(O)—(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —NR24C(O)—(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —NR24C(O)—(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —NR24C(O)—(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4, and each R24 independently represents H or C1-C8 alkyl.
  • ‘Substituted Acylamino’ refers to a radical —NR25C(O)R26, wherein:
  • R25 is independently
      • H, C1-C8 alkyl, substituted with halo or hydroxy; or
      • C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl, each of which is substituted with unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy; and
  • R26 is independently
      • H, C1-C8 alkyl, substituted with halo or hydroxy; or
      • C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl, each of which is substituted with unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxyl;
  • provided at least one of R25 and R26 is other than H.
  • ‘Acyloxy’ refers to a radical —OC(O)R27, where R27 is hydrogen, C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkylmethyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl as defined herein. Representative examples include, but are not limited to, formyl, acetyl, cyclohexylcarbonyl, cyclohexylmethylcarbonyl, benzoyl and benzylcarbonyl. Exemplary ‘acyl’ groups are —C(O)H, —C(O)—C1-C8 alkyl, —C(O)—(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —C(O)—(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —C(O)—(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —C(O)—(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4.
  • ‘Substituted Acyloxy’ refers to a radical —OC(O)R28, wherein R28 is independently
      • C1-C8 alkyl, substituted with halo or hydroxy; or
      • C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl, each of which is substituted with unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • ‘Alkoxy’ refers to the group —OR29 where R29 is C1-C8 alkyl. Particular alkoxy groups are methoxy, ethoxy, n-propoxy, isopropoxy, n-butoxy, tert-butoxy, sec-butoxy, n-pentoxy, n-hexoxy, and 1,2-dimethylbutoxy. Particular alkoxy groups are lower alkoxy, i.e. with between 1 and 6 carbon atoms. Further particular alkoxy groups have between 1 and 4 carbon atoms.
  • ‘Substituted alkoxy’ refers to an alkoxy group substituted with one or more of those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to an alkoxy group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, in particular 1 substituent, selected from the group consisting of amino, substituted amino, C6-C10 aryl, aryloxy, carboxyl, cyano, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, halogen, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, hydroxyl, nitro, thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thiol, alkyl-S(O)—, aryl-S(O)—, alkyl-S(O)2— and aryl-S(O)2—. Exemplary ‘substituted alkoxy’ groups are —O—(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —O—(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —O—(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —O—(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4 and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy. Particular exemplary ‘substituted alkoxy’ groups are OCF3, OCH2CF3, OCH2Ph, OCH2-cyclopropyl, OCH2CH2OH, and OCH2CH2NMe2.
  • ‘Alkoxycarbonyl’ refers to a radical —C(O)—OR30 where R30 represents an C1-Cs alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkylalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkylalkyl, aralkyl, or 5-10 membered heteroarylalkyl as defined herein. Exemplary “alkoxycarbonyl” groups are C(O)O—C1-C8 alkyl, —C(O)O—(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —C(O)O—(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —C(O)O—(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —C(O)O—(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 1 to 4.
  • ‘Substituted Alkoxycarbonyl’ refers to a radical —C(O)—OR31 where R31 represents:
      • C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkylalkyl, or 4-10 membered heterocycloalkylalkyl, each of which is substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy; or
      • C6-C10 aralkyl, or 5-10 membered heteroarylalkyl, each of which is substituted with unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxyl.
  • ‘Aryloxycarbonyl’ refers to a radical —C(O)—OR32 where R32 represents an C6-C10 aryl, as defined herein. Exemplary “aryloxycarbonyl” groups is —C(O)O—(C6-C10 aryl).
  • ‘Substituted Aryloxycarbonyl’ refers to a radical —C(O)—OR33 where R33 represents
      • C6-C10 aryl, substituted with unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxyl.
  • ‘Heteroaryloxycarbonyl’ refers to a radical —C(O)—OR34 where R34 represents a 5-10 membered heteroaryl, as defined herein. An exemplary “aryloxycarbonyl” group is —C(O)O-(5-10 membered heteroaryl).
  • ‘Substituted Heteroaryloxycarbonyl’ refers to a radical —C(O)—OR35 where R35 represents:
      • 5-10 membered heteroaryl, substituted with unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxyl.
  • ‘Alkoxycarbonylamino’ refers to the group —NR36C(O)OR32, where R36 is hydrogen, C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkylmethyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl as defined herein, and R37 is C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkylmethyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl as defined herein.
  • ‘Alkyl’ means straight or branched aliphatic hydrocarbon having 1 to 20 carbon atoms. Particular alkyl has 1 to 12 carbon atoms. More particular is lower alkyl which has 1 to 6 carbon atoms. A further particular group has 1 to 4 carbon atoms. Exemplary straight chained groups include methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, and n-butyl. Branched means that one or more lower alkyl groups such as methyl, ethyl, propyl or butyl is attached to a linear alkyl chain, exemplary branched chain groups include isopropyl, iso-butyl, t-butyl and isoamyl.
  • ‘Substituted alkyl’ refers to an alkyl group as defined above substituted with one or more of those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to an alkyl group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, in particular 1 substituent, selected from the group consisting of acyl, acylamino, acyloxy (—O-acyl or —OC(O)R20), alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxycarbonylamino (—NR″-alkoxycarbonyl or —NH—C(O)—OR27), amino, substituted amino, aminocarbonyl (carbamoyl or amido or —C(O)—NR″2), aminocarbonylamino (—NR″—C(O)—NR″2), aminocarbonyloxy (—O—C(O)—NR″2), aminosulfonyl, sulfonylamino, aryl, aryloxy, azido, carboxyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxy, heteroaryl, nitro, thiol, —S-alkyl, —S-aryl, —S(O)-alkyl, —S(O)-aryl, —S(O)2-alkyl, and —S(O)2-aryl. In a particular embodiment ‘substituted alkyl’ refers to a C1-Cs alkyl group substituted with halo, cyano, nitro, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, azido, —NR′″SO2R″, —SO2NR″R′″, —C(O)R″, —C(O)OR″, —OC(O)R″, —NR′″C(O)R″, —C(O)NR″R′″, —NR″R′″, or —(CR′″R″″)mOR′″; wherein each R″ is independently selected from H, C1-C8 alkyl, —(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4 and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy. Each of R′″ and R″″ independently represents H or C1-C8 alkyl.
  • ‘Alkylene’ refers to divalent saturated alkene radical groups having 1 to 11 carbon atoms and more particularly 1 to 6 carbon atoms which can be straight-chained or branched. This term is exemplified by groups such as methylene (—CH2—), ethylene (—CH2CH2—), the propylene isomers (e.g., —CH2CH2CH2— and —CH(CH3)CH2—) and the like.
  • ‘Substituted alkylene’ refers to those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to an alkylene group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, selected from the group consisting of acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxycarbonylamino, amino, substituted amino, aminocarbonyl, amino-carbonylamino, aminocarbonyloxy, aryl, aryloxy, azido, carboxyl, cyano, halogen, hydroxyl, keto, nitro, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioketo, thiol, alkyl-S(O)—, aryl-S(O)—, alkyl-S(O)2— and aryl-S(O)2—.
  • ‘Alkenyl’ refers to monovalent olefinically unsaturated hydrocarbyl groups preferably having 2 to 11 carbon atoms, particularly, from 2 to 8 carbon atoms, and more particularly, from 2 to 6 carbon atoms, which can be straight-chained or branched and having at least 1 and particularly from 1 to 2 sites of olefinic unsaturation. Particular alkenyl groups include ethenyl (—CH═CH2), n-propenyl (—CH2CH═CH2), isopropenyl (—C(CH3)═CH2), vinyl and substituted vinyl, and the like.
  • ‘Substituted alkenyl’ refers to those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to an alkenyl group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, selected from the group consisting of acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxycarbonylamino, amino, substituted amino, aminocarbonyl, aminocarbonylamino, aminocarbonyloxy, aryl, aryloxy, azido, carboxyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, substituted cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, keto, nitro, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioketo, thiol, alkyl-S(O)—, aryl-S(O)—, alkyl-S(O)2— and aryl-S(O)2—.
  • ‘Alkenylene’ refers to divalent olefinically unsaturated hydrocarbyl groups particularly having up to about 11 carbon atoms and more particularly 2 to 6 carbon atoms which can be straight-chained or branched and having at least 1 and particularly from 1 to 2 sites of olefinic unsaturation. This term is exemplified by groups such as ethenylene (—CH═CH—), the propenylene isomers (e.g., —CH═CHCH2— and —C(CH3)═CH— and —CH═C(CH3)—) and the like.
  • ‘Alkynyl’ refers to acetylenically or alkynically unsaturated hydrocarbyl groups particularly having 2 to 11 carbon atoms, and more particularly 2 to 6 carbon atoms which can be straight-chained or branched and having at least 1 and particularly from 1 to 2 sites of alkynyl unsaturation. Particular non-limiting examples of alkynyl groups include acetylenic, ethynyl (—C≡CH), propargyl (—CH2C≡CH), and the like.
  • ‘Substituted alkynyl’ refers to those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to an alkynyl group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, selected from the group consisting of acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxycarbonylamino, amino, substituted amino, aminocarbonyl, aminocarbonylamino, aminocarbonyloxy, aryl, aryloxy, azido, carboxyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, substituted cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, keto, nitro, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioketo, thiol, alkyl-S(O)—, aryl-S(O)—, alkyl-S(O)2— and aryl-S(O)2—.
  • ‘Amino’ refers to the radical —NH2.
  • ‘Substituted amino’ refers to an amino group substituted with one or more of those groups recited in the definition of ‘substituted’ herein, and particularly refers to the group —N(R38)2 where each R38 is independently selected from:
      • hydrogen, C1-C8 alkyl, C6-C10 aryl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, or C3-C10 cycloalkyl; or
      • C1-C8 alkyl, substituted with halo or hydroxy; or
      • —(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl) or —(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl) wherein t is an integer between 0 and 8, each of which is substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy; or
      • both R38 groups are joined to form an alkylene group.
        When both R38 groups are hydrogen, —N(R38)2 is an amino group. Exemplary ‘substituted amino’ groups are —NR39—C1-C8 alkyl, —NR39—(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —NR39—(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —NR39—(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —NR39—(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4, each R39 independently represents H or C1-C8 alkyl; and any alkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy; and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy. For the avoidance of doubt the term “substituted amino” includes the groups alkylamino, substituted alkylamino, alkylarylamino, substituted alkylarylamino, arylamino, substituted arylamino, dialkylamino and substituted dialkylamino as defined below.
  • ‘Alkylamino’ refers to the group —NHR40, wherein R40 is C1-C8 alkyl.
  • ‘Substituted Alkylamino’ refers to the group —NHR41, wherein R41 is C1-C8 alkyl; and the alkyl group is substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, hydroxy, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, aralkyl or heteroaralkyl; and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • ‘Alkylarylamino’ refers to the group —NR42R43, wherein R42 is aryl and R43 is C1-C8 alkyl.
  • ‘Substituted Alkylarylamino’ refers to the group —NR44R45, wherein R44 is aryl and R45 is C1-C8 alkyl; and the alkyl group is substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, hydroxy, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, aralkyl or heteroaralkyl; and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, cyano, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • ‘Arylamino’ means a radical —NHR46 where R46 is selected from C6-C10 aryl and 5-10 membered heteroaryl as defined herein.
  • ‘Substituted Arylamino’ refers to the group —NHR47, wherein R47 is independently selected from C6-C10 aryl and 5-10 membered heteroaryl; and any aryl or heteroaryl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, cyano, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • ‘Dialkylamino’ refers to the group —NR48R49, wherein each of R48 and R49 are independently selected from C1-C8 alkyl.
  • ‘Substituted Dialkylamino’ refers to the group —NR50R51, wherein each of R59 and R51 are independently selected from C1-C8 alkyl; and at least one of the alkyl groups is independently substituted with halo, hydroxy, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, aralkyl or heteroaralkyl; and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • ‘Diarylamino’ refers to the group —NR52R53, wherein each of R52 and R53 are independently selected from C6-C10 aryl.
  • ‘Aminosulfonyl’ or ‘Sulfonamide’ refers to the radical —S(O2)NH2.
  • ‘Substituted aminosulfonyl’ or ‘substituted sulfonamide’ refers to a radical such as —S(O2)N(R54)2 wherein each R548 is independently selected from:
      • H, C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, and heteroaralkyl; or
      • C1-C8 alkyl substituted with halo or hydroxy; or
      • C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, or heteroaralkyl, each of which is substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy;
        provided that at least one R54 is other than H.
  • Exemplary ‘substituted aminosulfonyl’ or ‘substituted sulfonamide’ groups are —S(O2)N(R55)—C1-C8 alkyl, —S(O2)N(R55)—(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —S(O2)N(R55)—(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —S(O2)N(R55)—(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —S(O2)N(R55)—(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4; each R55 independently represents H or C1-C8 alkyl; and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • ‘Aralkyl’ or ‘arylalkyl’ refers to an alkyl group, as defined above, substituted with one or more aryl groups, as defined above. Particular aralkyl or arylalkyl groups are alkyl groups substituted with one aryl group.
  • ‘Substituted Aralkyl’ or ‘substituted arylalkyl’ refers to an alkyl group, as defined above, substituted with one or more aryl groups; and at least one of the aryl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, cyano, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • ‘Aryl’ refers to a monovalent aromatic hydrocarbon group derived by the removal of one hydrogen atom from a single carbon atom of a parent aromatic ring system. In particular aryl refers to an aromatic ring structure, mono-cyclic or poly-cyclic that includes from 5 to 12 ring members, more usually 6 to 10. Where the aryl group is a monocyclic ring system it preferentially contains 6 carbon atoms. Typical aryl groups include, but are not limited to, groups derived from aceanthrylene, acenaphthylene, acephenanthrylene, anthracene, azulene, benzene, chrysene, coronene, fluoranthene, fluorene, hexacene, hexaphene, hexylene, as-indacene, s-indacene, indane, indene, naphthalene, octacene, octaphene, octalene, ovalene, penta-2,4-diene, pentacene, pentalene, pentaphene, perylene, phenalene, phenanthrene, picene, pleiadene, pyrene, pyranthrene, rubicene, triphenylene and trinaphthalene. Particularly aryl groups include phenyl, naphthyl, indenyl, and tetrahydronaphthyl.
  • ‘Substituted Aryl’ refers to an aryl group substituted with one or more of those groups recited in the definition of ‘substituted’ herein, and particularly refers to an aryl group that may optionally be substituted with 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, particularly 1 to 3 substituents, in particular 1 substituent. Particularly, ‘Substituted Aryl’ refers to an aryl group substituted with one or more of groups selected from halo, C1-C8 alkyl, C1-C8 haloalkyl, cyano, hydroxy, C1-C8 alkoxy, and amino.
  • Examples of representative substituted aryls include the following
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00004
  • In these formulae one of R56 and R57 may be hydrogen and at least one of R56 and R57 is each independently selected from C1-C8 alkyl, C1-C8 haloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, alkanoyl, C1-C8 alkoxy, heteroaryloxy, alkylamino, arylamino, heteroarylamino, NR58COR59, NR58SOR59NR58SO2R59, COOalkyl, COOaryl, CONR58R59, CONR58OR59, NR58R59, SO2NR58R59, S-alkyl, SOalkyl, SO2alkyl, Saryl, SOaryl, SO2aryl; or R56 and R57 may be joined to form a cyclic ring (saturated or unsaturated) from 5 to 8 atoms, optionally containing one or more heteroatoms selected from the group N, O or S. R60 and R61 are independently hydrogen, C1-C8 alkyl, C1-C4 haloalkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, substituted aryl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl.
  • ‘Fused Aryl’ refers to an aryl having two of its ring carbon in common with a second aryl ring or with an aliphatic ring.
  • ‘Arylalkyloxy’ refers to an —O-alkylaryl radical where alkylaryl is as defined herein.
  • ‘Substituted Arylalkyloxy’ refers to an —O-alkylaryl radical where alkylaryl is as defined herein; and any aryl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, cyano, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • ‘Azido’ refers to the radical —N3.
  • ‘Carbamoyl or amido’ refers to the radical —C(O)NH2.
  • ‘Substituted Carbamoyl or substituted amido’ refers to the radical —C(O)N(R62)2 wherein each R62 is independently
      • H, C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, and heteroaralkyl; or
      • C1-C8 alkyl substituted with halo or hydroxy; or
      • C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, or heteroaralkyl, each of which is substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy;
        provided that at least one R62 is other than H.
        Exemplary ‘Substituted Carbamoyl’ groups are —C(O)NR64—C1-C8 alkyl, —C(O)NR64—(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —C(O)N64—(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —C(O)NR64—(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —C(O)NR64—(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4, each R64 independently represents H or C1-C8 alkyl and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • ‘Carboxy’ refers to the radical —C(O)OH.
  • ‘Cycloalkyl’ refers to cyclic non-aromatic hydrocarbyl groups having from 3 to 10 carbon atoms. Such cycloalkyl groups include, by way of example, single ring structures such as cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, and cyclooctyl.
  • ‘Substituted cycloalkyl’ refers to a cycloalkyl group as defined above substituted with one or more of those groups recited in the definition of ‘substituted’ herein, and particularly refers to a cycloalkyl group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, in particular 1 substituent
  • ‘Cyano’ refers to the radical —CN.
  • ‘Halo’ or ‘halogen’ refers to fluoro (F), chloro (Cl), bromo (Br) and iodo (I). Particular halo groups are either fluoro or chloro.
  • ‘Hetero’ when used to describe a compound or a group present on a compound means that one or more carbon atoms in the compound or group have been replaced by a nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur heteroatom. Hetero may be applied to any of the hydrocarbyl groups described above such as alkyl, e.g. heteroalkyl, cycloalkyl, e.g. heterocycloalkyl, aryl, e.g. heteroaryl, cycloalkenyl, e.g. cycloheteroalkenyl, and the like having from 1 to 5, and particularly from 1 to 3 heteroatoms.
  • ‘Heteroaryl’ means an aromatic ring structure, mono-cyclic or polycyclic, that includes one or more heteroatoms and 5 to 12 ring members, more usually 5 to 10 ring members. The heteroaryl group can be, for example, a five membered or six membered monocyclic ring or a bicyclic structure formed from fused five and six membered rings or two fused six membered rings or, by way of a further example, two fused five membered rings. Each ring may contain up to four heteroatoms typically selected from nitrogen, sulphur and oxygen. Typically the heteroaryl ring will contain up to 4 heteroatoms, more typically up to 3 heteroatoms, more usually up to 2, for example a single heteroatom. In one embodiment, the heteroaryl ring contains at least one ring nitrogen atom. The nitrogen atoms in the heteroaryl rings can be basic, as in the case of an imidazole or pyridine, or essentially non-basic as in the case of an indole or pyrrole nitrogen. In general the number of basic nitrogen atoms present in the heteroaryl group, including any amino group substituents of the ring, will be less than five. Examples of five membered monocyclic heteroaryl groups include but are not limited to pyrrole, furan, thiophene, imidazole, furazan, oxazole, oxadiazole, oxatriazole, isoxazole, thiazole, isothiazole, pyrazole, triazole and tetrazole groups. Examples of six membered monocyclic heteroaryl groups include but are not limited to pyridine, pyrazine, pyridazine, pyrimidine and triazine. Particular examples of bicyclic heteroaryl groups containing a five membered ring fused to another five membered ring include but are not limited to imidazothiazole and imidazoimidazole. Particular examples of bicyclic heteroaryl groups containing a six membered ring fused to a five membered ring include but are not limited to benzfuran, benzthiophene, benzimidazole, benzoxazole, isobenzoxazole, benzisoxazole, benzthiazole, benzisothiazole, isobenzofuran, indole, isoindole, isoindolone, indolizine, indoline, isoindoline, purine (e.g., adenine, guanine), indazole, pyrazolopyrimidine, triazolopyrimidine, benzodioxole and pyrazolopyridine groups. Particular examples of bicyclic heteroaryl groups containing two fused six membered rings include but are not limited to quinoline, isoquinoline, chroman, thiochroman, chromene, isochromene, chroman, isochroman, benzodioxan, quinolizine, benzoxazine, benzodiazine, pyridopyridine, quinoxaline, quinazoline, cinnoline, phthalazine, naphthyridine and pteridine groups. Particular heteroaryl groups are those derived from thiophene, pyrrole, benzothiophene, benzofuran, indole, pyridine, quinoline, imidazole, oxazole and pyrazine.
  • Examples of representative heteroaryls include the following:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00005
  • wherein each Y is selected from carbonyl, N, NR65, O and S; and R65 is independently hydrogen, C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, and 5-10 membered heteroaryl.
  • Examples of representative aryl having hetero atoms containing substitution include the following:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00006
  • wherein each W is selected from C(R66)2, NR66, O and S; and each Y is selected from carbonyl, NR66, O and S; and R66 is independently hydrogen, C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, and 5-10 membered heteroaryl.
  • As used herein, the term ‘heterocycloalkyl’ refers to a 4-10 membered, stable heterocyclic non-aromatic ring and/or including rings containing one or more heteroatoms independently selected from N, O and S, fused thereto. A fused heterocyclic ring system may include carbocyclic rings and need only include one heterocyclic ring. Examples of heterocyclic rings include, but are not limited to, morpholine, piperidine (e.g. 1-piperidinyl, 2-piperidinyl, 3-piperidinyl and 4-piperidinyl), pyrrolidine (e.g. 1-pyrrolidinyl, 2-pyrrolidinyl and 3-pyrrolidinyl), pyrrolidone, pyran (2H-pyran or 4H-pyran), dihydrothiophene, dihydropyran, dihydropyran, dihydrothiazole, tetrahydrofuran, tetrahydrothiophene, dioxane, tetrahydropyran (e.g. 4-tetrahydro pyranyl), imidazoline, imidazolidinone, oxazoline, thiazoline, 2-pyrazoline, pyrazolidine, piperazine, and N-alkyl piperazines such as N-methyl piperazine. Further examples include thiomorpholine and its S-oxide and S,S-dioxide (particularly thiomorpholine). Still further examples include azetidine, piperidone, piperazone, and N-alkyl piperidines such as N-methyl piperidine. Particular examples of heterocycloalkyl groups are shown in the following illustrative examples:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00007
  • wherein each W is selected from CR67, C(R67)2, NR67, O and S; and each Y is selected from NR67, O and S; and R67 is independently hydrogen, C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, These heterocycloalkyl rings may be optionally substituted with one or more groups selected from the group consisting of acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxycarbonylamino, amino, substituted amino, aminocarbonyl (carbamoyl or amido), aminocarbonylamino, aminosulfonyl, sulfonylamino, aryl, aryloxy, azido, carboxyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxy, keto, nitro, thiol, —S-alkyl, —S-aryl, —S(O)-alkyl, —S(O)-aryl, —S(O)2-alkyl, and —S(O)2-aryl. Substituting groups include carbonyl or thiocarbonyl which provide, for example, lactam and urea derivatives.
  • ‘Hydroxy’ refers to the radical —OH.
  • ‘Nitro’ refers to the radical —NO2.
  • ‘Substituted’ refers to a group in which one or more hydrogen atoms are each independently replaced with the same or different substituent(s). Typical substituents may be selected from the group consisting of:
  • halogen, —R68, —O, ═O, —OR68, —SR68, —S, ═S, —NR68R69, ═NR68, —CCl3, —CF3, —CN, —OCN, —SCN, —NO, —NO2, ═N2, —N3, —S(O)2O, —S(O)2OH, —S(O)2R68, —OS(O2)O, —OS(O)2R68, —P(O)(O)2, —P(O)(OR68)(O), —OP(O)(OR68)(OR69), —C(O)R68, —C(S)R68, —C(O)OR68, —C(O)NR68R69, —C(O)O, —C(S)OR68, —NR70C(O)NR68R69, —NR70C(S)NR68R69, NR71C(NR70)NR68R69 and —C(NR70)NR68R69;
    wherein each R68, R69, R70 and R71 are independently:
      • hydrogen, C1-C8 alkyl, C6-C10 aryl, arylalkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, heteroarylalkyl; or
      • C1-C8 alkyl substituted with halo or hydroxy; or
      • C6-C10 aryl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, C6-C10 cycloalkyl or 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl each of which is substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
        In a particular embodiment, substituted groups are substituted with one or more substituents, particularly with 1 to 3 substituents, in particular with one substituent group.
  • In a further particular embodiment the substituent group or groups are selected from halo, cyano, nitro, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, azido, —NR72SO2R73, —SO2NR73R72, —C(O)R73, —C(O)OR73, —OC(O)R73, —NR72C(O)R73, —C(O)NR73R72, —NR73R72, —(CR72R72)mOR72, wherein, each R73 is independently selected from H, C1-C8 alkyl, —(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4; and
      • any alkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by halo or hydroxy; and
      • any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy. Each R″ independently represents H or C1-C6alkyl.
  • ‘Substituted sulfanyl’ refers to the group —SR74, wherein R74 is selected from:
      • C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, and heteroaralkyl; or
      • C1-C8 alkyl substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy; or
      • C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, or heteroaralkyl, each of which is substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • Exemplary ‘substituted sulfanyl’ groups are —S—(C1-C8 alkyl) and —S—(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), —S—(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —S—(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —S—(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —S—(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4 and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy. The term ‘substituted sulfanyl’ includes the groups ‘alkylsulfanyl’ or ‘alkylthio’, ‘substituted alkylthio’ or ‘substituted alkylsulfanyl’, ‘cycloalkylsulfanyl’ or ‘cycloalkylthio’, ‘substituted cycloalkylsulfanyl’ or ‘substituted cycloalkylthio’, ‘arylsulfanyl’ or ‘arylthio’ and ‘heteroarylsulfanyl’ or ‘heteroarylthio’ as defined below.
  • ‘Alkylthio’ or ‘Alkylsulfanyl’ refers to a radical —SR75 where R75 is a C1-C8 alkyl or group as defined herein. Representative examples include, but are not limited to, methylthio, ethylthio, propylthio and butylthio.
  • ‘Substituted Alkylthio’ or ‘substituted alkylsulfanyl’ refers to the group —SR76 where R76 is a C1-C8 alkyl, substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy.
  • ‘Cycloalkylthio’ or ‘Cycloalkylsulfanyl’ refers to a radical —SR77 where R77 is a C3-C10 cycloalkyl or group as defined herein. Representative examples include, but are not limited to, cyclopropylthio, cyclohexylthio, and cyclopentylthio.
  • ‘Substituted cycloalkylthio’ or ‘substituted cycloalkylsulfanyl’ refers to the group —SR78 where R78 is a C3-C10 cycloalkyl, substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy.
  • ‘Arylthio’ or ‘Arylsulfanyl’ refers to a radical —SR79 where R79 is a C6-C10 aryl group as defined herein.
  • ‘Heteroarylthio’ or ‘Heteroarylsulfanyl’ refers to a radical —SR80 where R80 is a 5-10 membered heteroaryl group as defined herein.
  • ‘Substituted sulfinyl’ refers to the group —S(O)R81, wherein R81 is selected from:
      • C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, and heteroaralkyl; or
      • C1-C8 alkyl substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy; or
      • C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, or heteroaralkyl, each of which is substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • Exemplary ‘substituted sulfinyl’ groups are —S(O)—(C1-C8 alkyl) and —S(O)—(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), —S(O)—(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —S(O)—(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —S(O)—(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —S(O)—(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4 and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy. The term substituted sulfinyl includes the groups ‘alkylsulfinyl’, ‘substituted alkylsulfinyl’, ‘cycloalkylsulfinyl’, ‘substituted cycloalkylsulfinyl’, ‘arylsulfinyl’ and ‘heteroarylsulfinyl’ as defined herein.
  • ‘Alkylsulfinyl’ refers to a radical —S(O)R82 where R82 is a C1-C8 alkyl group as defined herein. Representative examples include, but are not limited to, methylsulfinyl, ethylsulfinyl, propylsulfinyl and butylsulfinyl.
  • ‘Substituted Alkylsulfinyl’ refers to a radical —S(O)R83 where R83 is a C1-C8 alkyl group as defined herein, substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy.
  • ‘Cycloalkylsulfinyl’ refers to a radical —S(O)R84 where R84 is a C3-C10 cycloalkyl or group as defined herein. Representative examples include, but are not limited to, cyclopropylsulfinyl, cyclohexylsulfinyl, and cyclopentylsulfinyl. Exemplary ‘cycloalkylsulfinyl’ groups are S(O)—C3-C10 cycloalkyl.
  • ‘Substituted cycloalkylsulfinyl’ refers to the group —S(O)R85 where R85 is a C3-C10 cycloalkyl, substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy.
  • ‘Arylsulfinyl’ refers to a radical —S(O)R86 where R86 is a C6-C10 aryl group as defined herein.
  • ‘Heteroarylsulfinyl’ refers to a radical —S(O)R87 where R87 is a 5-10 membered heteroaryl group as defined herein.
  • ‘Substituted sulfonyl’ refers to the group —S(O)2R88, wherein R88 is selected from:
      • C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, and heteroaralkyl; or
      • C1-C8 alkyl substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy; or
      • C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, or heteroaralkyl, each of which is substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • Exemplary ‘substituted sulfonyl’ groups are —S(O)2—(C1-C8 alkyl) and —S(O)2—(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), —S(O)2—(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —S(O)2—(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —S(O)2—(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —S(O)2—(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4 and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy. The term substituted sulfonyl includes the groups alkylsulfonyl, substituted alkylsulfonyl, cycloalkylsulfonyl, substituted cycloalkylsulfonyl, arylsulfonyl and heteroarylsulfonyl.
  • ‘Alkylsulfonyl’ refers to a radical —S(O)2R89 where R89 is an C1-C8 alkyl group as defined herein. Representative examples include, but are not limited to, methylsulfonyl, ethylsulfonyl, propylsulfonyl and butylsulfonyl.
  • ‘Substituted Alkylsulfonyl’ refers to a radical —S(O)2R90 where R90 is an C1-C8 alkyl group as defined herein, substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy.
  • ‘Cycloalkylsulfonyl’ refers to a radical —S(O)2R91 where R90 is a C3-C10 cycloalkyl or group as defined herein. Representative examples include, but are not limited to, cyclopropylsulfonyl, cyclohexylsulfonyl, and cyclopentylsulfonyl.
  • ‘Substituted cycloalkylsulfonyl’ refers to the group —S(O)2R92 where R92 is a C3-C10 cycloalkyl, substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy.
  • ‘Arylsulfonyl’ refers to a radical —S(O)2R93 where R93 is an C6-C10 aryl group as defined herein.
  • ‘Heteroarylsulfonyl’ refers to a radical —S(O)2R94 where R94 is an 5-10 membered heteroaryl group as defined herein.
  • ‘Sulfo’ or ‘sulfonic acid’ refers to a radical such as —SO3H.
  • ‘Substituted sulfo’ or ‘sulfonic acid ester’ refers to the group —S(O)2OR95, wherein R95 is selected from:
      • C1-C8 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, and heteroaralkyl; or
      • C1-C8 alkyl substituted with halo, substituted or unsubstituted amino, or hydroxy; or
      • C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, or heteroaralkyl, each of which is substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • Exemplary ‘Substituted sulfo’ or ‘sulfonic acid ester’ groups are —S(O)2—O—(C1-C8 alkyl) and —S(O)2—O—(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), —S(O)2—O—(CH2)t(C6-C10 aryl), —S(O)2—O—(CH2)t(5-10 membered heteroaryl), —S(O)2—O—(CH2)t(C3-C10 cycloalkyl), and —S(O)2—O—(CH2)t(4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl), wherein t is an integer from 0 to 4 and any aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl groups present, may themselves be substituted by unsubstituted C1-C4 alkyl, halo, unsubstituted C1-C4 alkoxy, unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkyl, unsubstituted C1-C4 hydroxyalkyl, or unsubstituted C1-C4 haloalkoxy or hydroxy.
  • ‘Thiol’ refers to the group —SH.
  • ‘Aminocarbonylamino’ refers to the group —NR96C(O)NR96R96 where each R96 is independently hydrogen C1-C3 alkyl, C3-C10 cycloalkyl, 4-10 membered heterocycloalkyl, C6-C10 aryl, aralkyl, 5-10 membered heteroaryl, and heteroaralkyl, as defined herein; or where two R96 groups, when attached to the same N, are joined to form an alkylene group.
  • ‘Bicycloaryl’ refers to a monovalent aromatic hydrocarbon group derived by the removal of one hydrogen atom from a single carbon atom of a parent bicycloaromatic ring system. Typical bicycloaryl groups include, but are not limited to, groups derived from indane, indene, naphthalene, tetrahydronaphthalene, and the like. Particularly, an aryl group comprises from 8 to 11 carbon atoms.
  • ‘Bicycloheteroaryl’ refers to a monovalent bicycloheteroaromatic group derived by the removal of one hydrogen atom from a single atom of a parent bicycloheteroaromatic ring system. Typical bicycloheteroaryl groups include, but are not limited to, groups derived from benzofuran, benzimidazole, benzindazole, benzdioxane, chromene, chromane, cinnoline, phthalazine, indole, indoline, indolizine, isobenzofuran, isochromene, isoindole, isoindoline, isoquinoline, benzothiazole, benzoxazole, naphthyridine, benzoxadiazole, pteridine, purine, benzopyran, benzpyrazine, pyridopyrimidine, quinazoline, quinoline, quinolizine, quinoxaline, benzomorphan, tetrahydroisoquinoline, tetrahydroquinoline, and the like. Preferably, the bicycloheteroaryl group is between 9-11 membered bicycloheteroaryl, with 5-10 membered heteroaryl being particularly preferred. Particular bicycloheteroaryl groups are those derived from benzothiophene, benzofuran, benzothiazole, indole, quinoline, isoquinoline, benzimidazole, benzoxazole and benzdioxane.
  • ‘Compounds of the present invention’, and equivalent expressions, are meant to embrace the compounds as hereinbefore described, in particular compounds according to any of the formulae herein recited and/or described, which expression includes the prodrugs, the pharmaceutically acceptable salts, and the solvates, e.g., hydrates, where the context so permits. Similarly, reference to intermediates, whether or not they themselves are claimed, is meant to embrace their salts, and solvates, where the context so permits.
  • ‘Cycloalkylalkyl’ refers to a radical in which a cycloalkyl group is substituted for a hydrogen atom of an alkyl group. Typical cycloalkylalkyl groups include, but are not limited to, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, cyclohexylmethyl, cycloheptylmethyl, cyclooctylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, cyclobutylethyl, cyclopentylethyl, cyclohexylethyl, cycloheptylethyl, and cyclooctylethyl, and the like.
  • ‘Heterocycloalkylalkyl’ refers to a radical in which a heterocycloalkyl group is substituted for a hydrogen atom of an alkyl group. Typical heterocycloalkylalkyl groups include, but are not limited to, pyrrolidinylmethyl, piperidinylmethyl, piperazinylmethyl, morpholinylmethyl, pyrrolidinylethyl, piperidinylethyl, piperazinylethyl, morpholinylethyl, and the like.
  • ‘Cycloalkenyl’ refers to cyclic hydrocarbyl groups having from 3 to 10 carbon atoms and having a single cyclic ring or multiple condensed rings, including fused and bridged ring systems and having at least one and particularly from 1 to 2 sites of olefinic unsaturation. Such cycloalkenyl groups include, by way of example, single ring structures such as cyclohexenyl, cyclopentenyl, cyclopropenyl, and the like.
  • ‘Substituted cycloalkenyl’ refers to those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to a cycloalkenyl group having 1 or more substituents, for instance from 1 to 5 substituents, and particularly from 1 to 3 substituents, selected from the group consisting of acyl, acylamino, acyloxy, alkoxy, substituted alkoxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxycarbonylamino, amino, substituted amino, aminocarbonyl, aminocarbonylamino, aminocarbonyloxy, aryl, aryloxy, azido, carboxyl, cyano, cycloalkyl, substituted cycloalkyl, halogen, hydroxyl, keto, nitro, thioalkoxy, substituted thioalkoxy, thioaryloxy, thioketo, thiol, alkyl-S(O)—, aryl-S(O)—, alkyl-S(O)2— and aryl-S(O)2—.
  • ‘Fused Cycloalkenyl’ refers to a cycloalkenyl having two of its ring carbon atoms in common with a second aliphatic or aromatic ring and having its olefinic unsaturation located to impart aromaticity to the cycloalkenyl ring.
  • ‘Ethenyl’ refers to substituted or unsubstituted —(C═C)—.
  • ‘Ethylene’ refers to substituted or unsubstituted —(C—C)—.
  • ‘Ethynyl’ refers to —(C≡C)—.
  • ‘Hydrogen bond donor’ group refers to a group containing O—H, or N—H functionality. Examples of ‘hydrogen bond donor’ groups include —OH, —NH2, and —NH—R97 and wherein R97 is alkyl, acyl, cycloalkyl, aryl, or heteroaryl.
  • ‘Dihydroxyphosphoryl’ refers to the radical —PO(OH)2.
  • ‘Substituted dihydroxyphosphoryl’ refers to those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to a dihydroxyphosphoryl radical wherein one or both of the hydroxyl groups are substituted. Suitable substituents are described in detail below.
  • ‘Aminohydroxyphosphoryl’ refers to the radical —PO(OH)NH2.
  • ‘Substituted aminohydroxyphosphoryl’ refers to those groups recited in the definition of “substituted” herein, and particularly refers to an aminohydroxyphosphoryl wherein the amino group is substituted with one or two substituents. Suitable substituents are described in detail below. In certain embodiments, the hydroxyl group can also be substituted.
  • ‘Nitrogen-Containing Heterocycloalkyl’ group means a 4 to 7 membered non-aromatic cyclic group containing at least one nitrogen atom, for example, but without limitation, morpholine, piperidine (e.g. 2-piperidinyl, 3-piperidinyl and 4-piperidinyl), pyrrolidine (e.g. 2-pyrrolidinyl and 3-pyrrolidinyl), azetidine, pyrrolidone, imidazoline, imidazolidinone, 2-pyrazoline, pyrazolidine, piperazine, and N-alkyl piperazines such as N-methyl piperazine. Particular examples include azetidine, piperidone and piperazone.
  • ‘Thioketo’ refers to the group ═S.
  • One having ordinary skill in the art of organic synthesis will recognize that the maximum number of heteroatoms in a stable, chemically feasible heterocyclic ring, whether it is aromatic or non aromatic, is determined by the size of the ring, the degree of unsaturation and the valence of the heteroatoms. In general, a heterocyclic ring may have one to four heteroatoms so long as the heteroaromatic ring is chemically feasible and stable.
  • ‘Pharmaceutically acceptable’ means approved or approvable by a regulatory agency of the Federal or a state government or the corresponding agency in countries other than the United States, or that is listed in the U.S. Pharmacopoeia or other generally recognized pharmacopoeia for use in animals; and more particularly, in humans.
  • ‘Pharmaceutically acceptable salt’ refers to a salt of a compound of the invention that is pharmaceutically acceptable and that possesses the desired pharmacological activity of the parent compound. In particular, such salts are non-toxic may be inorganic or organic acid addition salts and base addition salts. Specifically, such salts include: (1) acid addition salts, formed with inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, nitric acid, phosphoric acid, and the like; or formed with organic acids such as acetic acid, propionic acid, hexanoic acid, cyclopentanepropionic acid, glycolic acid, pyruvic acid, lactic acid, malonic acid, succinic acid, malic acid, maleic acid, fumaric acid, tartaric acid, citric acid, benzoic acid, 3-(4-hydroxybenzoyl)benzoic acid, cinnamic acid, mandelic acid, methanesulfonic acid, ethanesulfonic acid, 1,2-ethane-disulfonic acid, 2-hydroxyethanesulfonic acid, benzenesulfonic acid, 4-chlorobenzenesulfonic acid, 2-naphthalenesulfonic acid, 4-toluenesulfonic acid, camphorsulfonic acid, 4-methylbicyclo[2.2.2]-oct-2-ene-1-carboxylic acid, glucoheptonic acid, 3-phenylpropionic acid, trimethylacetic acid, tertiary butylacetic acid, lauryl sulfuric acid, gluconic acid, glutamic acid, hydroxynaphthoic acid, salicylic acid, stearic acid, muconic acid, and the like; or (2) salts formed when an acidic proton present in the parent compound either is replaced by a metal ion, e.g., an alkali metal ion, an alkaline earth ion, or an aluminum ion; or coordinates with an organic base such as ethanolamine, diethanolamine, triethanolamine, N-methylglucamine and the like. Salts further include, by way of example only, sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, ammonium, tetraalkylammonium, and the like; and when the compound contains a basic functionality, salts of non toxic organic or inorganic acids, such as hydrochloride, hydrobromide, tartrate, mesylate, acetate, maleate, oxalate and the like. The term “pharmaceutically acceptable cation” refers to an acceptable cationic counter-ion of an acidic functional group. Such cations are exemplified by sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, ammonium, tetraalkylammonium cations, and the like.
  • ‘Pharmaceutically acceptable vehicle’ refers to a diluent, adjuvant, excipient or carrier with which a compound of the invention is administered.
  • ‘Prodrugs’ refers to compounds, including derivatives of the compounds of the invention, which have cleavable groups and become by solvolysis or under physiological conditions the compounds of the invention which are pharmaceutically active in vivo. Such examples include, but are not limited to, choline ester derivatives and the like, N-alkylmorpholine esters and the like.
  • ‘Solvate’ refers to forms of the compound that are associated with a solvent, usually by a solvolysis reaction. This physical association includes hydrogen bonding. Conventional solvents include water, ethanol, acetic acid and the like. The compounds of the invention may be prepared e.g. in crystalline form and may be solvated or hydrated. Suitable solvates include pharmaceutically acceptable solvates, such as hydrates, and further include both stoichiometric solvates and non-stoichiometric solvates. In certain instances the solvate will be capable of isolation, for example when one or more solvent molecules are incorporated in the crystal lattice of the crystalline solid. ‘Solvate’ encompasses both solution-phase and isolable solvates. Representative solvates include hydrates, ethanolates and methanolates.
  • ‘Subject’ includes humans. The terms ‘human’, ‘patient’ and ‘subject’ are used interchangeably herein.
  • ‘Therapeutically effective amount’ means the amount of a compound that, when administered to a subject for treating a disease, is sufficient to effect such treatment for the disease. The “therapeutically effective amount” can vary depending on the compound, the disease and its severity, and the age, weight, etc., of the subject to be treated.
  • ‘Preventing’ or ‘prevention’ refers to a reduction in risk of acquiring or developing a disease or disorder (i.e., causing at least one of the clinical symptoms of the disease not to develop in a subject that may be exposed to a disease-causing agent, or predisposed to the disease in advance of disease onset.
  • The term ‘prophylaxis’ is related to ‘prevention’, and refers to a measure or procedure the purpose of which is to prevent, rather than to treat or cure a disease. Non-limiting examples of prophylactic measures may include the administration of vaccines; the administration of low molecular weight heparin to hospital patients at risk for thrombosis due, for example, to immobilization; and the administration of an anti-malarial agent such as chloroquine, in advance of a visit to a geographical region where malaria is endemic or the risk of contracting malaria is high.
  • ‘Treating’ or ‘treatment’ of any disease or disorder refers, in one embodiment, to ameliorating the disease or disorder (i.e., arresting the disease or reducing the manifestation, extent or severity of at least one of the clinical symptoms thereof). In another embodiment ‘treating’ or ‘treatment’ refers to ameliorating at least one physical parameter, which may not be discernible by the subject. In yet another embodiment, ‘treating’ or ‘treatment’ refers to modulating the disease or disorder, either physically, (e.g., stabilization of a discernible symptom), physiologically, (e.g., stabilization of a physical parameter), or both. In a further embodiment, “treating” or “treatment” relates to slowing the progression of the disease.
  • ‘Compounds of the present invention’, and equivalent expressions, are meant to embrace compounds of the Formula(e) as hereinbefore described, which expression includes the prodrugs, the pharmaceutically acceptable salts, and the solvates, e.g., hydrates, where the context so permits. Similarly, reference to intermediates, whether or not they themselves are claimed, is meant to embrace their salts, and solvates, where the context so permits.
  • When ranges are referred to herein, for example but without limitation, C1-C8 alkyl, the citation of a range should be considered a representation of each member of said range.
  • Other derivatives of the compounds of this invention have activity in both their acid and acid derivative forms, but in the acid sensitive form often offers advantages of solubility, tissue compatibility, or delayed release in the mammalian organism (see, Bundgard, H., Design of Prodrugs, pp. 7-9, 21-24, Elsevier, Amsterdam 1985). Prodrugs include acid derivatives well know to practitioners of the art, such as, for example, esters prepared by reaction of the parent acid with a suitable alcohol, or amides prepared by reaction of the parent acid compound with a substituted or unsubstituted amine, or acid anhydrides, or mixed anhydrides. Simple aliphatic or aromatic esters, amides and anhydrides derived from acidic groups pendant on the compounds of this invention are particular prodrugs. In some cases it is desirable to prepare double ester type prodrugs such as (acyloxy)alkyl esters or ((alkoxycarbonyl)oxy)alkylesters. Particularly the C1 to C8 alkyl, C2-C8 alkenyl, aryl, C7-C12 substituted aryl, and C7-C12 arylalkyl esters of the compounds of the invention.
  • As used herein, the term ‘isotopic variant’ refers to a compound that contains unnatural proportions of isotopes at one or more of the atoms that constitute such compound. For example, an ‘isotopic variant’ of a compound can contain one or more non-radioactive isotopes, such as for example, deuterium (2H or D), carbon-13 (13C), nitrogen-15 (15N), or the like. It will be understood that, in a compound where such isotopic substitution is made, the following atoms, where present, may vary, so that for example, any hydrogen may be 2H/D, any carbon may be 13C, or any nitrogen may be 15N, and that the presence and placement of such atoms may be determined within the skill of the art. Likewise, the invention may include the preparation of isotopic variants with radioisotopes, in the instance for example, where the resulting compounds may be used for drug and/or substrate tissue distribution studies. The radioactive isotopes tritium, i.e. 3H, and carbon-14, i.e. 14C, are particularly useful for this purpose in view of their ease of incorporation and ready means of detection. Further, compounds may be prepared that are substituted with positron emitting isotopes, such as 11C, 18F, 15O, and 13N, and would be useful in Positron Emission Topography (PET) studies for examining substrate receptor occupancy.
  • All isotopic variants of the compounds provided herein, radioactive or not, are intended to be encompassed within the scope of the invention.
  • It is also to be understood that compounds that have the same molecular formula but differ in the nature or sequence of bonding of their atoms or the arrangement of their atoms in space are termed ‘isomers’. Isomers that differ in the arrangement of their atoms in space are termed ‘stereoisomers’.
  • Stereoisomers that are not mirror images of one another are termed ‘diastereomers’ and those that are non-superimposable mirror images of each other are termed ‘enantiomers’. When a compound has an asymmetric center, for example, it is bonded to four different groups, a pair of enantiomers is possible. An enantiomer can be characterized by the absolute configuration of its asymmetric center and is described by the R- and S-sequencing rules of Cahn and Prelog, or by the manner in which the molecule rotates the plane of polarized light and designated as dextrorotatory or levorotatory (i.e., as (+) or (−)-isomers respectively). A chiral compound can exist as either individual enantiomer or as a mixture thereof. A mixture containing equal proportions of the enantiomers is called a ‘racemic mixture’.
  • ‘Tautomers’ refer to compounds that are interchangeable forms of a particular compound structure, and that vary in the displacement of hydrogen atoms and electrons. Thus, two structures may be in equilibrium through the movement of π electrons and an atom (usually H). For example, enols and ketones are tautomers because they are rapidly interconverted by treatment with either acid or base. Another example of tautomerism is the aci- and nitro-forms of phenylnitromethane, that are likewise formed by treatment with acid or base.
  • Tautomeric forms may be relevant to the attainment of the optimal chemical reactivity and biological activity of a compound of interest.
  • As used herein a pure enantiomeric compound is substantially free from other enantiomers or stereoisomers of the compound (i.e., in enantiomeric excess). In other words, an “S” form of the compound is substantially free from the “R” form of the compound and is, thus, in enantiomeric excess of the “R” form. The term “enantiomerically pure” or “pure enantiomer” denotes that the compound comprises more than 75% by weight, more than 80% by weight, more than 85% by weight, more than 90% by weight, more than 91% by weight, more than 92% by weight, more than 93% by weight, more than 94% by weight, more than 95% by weight, more than 96% by weight, more than 97% by weight, more than 98% by weight, more than 98.5% by weight, more than 99% by weight, more than 99.2% by weight, more than 99.5% by weight, more than 99.6% by weight, more than 99.7% by weight, more than 99.8% by weight or more than 99.9% by weight, of the enantiomer. In certain embodiments, the weights are based upon total weight of all enantiomers or stereoisomers of the compound.
  • As used herein and unless otherwise indicated, the term “enantiomerically pure R-compound” refers to at least about 80% by weight R-compound and at most about 20% by weight S-compound, at least about 90% by weight R-compound and at most about 10% by weight S-compound, at least about 95% by weight R-compound and at most about 5% by weight S-compound, at least about 99% by weight R-compound and at most about 1% by weight S-compound, at least about 99.9% by weight R-compound or at most about 0.1% by weight S-compound. In certain embodiments, the weights are based upon total weight of compound.
  • As used herein and unless otherwise indicated, the term “enantiomerically pure S-compound” or “S-compound” refers to at least about 80% by weight S-compound and at most about 20% by weight R-compound, at least about 90% by weight S-compound and at most about 10% by weight R-compound, at least about 95% by weight S-compound and at most about 5% by weight R-compound, at least about 99% by weight S-compound and at most about 1% by weight R-compound or at least about 99.9% by weight S-compound and at most about 0.1% by weight R-compound. In certain embodiments, the weights are based upon total weight of compound.
  • In the compositions provided herein, an enantiomerically pure compound or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, hydrate or prodrug thereof can be present with other active or inactive ingredients. For example, a pharmaceutical composition comprising enantiomerically pure R-compound can comprise, for example, about 90% excipient and about 10% enantiomerically pure R-compound. In certain embodiments, the enantiomerically pure R-compound in such compositions can, for example, comprise, at least about 95% by weight R-compound and at most about 5% by weight S-compound, by total weight of the compound. For example, a pharmaceutical composition comprising enantiomerically pure S-compound can comprise, for example, about 90% excipient and about 10% enantiomerically pure S-compound. In certain embodiments, the enantiomerically pure S-compound in such compositions can, for example, comprise, at least about 95% by weight S-compound and at most about 5% by weight R-compound, by total weight of the compound. In certain embodiments, the active ingredient can be formulated with little or no excipient or carrier.
  • The compounds of this invention may possess one or more asymmetric centers; such compounds can therefore be produced as individual (R)- or (S)-stereoisomers or as mixtures thereof. Unless indicated otherwise, the description or naming of a particular compound in the specification and claims is intended to include both individual enantiomers and mixtures, racemic or otherwise, thereof. The methods for the determination of stereochemistry and the separation of stereoisomers are well-known in the art.
  • The Compounds
  • In certain aspects, provided herein are compounds useful for preventing and/or treating a broad range of conditions, among them, arthritis, Parkinson's disease, Alzheimer's disease, stroke, uveitis, asthma, myocardial infarction, the treatment and prophylaxis of pain syndromes (acute and chronic or neuropathic), traumatic brain injury, acute spinal cord injury, neurodegenerative disorders, alopecia (hair loss), inflammatory bowel disease and autoimmune disorders or conditions in mammals.
  • In one aspect, provided herein are compounds according to formula 1:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00008
  • wherein
      • each of A, B, and W are independently selected from CR4 and N; provided that not all A, B, and W are N at the same time;
      • X′ is selected from CR4a and N;
      • L is substituted or unsubstituted C1-C9 alkylene or C1-C9 heteroalkylene;
      • R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, aryl, and heteroaryl;
      • R3 is substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered aryl, or substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered heteroaryl; or
        • R3 is substituted or unsubstituted N containing heterocycloalkyl; and the heterocycloalkyl is attached to the core group via the N;
      • each R4 is independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, substituted or unsubstituted amino, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, nitro, and thiol;
      • each R4a, and R4b is independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyloxy, substituted or unsubstituted amino, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol; and subscript m′ is selected from 0-4;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 1, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted 4-7 membered heterocycloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 1, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 1, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl.
  • In one aspect, with respect to formula 1, R4 is other than hydroxy, alkoxy, aryloxy, or heteroaryloxy. For the sake of clarity, the invention does not include compounds wherein R4 is hydroxy, alkoxy, aryloxy, or heteroaryloxy.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 1, one of A, B, and W is N; and the rest are independently selected from CR4.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 1, each A, B, and W is independently selected from CR4.
  • In one particular embodiment, with respect to formula 1, each A, B, and W is CH.
  • In one particular embodiment, with respect to formula 1, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted 4-7 membered heterocycloalkyl;
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 1, the compound is according to formula 2:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00009
  • wherein
      • X′, L, R1, R3, R4a; R4b, and m′ are as described for formula 1;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1 and 2, L is selected from —CH2—, —CHMe-, —CMe2-, —(CH2)2—, —CMe2-CH2—, —(CH2)3—, —(CH2)4—, —CH(CH3)CH2—, —(CH2)2SCH2—, —(CH2)2—SO2CH2—, —CH(CH2CH3)CH2OCH2—, —CH2CHF—, —CH2CF2—, —CH2CH(OH)—, —CH(CH2OH)—, —CH(CH2CH2OH)—, and —CH2CO—.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 1 and 2, L is selected from —CH2—, —CHMe-, —CMe2-, —(CH2)2—, —CMe2-CH2—)—, —CH(CH2OH)—, —CH(CH2CH2OH)—, and —(CH2)3—.
  • In one particular embodiment, with respect to formulae 1 and 2, L is selected from —CH2—, —(CH2)2—, —CHMe-, and —C(Me)H—CH2—.
  • In another aspect, provided herein are compounds according to formula 2a:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00010
  • wherein
      • X′ is selected from CR4a and N;
      • R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, aryl, and heteroaryl;
      • each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, haloalkyl, and halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms;
      • R3 is substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered aryl, or substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered heteroaryl; and when R3 is 6,5 fused bicyclic heteroaryl then R3 is joined to the core group via the 6 membered ring;
        • R3 is N containing heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo; and the heterocycloalkyl is attached to the core group via the N;
  • each R4a, and R4b is independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyloxy, substituted or unsubstituted amino, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol; and subscript m′ is selected from 0-4; and the subscript n2 is 0 or 1;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof;
      • provided that
      • a) when n2 is 0, R1 is other than Me; or
      • b) the compound is other than
    • i) 3,5-di(4-fluorophenyl)benzoic acid N-[1-methyl-2-[4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)piperazin-1-yl]ethyl]amide;
    • ii) 3,5-di(4-fluorophenyl)benzoic acid N-[1-methyl-2-(4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl)ethyl]amide;
    • iii) 3-(3-fluoro-2-pyridinyl)-N-[2-hydroxy-1-(3-methyl-1,2,4-oxadiazol-5-yl)propyl]-5-(5-methyl-2-pyridinyl)-benzamide;
    • iv) 3-(5-methyl-2-pyridinyl)-5-(1-piperidinyl)-N-[(1S)-1-(1H-1,2,4-triazol-5-yl)ethyl]-benzamide;
    • v) N-[(1R)-1-(3-fluoro-2-pyridinyl)ethyl]-3-(5-methyl-2-pyridinyl)-5-(1-piperidinyl)-benzamide;
    • vii) 5-(2,4-dioxo-1-imidazolidinyl)-2′-fluoro-4′-methyl-N-(1-methylethyl)-[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-carboxamide;
    • viii) N-(3,3-dimethylbutyl)-γ-hydroxy-α-methyl-δ-[[[5-(2-oxo-1-pyrrolidinyl)[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-yl]carbonyl]amino]-,(αR,δS,γS)-benzenehexanamide;
    • ix) 2-[[3′-[(2R)-2-[(dimethylamino)carbonyl]-1-pyrrolidinyl]-5′-[[[(1S)-1-[(dimethylamino)methyl]-2-phenylethyl]amino]carbonyl]-2-methoxy[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-yl]methyl]-4-[(1S)-1-hydroxyethyl]-5-(hydroxymethyl)-N-[(1S,2S,3S,5R)-2,6,6-trimethylbicyclo[3.1.1]hept-3-yl]-,(3S,4R,5R)-3-isoxazolidinecarboxamide; or
    • x) N-(3,3-dimethylbutyl)-γ-hydroxy-α-methyl-δ-[[[5-(2-oxo-1-pyrrolidinyl)[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-yl]carbonyl]amino]-(αR,δS,γS)-benzenehexanamide.
  • In another aspect, provided herein are compounds according to formula 2aa:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00011
  • wherein
      • X′, L, R1, R4a; R4b, and m′ a are as described for formula 1 and R3 is substituted or unsubstituted N containing heterocycloalkyl; and the heterocycloalkyl is attached to the core group via the N.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 2aa, L is selected from —CH2—, —CHMe-, —CMe2-, —(CH2)2—, —CMe2-CH2—, —(CH2)3—, —(CH2)4—, —CH(CH3)CH2—, —(CH2)2SCH2—, —(CH2)2—SO2CH2—, —CH(CH2CH3) CH2OCH2—, —CH2CHF—, —CH2CF2—, —CH2CH(OH)—, —CH(CH2OH)—, —CH(CH2CH2OH)—, and —CH2CO—.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2aa, L is selected from —CH2—, —CHMe-, —(CH2)2—, —CMe2-CH2—)—, —CH(CH2OH)—, —CH(CH2CH2OH)—, and —(CH2)3—.
  • In one particular embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa, L is selected from —CH2—, and —CHMe-.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 2aa, R3 is substituted or unsubstituted azetidine, pyrrolidine, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2aa, R3 is azetidine, pyrrolidine, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2aa, R3 is azetidine, pyrrolidine, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2aa, R3 is
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00012
  • and wherein R3a is independently selected from hydrogen, or substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2aa, the compound is according to formula 3aa, 4aa, 5aa, 6aa, 7aa, or 8aa:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00013
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00014
  • wherein
      • X′, R1, R4b; and m′ are as described for formula 1; and R3a is as described above;
      • each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, or halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or cycloheteroalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-8aa, the subscript m′ is 1, 2 or 3.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-8aa, the subscript m′ is 1.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2aa, the compound is according to formula 9aa, 10aa, 11aa, 12aa, 13aa, or 14aa:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00015
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00016
  • wherein
      • X′, R1, R4a, R4b, and m′ are as described for formula 1; and R3a is as described above;
      • each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, or halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or cycloheteroalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R3a is H or alkyl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R3a is H, Me, Et, or i-Pr.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, X′ is CR4a.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, X′ is N.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, X′ is CR4a; and R4a is independently H, C1-C4 alkyl, halo C1-C4 alkyl, CN, NO2, or halo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, X′ is CR4a; and R4a is H, Me, CF3, Cl, F, CN or NO2.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, X′ is CR4a; and R4a is Cl or CN.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R4b is H, C1-C4 alkyl or halo C1-C4 alkyl or halo.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R4b is H, Me, CF3, Cl or F.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3aa-14aa, each of R2a and R2b is hydrogen.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3aa-14aa, one of R2a and R2b is methyl, hydroxymethyl or hydroxyethyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3aa-14aa, each of R2a and R2b is methyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3aa-14aa, R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl ring.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3aa-14aa, R2a and R2b join together to form a cyclopropyl ring.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3aa-14aa, R2a is selected from Me, Et, n-Pr, t-Bu, CF3, CH2OH, CH2CH2OH, CH2CH2OAc, CH2(CH2)2OH, CH2CH2NHMe, CH2NMe2, CH2CH2NMe2, CH2CONH2, CH2CONMe2, CH2COOH, CH2CH2COOH, CH2(CH2)2COOH, CH2OMe, and CH2CH2OMe; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3aa-14aa, R2a is selected from CH2NR2′R2″, CH2CH2NR2′R2″, CH2CH2CH2NR2′R2″ and wherein R2′ and R2″ can join together to form a heterocyclic ring; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3aa-14aa, R2a is selected from cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl or cyclohexyl; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3aa-14aa, R2a is CH2OH or CH2CH2OH; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R1 is substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R1 is Me, Et, i-Pr, or t-Bu.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R1 is substituted or unsubstituted aryl or heteroaryl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R1 is substituted or unsubstituted bicycloaryl, bicycloalkyl, or bicycloheteroaryl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R1 is substituted or unsubstituted phenyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R1 is substituted or unsubstituted pyridyl, pyrimidinyl or pyrazinyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, methylenedioxyphenyl, imidazopyridyl, benzoxazolyl, and indolyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R1 is
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00017
  • and wherein subscript n2 is selected from 1-5 and each R5b is independently selected from hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, aryloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, substituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, arylalkyloxy, substituted arylalkyloxy, amino, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted sulfinyl, substituted or unsubstituted sulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, sulfonic acid, sulfonic acid ester, substituted or unsubstituted dihydroxyphosphoryl, substituted or unsubstituted aminodihydroxyphosphoryl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted cycloheteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro and thiol.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R1 is as described above and the subscript n2 is 1, 2 or 3.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R1 is as described above and the subscript n2 is 1 or 2.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 2aa-14aa, R1 is
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00018
  • and wherein R5b is as described above.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, each R5b is independently selected from H, alkyl, halo, cyano, alkoxy, and haloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, R1 is as described above and each R5b is independently selected from H, Me, Et, Pr, iso-Pr, Ph, Cl, F, Br, CN, OH, OMe, OEt, OPh, COPh, CO2Me, CH2—N-morpholino, CH2—N-(4-Me-piperidino), NH2, CONH2, CF3, CHF2, OCF3, OCHF2, t-Bu, SMe, CH═CH—CO2H, SOMe, SO2Me, SO2CF3, SO2NH2, SO3H, SO3Me, cyclopropyl, triazolyl, morpholinyl, and pyridyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 2aa-14aa, each R5b is independently selected from H, Cl, F, Me, or CF3.
  • With regard to formula 2aa, in certain embodiments, the compound is selected from the group consisting of
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00019
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00020
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00021
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00022
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00023
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00024
  • and wherein Cy is R3 and R3 is as defined for formula 2aa. Additional embodiments within the scope provided herein are set forth in non-limiting fashion elsewhere herein and in the examples. It should be understood that these examples are for illustrative purposes only and are not to be construed as limiting in any manner.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1, 2 and 2a, R3 is substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered aryl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 1, 2 and 2a, R3 is substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered heteroaryl. For the sake of clarity the invention does not include 5 membered heteroaryls, for example pyrrolyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, oxazolyl, thiazolyl and the like.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 1, 2 and 2a, R3 is substituted or unsubstituted bicycloaryl, bicycloalkyl, or bicycloheteroaryl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 1, 2 and 2a, R3 is substituted or unsubstituted phenyl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 1, 2 and 2a, R3 is substituted or unsubstituted pyridyl, pyrazinyl or unsubstituted pyrimidinyl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 1, 2 and 2a, R3 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, methylenedioxyphenyl, imidazopyridyl, benzoxazolyl, and indolyl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 1, 2 and 2a, R3 is
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00025
      • and wherein subscript n1 is selected from 1-5 and each R5a is independently selected from hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, aryloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, substituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, arylalkyloxy, substituted arylalkyloxy, amino, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1, 2 or 2a, R1 is unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1, 2 or 2a, R1 substituted heterocycloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1, 2 or 2a, R1 is heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1, 2 or 2a, R1 is heterocycloalkyl, substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In another aspect, provided herein are compounds according to formulae 3, 4, or 5:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00026
  • wherein
      • X′ is selected from CR4a and N;
  • R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted aryl, and heteroaryl; or
      • R1 is substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl; or
        • R1 is selected from alkyl, and hydroxyalkyl; or
          • R1 is heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo;
      • each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, haloalkyl, and halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms;
      • each R4a, and R4b is independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyloxy, substituted or unsubstituted amino, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol; and subscript m′ is selected from 0-4;
      • each R5a is independently selected from hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, aryloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, substituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, arylalkyloxy, substituted arylalkyloxy, amino, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol; the subscript n1 is selected from 1-5; and the subscript n2 is 0 or 1;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof;
      • provided that
      • a) when n2 is 0, R1 is other than Me; or
      • b) the compound is other than
    • i) 3-(3-fluoro-2-pyridinyl)-N-[2-hydroxy-1-(3-methyl-1,2,4-oxadiazol-5-yl)propyl]-5-(5-methyl-2-pyridinyl)-benzamide.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3, 4, and 5, the subscript m′ is 1, 2 or 3.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3, 4, and 5, the subscript m′ is 1.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3, 4, and 5, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted aryl, and heteroaryl; or
  • R1 is substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl; or
      • R1 is selected from alkyl, and hydroxyalkyl; or
      • R1 is heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, the compound is according to formulae 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, or 11:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00027
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00028
  • wherein
      • R1, R2a, R2, R4a, R4b, R5a, n1 and n2 are as described for formula 3-5;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, the subscript n2 is 0.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, the subscript n2 is 1.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-6, 8, and 10, each R4a is independently H, C1-C4 alkyl, halo C1-C4 alkyl, CN, NO2, or halo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-6, 8, and 10, each R4a is H, Me, CF3, Cl, F, CN or NO2.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-6, 8, and 10, R4a is Cl or CN.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-11, R4b is H, C1-C4 alkyl or halo C1-C4 alkyl or halo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-11, R4b is H, Me, CF3, Cl or F.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, subscript n1 is 1, 2 or 3.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, subscript n1 is 1 or 2.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, subscript n1 is 1.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, each R5a is independently selected from H, alkyl, halo, cyano, alkoxy, and haloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, each R5a is independently selected from H, Me, Et, Pr, iso-Pr, Ph, Cl, F, Br, CN, OH, OMe, OEt, OPh, COPh, CO2Me, CH2—N-morpholino, CH2—N-(4-Me-piperidino), NH2, CONH2, CF3, CHF2, OCF3, OCHF2, t-Bu, SMe, CH═CH—CO2H, SOMe, SO2Me, SO2CF3, SO2NH2, SO3H, SO3Me, cyclopropyl, triazolyl, morpholinyl, and pyridyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, each R5a is independently selected from H, Cl, F, Me, or CF3.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, each R5a is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted aryl, and heteroaryl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is selected from alkyl, and hydroxyalkyl; or R1 is heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is other than aryl or heteroaryl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is unsubstituted aryl or heteroaryl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, aryl, and heteroaryl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is alkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is hydroxyalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, haloalkyl, and oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is heterocycloalkyl, substituted with one or more groups selected from alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, and dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is heterocycloalkyl, substituted with alkylsulfonylalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C2-C4 alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, and halo. In another embodiment, each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C2-C4 alkyl, and hydroxyalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R2a and R2b join together to form a cyclopropyl ring.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, the subscript n2 is 1; and R1 is unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, the subscript n2 is 1; and R1 substituted heterocycloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, the subscript n2 is 1; and R1 is heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11 R1 is heterocycloalkyl, substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, R1 is selected from morpholinyl, and 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, the subscript n2 is 1; and R1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, the subscript n2 is 1; and R1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with alkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, the subscript n2 is 1; and R1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-11, the subscript n2 is 1; and R1 is selected from morpholinyl, and 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl.
  • In yet another aspect, provided herein are compounds according to formula 2a:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00029
  • wherein
      • X′ is selected from CR4a and N;
      • R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, aryl, and heteroaryl;
      • each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, haloalkyl, and halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms;
      • R3 is N containing heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo; and the heterocycloalkyl is attached to the core group via the N;
      • each R4a, and R4b is independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyloxy, substituted or unsubstituted amino, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol; subscript m′ is selected from 0-4; and the subscript n2 is 0 or 1;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof;
      • provided that the compound is other than
    • i) 3-(5-methyl-2-pyridinyl)-5-(1-piperidinyl)-N-[(1S)-1-(1H-1,2,4-triazol-5-yl)ethyl]-benzamide;
    • ii) N-[(1R)-1-(3-fluoro-2-pyridinyl)ethyl]-3-(5-methyl-2-pyridinyl)-5-(1-piperidinyl)-benzamide;
    • iii) 5-(2,4-dioxo-1-imidazolidinyl)-2′-fluoro-4′-methyl-N-(1-methylethyl)-[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-carboxamide;
    • iv) N-(3,3-dimethylbutyl)-γ-hydroxy-α-methyl-δ-[[[5-(2-oxo-1-pyrrolidinyl)[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-yl]carbonyl]amino]-,(αR,δS,γS)-benzenehexanamide;
    • v) 2-[[3′-[(2R)-2-[(dimethylamino)carbonyl]-1-pyrrolidinyl]-5′-[[[(1S)-1-[(dimethylamino)methyl]-2-phenylethyl]amino]carbonyl]-2-methoxy[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-yl]methyl]-4-[(1S)-1-hydroxyethyl]-5-(hydroxymethyl)-N-[1S,2S,3S,5R)-2,6,6-trimethylbicyclo[3.1.1]hept-3-yl]-, (3S,4R,5R)-3-isoxazolidinecarboxamide; or
    • vi) N-(3,3-dimethylbutyl)-γ-hydroxy-α-methyl-δ-[[[5-(2-oxo-1-pyrrolidinyl)[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-yl]carbonyl]amino]-(αR,δS,γS)-benzenehexanamide.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, R3 is unsubstituted N containing heterocycloalkyl; and the heterocycloalkyl is attached to the core group via the N.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, R3 is N containing heterocycloalkyl, substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo; and the heterocycloalkyl is attached to the core group via the N.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, R3 is N containing heterocycloalkyl, substituted with one or more groups selected from hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, R3 is N containing heterocycloalkyl, substituted with hydroxyalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, R3 is N containing heterocycloalkyl, substituted with oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, R3 is unsubstituted azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, R3 is azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, R3 is azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl, substituted with one or more groups selected from hydroxyalkyl, and oxo.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, R3 is azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, R3 is azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, or azepinyl, substituted with hydroxyalkyl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, R3 is
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00030
      • and wherein R3a is independently selected from hydrogen, or substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, the compound is according to formula 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, or 17:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00031
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00032
  • wherein
      • X′, R2a, R2b, R4b; m′ and n2 are as described for formula 2a;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-8, the subscript m′ is 1, 2 or 3.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-8, the subscript m′ is 1.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 2a, the compound is according to formulae 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, or 23:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00033
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00034
  • wherein
      • X′, R1, R2a, R2b, R4b; and n2 are as described for formula 2a;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, and halo. In another embodiment, each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, and C1-C4 alkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, each of R2a and R2b is hydrogen.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, one of R2a and R2b is hydrogen.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, one of R2a and R2b is methyl, hydroxymethyl or hydroxyethyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, each of R2a and R2b is methyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl ring.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, R2a and R2b join together to form a cyclopropyl ring.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, R2a is selected from Me, Et, n-Pr, t-Bu, CF3, CH2OH, CH2CH2OH, CH2(CH2)2OH, CH2CH2NHMe, CH2NMe2, CH2CH2NMe2, CH2OMe, and CH2CH2OMe; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, R2a is selected from Me, Et, n-Pr, t-Bu; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, R2a is selected from CH2OH, CH2CH2OH, CH2(CH2)2OH, CH2OMe, and CH2CH2OMe; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, R2a is selected from CF3, and CH2CF3; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, R2a is selected from CH2NR2′R2″, CH2CH2NR2′R2″, CH2CH2CH2NR2′R2″ and wherein R2′ and R2″ can join together to form a heterocyclic ring; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, R2a is selected from cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl or cyclohexyl; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, R2a is CH2OH or CH2CH2OH; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, the subscript n2 is 0.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, the subscript n2 is 1.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 15 or 21, R3a is H or alkyl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 15 or 21, R3a is H, Me, Et, or i-Pr.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, X′ is CR4a.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, X′ is N.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, X′ is CR4a; and R4a is independently H, C1-C4 alkyl, halo C1-C4 alkyl, CN, NO2, or halo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, X′ is CR4a; and R4a is H, Me, CF3, Cl, F, CN or NO2.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, X′ is CR4a; and R4a is Cl or CN.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, R4b is H, C1-C4 alkyl or halo C1-C4 alkyl or halo.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, R4b is H, Me, CF3, Cl or F.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R1 is other than aryl or heteroaryl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R1 is aryl or heteroaryl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, aryl, and heteroaryl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R1 is substituted or unsubstituted alkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R1 is hydroxyalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R1 is alkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R1 is Et, i-Pr, or t-Bu.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R1 is substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R1 is substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, R1 is selected from morpholinyl, and 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, the subscript n2 is 1; and R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, the subscript n2 is 1; and R1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, the subscript n2 is 1; and R1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 12-23, the subscript n2 is 1; and R1 is selected from morpholinyl, and 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted bicycloaryl, bicycloalkyl, or bicycloheteroaryl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted pyridyl, pyrazinyl or unsubstituted pyrimidinyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, methylenedioxyphenyl, imidazopyridyl, benzoxazolyl, and indolyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, R1 is
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00035
      • and wherein subscript n2 is selected from 1-5 and each R5b is independently selected from hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, aryloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, substituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, arylalkyloxy, substituted arylalkyloxy, amino, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, subscript n3 is 1, 2 or 3.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, subscript n3 is 1 or 2.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, R1 is
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00036
      • and wherein R5b is as described above.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, each R5b is independently selected from H, alkyl, halo, cyano, alkoxy, and haloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, each R5b is independently selected from H, Me, Et, Pr, iso-Pr, Ph, Cl, F, Br, CN, OH, OMe, OEt, OPh, COPh, CO2Me, CH2—N-morpholino, CH2—N-(4-Me-piperidino), NH2, CONH2, CF3, CHF2, OCF3, OCHF2, t-Bu, SMe, CH═CH—CO2H, SOMe, SO2Me, SO2CF3, SO2NH2, SO3H, SO3Me, cyclopropyl, triazolyl, morpholinyl, and pyridyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, each R5b is independently selected from H, Cl, F, Me, or CF3.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 1, the compound is according to formulae 3a, 4a, or 5a:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00037
  • wherein
      • X′, R1, R4b; and m′ are as described for formula 1; each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, and halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms; each R5a is independently selected from hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, aryloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, substituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, arylalkyloxy, substituted arylalkyloxy, amino, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol; the subscript n1 is selected from 1-5;
        or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 1, the compound is according to formulae 6a, 7a, 8a, 9a, 10a, or 11a:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00038
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00039
  • wherein
      • X′, R1, R4b; and m′ are as described for formula 1; each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, and halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms; each R5a is independently selected from hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, aryloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, substituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, arylalkyloxy, substituted arylalkyloxy, amino, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol; the subscript n1 is selected from 1-5;
        or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 1, the compound is according to formula 12a, 13a, 14a, 15a, 16a, or 17a:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00040
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00041
  • wherein
      • X′, R1, R4b; and m′ are as described for formula 1; each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, and halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms; R3a is as described above; the subscript n1 is selected from 1-5;
        or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 1, the compound is according to formulae 18a, 19a, 20a, 21a, 22a, or 23a:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00042
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00043
  • wherein
      • X′, R1, R4b; and m′ are as described for formula 1; each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, and halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms; R3a is as described above;
        or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, nd R1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, R1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, R1 is selected from morpholinyl, and 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 15a or 21a, R3a is H or alkyl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 15a or 21a, R3a is H, Me, Et, or i-Pr.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, X′ is CR4a.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, X′ is N.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, X′ is CR4a; and R4a is independently H, C1-C4 alkyl, halo C1-C4 alkyl, CN, NO2, or halo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, X′ is CR4a; and R4a is H, Me, CF3, Cl, F, CN or NO2.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, X′ is CR4a; and R4a is Cl or CN.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, R4b is H, C1-C4 alkyl or halo C1-C4 alkyl or halo.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, R4b is H, Me, CF3, Cl or F.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, each of R2a and R2b is hydrogen.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-11a, each of R2a and R2b is hydrogen.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, one of R2a and R2b is methyl, hydroxymethyl or hydroxyethyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, each of R2a and R2b is methyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl ring.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, R2a and R2b join together to form a cyclopropyl ring.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, R2a is selected from Me, Et, n-Pr, t-Bu, CF3, CH2OH, CH2CH2OH, CH2CH2OAc, CH2(CH2)2OH, CH2CH2NHMe, CH2NMe2, CH2CH2NMe2, CH2CONH2, CH2CONMe2, CH2COOH, CH2CH2COOH, CH2(CH2)2COOH, CH2OMe, and CH2CH2OMe; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, R2a is selected from CH2NR2′R2″, CH2CH2NR2′R2″, CH2CH2CH2NR2′R2″ and wherein R2′ and R2″ can join together to form a heterocyclic ring; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, R2a is selected from cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl or cyclohexyl; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3a-23a, R2a is CH2OH or CH2CH2OH; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23 and 3a-23a, R1 is Me. Et, i-Pr, or t-Bu.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-2, R1 is substituted or unsubstituted aryl or heteroaryl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 1, the compound is according to formula 3b, 4b, 5b, 6b, 7b, or 8b:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00044
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00045
  • wherein
      • X′, R1, R4b; and m′ are as described for formula 1; and R3a is as described above;
      • each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, or halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1b-8b, the subscript m′ is 1, 2 or 3.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 1b-8b, the subscript m′ is 1.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 1, the compound is according to formula 9b, 10b, 11b, 12b, 13b, or 14b:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00046
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00047
  • wherein
      • X′, R1, R4a, R4b, and m′ are as described for formula 1; and R3a is as described above;
      • each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, or halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 6b or 12b, R3a is H or alkyl.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 6b or 12b, R3a is H, Me, Et, or i-Pr.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 1, the compound is according to formula 3c, 4c, or 5c:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00048
  • wherein
      • each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, or halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms;
      • X′, R1, R4b; and m′ are as described for formula 1; and R5a and n1 are as described above;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 3c, 4c, and 5c, the subscript m′ is 1, 2 or 3.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 3c, 4c, and 5c, the subscript m′ is 1.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formula 1, the compound is according to formula 6c, 7c, 8c, 9c, 10c or 11c:
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00049
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00050
  • wherein
      • each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, or halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms;
      • X, R1, R4a, R4b, and m′ are as described for formula 1; and R5a and n1 are as described above;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, X′ is CR4a.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, X′ is N.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, X′ is CR4a; and R4a is independently H, C1-C4 alkyl, halo C1-C4 alkyl, CN, NO2, or halo.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, X′ is CR4a; and R4a is H, Me, CF3, Cl, F, CN or NO2.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, X′ is CR4a; and R4a is Cl or CN.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R4b is H, C1-C4 alkyl or halo C1-C4 alkyl or halo.
  • In another embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R4b is H, Me, CF3, Cl or F.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, each of R2a and R2b is hydrogen.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, one of R2a and R2b is methyl, hydroxymethyl or hydroxyethyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, each of R2a and R2b is methyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl ring.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R2a and R2b join together to form a cyclopropyl ring.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R2a is selected from Me, Et, n-Pr, t-Bu, CF3, CH2OH, CH2CH2OH, CH2CH2OAc, CH2(CH2)2OH, CH2CH2NHMe, CH2NMe2, CH2CH2NMe2, CH2CONH2, CH2CONMe2, CH2COOH, CH2CH2COOH, CH2(CH2)2COOH, CH2OMe, and CH2CH2OMe; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R2a is selected from CH2NR2′R2″, CH2CH2NR2′R2″, CH2CH2CH2NR2′R2″ and wherein R2′ and R2″ can join together to form a heterocyclic ring; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R2a is selected from cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl or cyclohexyl; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R2a is CH2OH or CH2CH2OH; and R2b is H.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R1 is substituted or unsubstituted bicycloaryl, bicycloalkyl, or bicycloheteroaryl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R1 is substituted or unsubstituted phenyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R1 is substituted or unsubstituted pyridyl, pyrimidinyl or pyrazinyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, methylenedioxyphenyl, imidazopyridyl, benzoxazolyl, and indolyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R1 is
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00051
      • and wherein subscript n3 is selected from 1-5 and each R5b is independently selected from hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, aryloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, substituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, arylalkyloxy, substituted arylalkyloxy, amino, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted sulfinyl, substituted or unsubstituted sulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, sulfonic acid, sulfonic acid ester, substituted or unsubstituted dihydroxyphosphoryl, substituted or unsubstituted aminodihydroxyphosphoryl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro and thiol.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R1 is as described above and the subscript n3 is 1, 2 or 3.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R1 is as described above and the subscript n3 is 1 or 2.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 1-23, 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R1 is
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00052
  • and wherein R5b is as described above.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, each R5b is independently selected from H, alkyl, halo, cyano, alkoxy, and haloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, R1 is as described above and each R5b is independently selected from H, Me, Et, Pr, iso-Pr, Ph, Cl, F, Br, CN, OH, OMe, OEt, OPh, COPh, CO2Me, CH2—N-morpholino, CH2—N-(4-Me-piperidino), NH2, CONH2, CF3, CHF2, OCF3, OCHF2, t-Bu, SMe, CH═CH—CO2H, SOMe, SO2Me, SO2CF3, SO2NH2, SO3H, SO3Me, cyclopropyl, triazolyl, morpholinyl, and pyridyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 1-23, 3b-14b, and 3c-11c, each R5b is independently selected from H, Cl, F, Me, or CF3.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, the subscript n2 is 0; and R1 is substituted or unsubstituted aryl or heteroaryl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, the subscript n2 is 0; and R1 is substituted or unsubstituted bicycloaryl, bicycloalkyl, or bicycloheteroaryl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, the subscript n2 is 0; and R1 is substituted or unsubstituted phenyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, the subscript n2 is 0; and R1 is substituted or unsubstituted pyridyl, pyrimidinyl or pyrazinyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, the subscript n2 is 0; and R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, methylenedioxyphenyl, imidazopyridyl, benzoxazolyl, and indolyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, the subscript n2 is 0; and R1 is
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00053
      • and wherein subscript n3 is selected from 1-5 and each R5b is independently selected from hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, aryloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, substituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, arylalkyloxy, substituted arylalkyloxy, amino, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted sulfinyl, substituted or unsubstituted sulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, sulfonic acid, sulfonic acid ester, substituted or unsubstituted dihydroxyphosphoryl, substituted or unsubstituted aminodihydroxyphosphoryl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro and thiol.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, the subscript n2 is 0; and R1 is as described above and the subscript n3 is 1, 2 or 3.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, the subscript n2 is 0; and R1 is as described above and the subscript n3 is 1 or 2.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formula 3-23, the subscript n2 is 0; and R1 is
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00054
  • and wherein R5b is as described above.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, the subscript n2 is 0; and each R5b is independently selected from H, alkyl, halo, cyano, alkoxy, and haloalkyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, the subscript n2 is 0; and R1 is as described above and each R5b is independently selected from H, Me, Et, Pr, iso-Pr, Ph, Cl, F, Br, CN, OH, OMe, OEt, OPh, COPh, CO2Me, CH2—N-morpholino, CH2—N-(4-Me-piperidino), NH2, CONH2, CF3, CHF2, OCF3, OCHF2, t-Bu, SMe, CH═CH—CO2H, SOMe, SO2Me, SO2CF3, SO2NH2, SO3H, SO3Me, cyclopropyl, triazolyl, morpholinyl, and pyridyl.
  • In one embodiment, with respect to formulae 3-23, the subscript n2 is 0; and each R5b is independently selected from H, Cl, F, Me, or CF3.
  • In general, for any formula shown herein, wherein R1 is defined it is preferred that when R1 is substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, said heterocycloalkyl is other than morpholino or piperidine; even more preferably R1 is other than substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.
  • With regard to formula 1, in certain embodiments, the compound is selected from the compounds exemplified in Table 1; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • With regard to formula 1, in certain embodiments, the compound is selected from:
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-pyrimidin-2-yl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4,4″-Dimethyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2″-Methoxy-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2″,4″-Difluoro-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2″-Fluoro-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4″-Methoxy-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2″-Hydroxymethyl-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2″,4″-Dimethoxy-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 3″,4″-Dimethoxy-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 3″-Methoxy-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 5-(2-Methoxy-pyrimidin-5-yl)-4′-methyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Hydroxymethyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 5-(5-Methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-2′-trifluoromethoxy-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Fluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 3-(2-Methoxy-pyrimidin-5-yl)-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-benzamide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Methoxy-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 3-(5-Methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-5-pyridin-4-yl-benzamide;
    • 3-(5-Methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-5-pyridin-3-yl-benzamide;
    • 5-(5-Methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-pyridin-4-yl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 3″-Dimethylamino-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4″-Cyano-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 3″,4″-Difluoro-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4″-Hydroxymethyl-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2″-Cyano-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Dimethylaminomethyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 3,5-Bis-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl)-benzamide;
    • 4-Methyl-2″-trifluoromethyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 3-(5-Methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-5-pyridin-2-yl-benzamide;
    • 2′,3′-Difluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Hydroxymethyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-4′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′,3′-Difluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-piperidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-piperidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-piperidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-piperidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 3-(5-Amino-pyrazin-2-yl)-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-benzamide;
    • 3-(2-Cyano-pyridin-3-yl)-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-benzamide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5-pyridin-2-yl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 2′-Hydroxymethyl-5-pyridin-2-yl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 2′-Methoxymethyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 3-(4-Cyano-pyridin-3-yl)-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-benzamide;
    • 5′-(5-Methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-2,3′-dicarboxylic acid 2-amide 3′-{[(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide};
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-3′-fluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 2′-Methoxymethyl-5-pyridin-2-yl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 5′-(5-Methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-2,3′-dicarboxylic acid 2-dimethylamide 3′-{[(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide};
    • 3-(4-Cyano-pyridin-3-yl)-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N—[(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-benzamide;
    • 3-(5-Methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N—[(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-5-(2-oxo-piperidin-1-yl)-benzamide;
    • 3-(5-Methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N—[(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-5-(3-oxo-morpholin-4-yl)-benzamide;
    • 3-(5-Methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N—[(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-benzamide;
    • 5-((S)-2-Hydroxymethyl-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-4′-methyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-piperazin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 5-((R)-2-Hydroxymethyl-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-4′-methyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 3-((R)-2-Hydroxymethyl-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-benzamide;
    • 2′-Cyano-4′-methyl-5-(3-oxo-morpholin-4-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-4′-methyl-5-(2-oxo-piperazin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-4′-methyl-5-(2-oxo-piperazin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-4′-methyl-5-(4-methyl-2-oxo-piperazin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(4-methyl-2-oxo-piperazin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′,3′-Difluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (1-methoxymethyl-propyl)-amide;
    • 2′,3′-Difluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 6′-Cyano-2′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((R)-1-methyl-2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-hydroxy-1-methoxymethyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (1-methoxymethyl-propyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Cyano-2′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′,3′-Difluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((R)-1-methyl-2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′,3′-Difluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-hydroxy-1-methoxymethyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-5′-trifluoromethyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-5′-trifluoromethyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((R)-1-methyl-2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-amide;
    • N—((S)-2-Hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-3-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-5-(3-trifluoromethyl-pyridin-2-yl)-benzamide;
    • 2′-Hydroxymethyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Fluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-6′-trifluoromethyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((R)-1-methyl-2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 3-(4-Cyano-pyridin-3-yl)-N—((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-benzamide;
    • 2-Cyano-2″,3″-difluoro-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5-(4-cyano-pyridin-3-yl)-4′-methyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5-(4-cyano-pyridin-3-yl)-4′-methyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((R)-1-methyl-2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-amide; and
    • 2-Cyano-2″-hydroxymethyl-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • With regard to formula 1, in certain embodiments, the compound is selected from (R1=heterocycloalkyl):
    • 2′-Cyano-5′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((R)-1-methyl-2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′,3′-Difluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((R)-1-methyl-2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-5′-trifluoromethyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((R)-1-methyl-2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Fluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-6′-trifluoromethyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((R)-1-methyl-2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-amide; and
    • 2′-Cyano-5-(4-cyano-pyridin-3-yl)-4′-methyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((R)-1-methyl-2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-amide;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • With regard to formula 1, in certain embodiments, the compound is selected from (R1=alkyl):
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′,3′-Difluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (1-methoxymethyl-propyl)-amide;
    • 2′,3′-Difluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 6′-Cyano-2′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-hydroxy-1-methoxymethyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (1-methoxymethyl-propyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Cyano-2′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′,3′-Difluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-hydroxy-1-methoxymethyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-5′-trifluoromethyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • N—((S)-2-Hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-3-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-5-(3-trifluoromethyl-pyridin-2-yl)-benzamide;
    • 2′-Hydroxymethyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 3-(4-Cyano-pyridin-3-yl)-N—((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-benzamide;
    • 2-Cyano-2″,3″-difluoro-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-5-(4-cyano-pyridin-3-yl)-4′-methyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide; and
    • 2-Cyano-2″-hydroxymethyl-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide;
      • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • With regard to formula 1, in certain embodiments, the compound is selected from (R3=heterocycloalkyl):
    • 4′ ethyl-5-(2-oxo-piperidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-piperidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-piperidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-piperidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl-]amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-yl)-ethyl]-amide;
    • 3-(5-Methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N—[(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-5-(2-oxo-piperidin-1-yl)-benzamide;
    • 3-(5-Methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N—[(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-5-(3-oxo-morpholin-4-yl)-benzamide;
    • 3-(5-Methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N—[(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-benzamide;
    • 5-((S)-2-Hydroxymethyl-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-4′-methyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-piperazin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 5-((R)-2-Hydroxymethyl-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-4′-methyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 3-((R)-2-Hydroxymethyl-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)—N-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-benzamide;
    • 2′-Cyano-4′-methyl-5-(3-oxo-morpholin-4-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-4′-methyl-5-(2-oxo-piperazin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-4′-methyl-5-(2-oxo-piperazin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 2′-Cyano-4′-methyl-5-(4-methyl-2-oxo-piperazin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
    • 4′-Methyl-5-(4-methyl-2-oxo-piperazin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide;
      or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
  • Additional embodiments within the scope provided herein are set forth in non-limiting fashion elsewhere herein and in the examples. It should be understood that these examples are for illustrative purposes only and are not to be construed as limiting in any manner.
  • In certain aspects, provided herein are prodrugs and derivatives of the compounds according to the formulae above. Prodrugs are derivatives of the compounds provided herein, which have metabolically cleavable groups and become by solvolysis or under physiological conditions the compounds provided herein, which are pharmaceutically active, in vivo. Such examples include, but are not limited to, choline ester derivatives and the like, N-alkylmorpholine esters and the like.
  • Certain compounds provided herein have activity in both their acid and acid derivative forms, but the acid sensitive form often offers advantages of solubility, tissue compatibility, or delayed release in the mammalian organism (see, Bundgard, H., Design of Prodrugs, pp. 7-9, 21-24, Elsevier, Amsterdam 1985). Prodrugs include acid derivatives well know to practitioners of the art, such as, for example, esters prepared by reaction of the parent acid with a suitable alcohol, or amides prepared by reaction of the parent acid compound with a substituted or unsubstituted amine, or acid anhydrides, or mixed anhydrides. Simple aliphatic or aromatic esters, amides and anhydrides derived from acidic groups pendant on the compounds provided herein are preferred prodrugs. In some cases it is desirable to prepare double ester type prodrugs such as (acyloxy)alkyl esters or ((alkoxycarbonyl)oxy)alkylesters. Preferred are the C1 to C8 alkyl, C2-C8 alkenyl, aryl, C7-C12 substituted aryl, and C7-C12 arylalkyl esters of the compounds provided herein.
  • Pharmaceutical Compositions
  • When employed as pharmaceuticals, the compounds provided herein are typically administered in the form of a pharmaceutical composition. Such compositions can be prepared in a manner well known in the pharmaceutical art and comprise at least one active compound.
  • Generally, the compounds provided herein are administered in a therapeutically effective amount. The amount of the compound actually administered will typically be determined by a physician, in the light of the relevant circumstances, including the condition to be treated, the chosen route of administration, the actual compound-administered, the age, weight, and response of the individual patient, the severity of the patient's symptoms, and the like.
  • The pharmaceutical compositions provided herein can be administered by a variety of routes including oral, rectal, transdermal, subcutaneous, intravenous, intramuscular, and intranasal. Depending on the intended route of delivery, the compounds provided herein are preferably formulated as either injectable or oral compositions or as salves, as lotions or as patches all for transdermal administration.
  • The compositions for oral administration can take the form of bulk liquid solutions or suspensions, or bulk powders. More commonly, however, the compositions are presented in unit dosage forms to facilitate accurate dosing. The term “unit dosage forms” refers to physically discrete units suitable as unitary dosages for human subjects and other mammals, each unit containing a predetermined quantity of active material calculated to produce the desired therapeutic effect, in association with a suitable pharmaceutical excipient. Typical unit dosage forms include prefilled, premeasured ampules or syringes of the liquid compositions or pills, tablets, capsules or the like in the case of solid compositions. In such compositions, the furansulfonic acid compound is usually a minor component (from about 0.1 to about 50% by weight or preferably from about 1 to about 40% by weight) with the remainder being various vehicles or carriers and processing aids helpful for forming the desired dosing form.
  • Liquid forms suitable for oral administration may include a suitable aqueous or nonaqueous vehicle with buffers, suspending and dispensing agents, colorants, flavors and the like. Solid forms may include, for example, any of the following ingredients, or compounds of a similar nature: a binder such as microcrystalline cellulose, gum tragacanth or gelatin; an excipient such as starch or lactose, a disintegrating agent such as alginic acid, Primogel, or corn starch; a lubricant such as magnesium stearate; a glidant such as colloidal silicon dioxide; a sweetening agent such as sucrose or saccharin; or a flavoring agent such as peppermint, methyl salicylate, or orange flavoring.
  • Injectable compositions are typically based upon injectable sterile saline or phosphate-buffered saline or other injectable carriers known in the art. As before, the active compound in such compositions is typically a minor component, often being from about 0.05 to 10% by weight with the remainder being the injectable carrier and the like.
  • Transdermal compositions are typically formulated as a topical ointment or cream containing the active ingredient(s), generally in an amount ranging from about 0.01 to about 20% by weight, preferably from about 0.1 to about 20% by weight, preferably from about 0.1 to about 10% by weight, and more preferably from about 0.5 to about 15% by weight. When formulated as a ointment, the active ingredients will typically be combined with either a paraffinic or a water-miscible ointment base. Alternatively, the active ingredients may be formulated in a cream with, for example an oil-in-water cream base. Such transdermal formulations are well-known in the art and generally include additional ingredients to enhance the dermal penetration of stability of the active ingredients or the formulation. All such known transdermal formulations and ingredients are included within the scope provided herein.
  • The compounds provided herein can also be administered by a transdermal device. Accordingly, transdermal administration can be accomplished using a patch either of the reservoir or porous membrane type, or of a solid matrix variety.
  • The above-described components for orally administrable, injectable or topically administrable compositions are merely representative. Other materials as well as processing techniques and the like are set forth in Part 8 of Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 17th edition, 1985, Mack Publishing Company, Easton, Pa., which is incorporated herein by reference.
  • The above-described components for orally administrable, injectable or topically administrable compositions are merely representative. Other materials as well as processing techniques and the like are set forth in Part 8 of Remington's The Science and Practice of Pharmacy, 21st edition, 2005, Publisher: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins, which is incorporated herein by reference.
  • The compounds of this invention can also be administered in sustained release forms or from sustained release drug delivery systems. A description of representative sustained release materials can be found in Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences.
  • The following formulation examples illustrate representative pharmaceutical compositions that may be prepared in accordance with this invention. The present invention, however, is not limited to the following pharmaceutical compositions.
  • Formulation 1 Tablets
  • A compound of the invention may be admixed as a dry powder with a dry gelatin binder in an approximate 1:2 weight ratio. A minor amount of magnesium stearate may be added as a lubricant. The mixture is formed into 240-270 mg tablets (80-90 mg of active amide compound per tablet) in a tablet press.
  • Formulation 2 Capsules
  • A compound of the invention may be admixed as a dry powder with a starch diluent in an approximate 1:1 weight ratio. The mixture may be filled into 250 mg capsules (125 mg of active amide compound per capsule).
  • Formulation 3 Liquid
  • A compound of the invention (125 mg), sucrose (1.75 g) and xanthan gum (4 mg) may be admixed with sucrose (1.75 g) and xanthan gum (4 mg) and the resultant mixture may be blended, passed through a No. 10 mesh U.S. sieve, and then mixed with a previously made solution of microcrystalline cellulose and sodium carboxymethyl cellulose (11:89, 50 mg) in water. Sodium benzoate (10 mg), flavor, and color are diluted with water and added with stirring. Sufficient water is then added to produce a total volume of 5 mL.
  • Formulation 4 Tablets
  • A compound of the invention may be admixed as a dry powder with a dry gelatin binder in an approximate 1:2 weight ratio. A minor amount of magnesium stearate is added as a lubricant. The mixture is formed into 450-900 mg tablets (150-300 mg of active amide compound) in a tablet press.
  • Formulation 5 Injection
  • A compound of the invention may be dissolved or suspended in a buffered sterile saline injectable aqueous medium to a concentration of approximately 5 mg/ml.
  • Formulation 6 Topical
  • Stearyl alcohol (250 g) and a white petrolatum (250 g) may be melted at about 75° C. and then a mixture of a compound of the invention (50 g) methylparaben (0.25 g), propylparaben (0.15 g), sodium lauryl sulfate (10 g), and propylene glycol (120 g) dissolved in water (about 370 g) is added and the resulting mixture is stirred until it congeals.
  • Methods of Treatment
  • The present compounds are used as therapeutic agents for the treatment of conditions in mammals. Accordingly, the compounds and pharmaceutical compositions provided herein find use as therapeutics for preventing and/or treating neurodegenerative, autoimmune and inflammatory conditions in mammals including humans and non-human mammals. Thus, and as stated earlier, the present invention includes within its scope, and extends to, the recited methods of treatment, as well as to the compounds for such methods, and to the use of such compounds for the preparation of medicaments useful for such methods.
  • In a method of treatment aspect, provided herein is a method of treating a mammal susceptible to or afflicted with a condition associated with arthritis, asthma, myocardial infarction, inflammatory bowel disease and autoimmune disorders, which method comprises administering an effective amount of one or more of the pharmaceutical compositions just described.
  • In yet another method of treatment aspect, provided herein is a method of treating a mammal susceptible to or afflicted with a condition that gives rise to pain responses or that relates to imbalances in the maintenance of basal activity of sensory nerves. The present compounds have use as analgesics for the treatment of pain of various geneses or etiology, for example acute, inflammatory pain (such as pain associated with osteoarthritis and rheumatoid arthritis); various neuropathic pain syndromes (such as post-herpetic neuralgia, trigeminal neuralgia, reflex sympathetic dystrophy, diabetic neuropathy, Guillian Barre syndrome, fibromyalgia, phantom limb pain, post-masectomy pain, peripheral neuropathy, HIV neuropathy, and chemotherapy-induced and other iatrogenic neuropathies); visceral pain, (such as that associated with gastroesophageal reflex disease, irritable bowel syndrome, inflammatory bowel disease, pancreatitis, and various gynecological and urological disorders), dental pain and headache (such as migraine, cluster headache and tension headache).
  • In additional method of treatment aspects, provided herein are methods of treating a mammal susceptible to or afflicted with neurodegenerative diseases and disorders such as, for example Parkinson's disease, Alzheimer's disease and multiple sclerosis; diseases and disorders which are mediated by or result in neuroinflammation such as, for example encephalitis; centrally-mediated neuropsychiatric diseases and disorders such as, for example depression mania, bipolar disease, anxiety, schizophrenia, eating disorders, sleep disorders and cognition disorders; epilepsy and seizure disorders; prostate, bladder and bowel dysfunction such as, for example urinary incontinence, urinary hesitancy, rectal hypersensitivity, fecal incontinence, benign prostatic hypertrophy and inflammatory bowel disease; respiratory and airway disease and disorders such as, for example, allergic rhinitis, asthma and reactive airway disease and chronic obstructive pulmonary disease; diseases and disorders which are mediated by or result in inflammation such as, for example rheumatoid arthritis and osteoarthritis, myocardial infarction, various autoimmune diseases and disorders; itch/pruritus such as, for example psoriasis; obesity; lipid disorders; cancer; and renal disorders method comprises administering an effective condition-treating or condition-preventing amount of one or more of the pharmaceutical compositions just described.
  • As a further aspect there is provided the present compounds for use as a pharmaceutical especially in the treatment or prevention of the aforementioned conditions and diseases. We also provide the use of the present compounds in the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment or prevention of one of the aforementioned conditions and diseases.
  • Injection dose levels range from about 0.1 mg/kg/hour to at least 10 mg/kg/hour, all for from about 1 to about 120 hours and especially 24 to 96 hours. A preloading bolus of from about 0.1 mg/kg to about 10 mg/kg or more may also be administered to achieve adequate steady state levels. The maximum total dose is not expected to exceed about 2 g/day for a 40 to 80 kg human patient.
  • For the prevention and/or treatment of long-term conditions, such as neurodegenerative and autoimmune conditions, the regimen for treatment usually stretches over many months or years so oral dosing is preferred for patient convenience and tolerance. With oral dosing, one to five and especially two to four and typically three oral doses per day are representative regimens. Using these dosing patterns, each dose provides from about 0.01 to about 20 mg/kg of the compound provided herein, with preferred doses each providing from about 0.1 to about 10 mg/kg and especially about 1 to about 5 mg/kg.
  • Transdermal doses are generally selected to provide similar or lower blood levels than are achieved using injection doses.
  • When used to prevent the onset of a neurodegenerative, autoimmune or inflammatory condition, the compounds provided herein will be administered to a patient at risk for developing the condition, typically on the advice and under the supervision of a physician, at the dosage levels described above. Patients at risk for developing a particular condition generally include those that have a family history of the condition, or those who have been identified by genetic testing or screening to be particularly susceptible to developing the condition.
  • The compounds provided herein can be administered as the sole active agent or they can be administered in combination with other agents, including other active amines and derivatives. Administration in combination can proceed by any technique apparent to those of skill in the art including, for example, separate, sequential, concurrent and alternating administration.
  • General Synthetic Procedures
  • The compounds provided herein can be prepared from readily available starting materials using the following general methods and procedures. See, e.g., FIG. 1 and Synthetic Schemes 1-10 below. It will be appreciated that where typical or preferred process conditions (i.e., reaction temperatures, times, mole ratios of reactants, solvents, pressures, etc.) are given, other process conditions can also be used unless otherwise stated. Optimum reaction conditions may vary with the particular reactants or solvent used, but such conditions can be determined by one skilled in the art by routine optimization procedures.
  • Additionally, as will be apparent to those skilled in the art, conventional protecting groups may be necessary to prevent certain functional groups from undergoing undesired reactions. The choice of a suitable protecting group for a particular functional group as well as suitable conditions for protection and deprotection are well known in the art. For example, numerous protecting groups, and their introduction and removal, are described in T. W. Greene and P. G. M. Wuts, Protecting Groups in Organic Synthesis, Second Edition, Wiley, New York, 1991, and references cited therein.
  • The compounds provided herein, for example, may be prepared by the reaction of a chloro derivative with an appropriately substituted amine and the product isolated and purified by known standard procedures. Such procedures include (but are not limited to) recrystallization, column chromatography or HPLC. The following schemes are presented with details as to the preparation of representative fused heterocyclics that have been listed hereinabove. The compounds provided herein may be prepared from known or commercially available starting materials and reagents by one skilled in the art of organic synthesis.
  • The enantiomerically pure compounds provided herein may be prepared according to any techniques known to those of skill in the art. For instance, they may be prepared by chiral or asymmetric synthesis from a suitable optically pure precursor or obtained from a racemate by any conventional technique, for example, by chromatographic resolution using a chiral column, TLC or by the preparation of diastereoisomers, separation thereof and regeneration of the desired enantiomer. See, e.g., “Enantiomers, Racemates and Resolutions,” by J. Jacques, A. Collet, and S. H. Wilen, (Wiley-Interscience, New York, 1981); S. H. Wilen, A. Collet, and J. Jacques, Tetrahedron, 2725 (1977); E. L. Eliel Stereochemistry of Carbon Compounds (McGraw-Hill, N.Y., 1962); and S. H. Wilen Tables of Resolving Agents and Optical Resolutions 268 (E. L. Eliel ed., Univ. of Notre Dame Press, Notre Dame, Ind., 1972, Stereochemistry of Organic Compounds, Ernest L. Eliel, Samuel H. Wilen and Lewis N. Manda (1994 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.), and Stereoselective Synthesis A Practical Approach, Mihály Nógrádi (1995 VCH Publishers, Inc., NY, N.Y.).
  • In certain embodiments, an enantiomerically pure compound of formula 1 may be obtained by reaction of the racemate with a suitable optically active acid or base. Suitable acids or bases include those described in Bighley et al., 1995, Salt Forms of Drugs and Adsorption, in Encyclopedia of Pharmaceutical Technology, vol. 13, Swarbrick & Boylan, eds., Marcel Dekker, New York; ten Hoeve & H. Wynberg, 1985, Journal of Organic Chemistry 50:4508-4514; Dale & Mosher, 1973, J. Am. Chem. Soc. 95:512; and CRC Handbook of Optical Resolution via Diastereomeric Salt Formation, the contents of which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entireties.
  • Enantiomerically pure compounds can also be recovered either from the crystallized diastereomer or from the mother liquor, depending on the solubility properties of the particular acid resolving agent employed and the particular acid enantiomer used. The identity and optical purity of the particular compound so recovered can be determined by polarimetry or other analytical methods known in the art. The diasteroisomers can then be separated, for example, by chromatography or fractional crystallization, and the desired enantiomer regenerated by treatment with an appropriate base or acid. The other enantiomer may be obtained from the racemate in a similar manner or worked up from the liquors of the first separation.
  • In certain embodiments, enantiomerically pure compound can be separated from racemic compound by chiral chromatography. Various chiral columns and eluents for use in the separation of the enantiomers are available and suitable conditions for the separation can be empirically determined by methods known to one of skill in the art. Exemplary chiral columns available for use in the separation of the enantiomers provided herein include, but are not limited to CHIRALCEL® OB, CHIRALCEL® OB-H, CHIRALCEL® OD, CHIRALCEL® OD-H, CHIRALCEL® OF, CHIRALCEL® OG, CHIRALCEL® OJ and CHIRALCEL® OK.
  • Various compounds of the invention can be prepared using a general procedures or synthetic schemes described below.
  • Synthetic Schemes
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00055
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00056
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00057
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00058
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00059
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00060
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00061
  • In Schemes 1-11 above, each of X1 and X2 is independently selected from F, Cl, Br, I, and OTf; R is selected from H, C1-C6 alkyl, and benzyl; n=0, 1, or 2; Q=Substituted or unsubstituted C, N, O, S(O)n; and A, B, W, X′, L, R1, R3, R4c, R4d, R5a, L and m′ are as described herein.
  • SYNTHESIS OF INTERMEDIATES Intermediate A 5-Bromo-4′-methylbiphenyl-3-carboxylic acid
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00062
  • A pressure vial was charged with 3-bromo-5-iodo-benzoic acid (7.60 g, 23.2 mmol), p-tolylboronic acid (3.16 g, 23.2 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (1.34 g, 1.16 mmol), cesium carbonate (8.33 g, 25.6 mmol), toluene (99.0 mL, 930 mmol), ethanol (27.1 mL, 465 mmol) and water (12.6 mL, 697 mmol) and the reaction stirred at 85° C. over nights. The reaction mixture was filtered over celite and the solvent removed to get the crude product as a brown solid.
  • LC/MS m/e 289.7 (M−H+)
  • Intermediate B 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxopiperidin-1-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00063
  • A) Methyl 3-iodo-5-nitrobenzoate
  • To a stirred solution of 3-iodo-5-nitrobenzoic acid (15.1 g, 0.049 mol) in methanol (151 mL, 3.73 mol) was added thionyl chloride (15.1 mL, 0.205 mol) dropwise at 0° C. The mixture was heated to reflux for 2 hours. The solvent was removed in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (0-100% EtOAc/hexane) to afford an white solid.
  • B) Methyl 4′-methyl-5-nitrobiphenyl-3-carboxylate
  • To a stirred solution of methyl 3-iodo-5-nitrobenzoate (7.76 g, 24 mmol) and p-tolylboronic acid (3.94 g, 28 mmol) in toluene (576 mL) was added cesium carbonate (9.4 g, 28 mmol) in water (7.8 mL). The mixture was purged with nitrogen, and then tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (860 mg, 0.74 mmol) was added at room temperature. The reaction mixture was heated to reflux for 3 days. After cooling, the mixture was filtered through Celite and the filtrate was concentrated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography to afford a white solid.
  • C) Methyl 5-amino-4′-methylbiphenyl-3-carboxylate
  • To a stirred solution methyl 4′-methyl-5-nitrobiphenyl-3-carboxylate (4.58 g, 16 mmol) in methanol (130 mL) was added tin dichloride (12.56 g, 64.2 mmol) at room temperature. The mixture was heated under reflux for 3 hours. After cooling, the mixture was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was treated with water, basified to pH=9 by addition of Na2CO3, and extracted with CH2Cl2. The organic layer was dried over MgSO4, filtered and concentrated to afford a white solid.
  • 1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl3): 7.85 (t, 1H, J=1.5 Hz), 7.57 (t, 1H, J=1.8 Hz), 7.48 (d, 2H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.35 (t, 1H, J=2.0 Hz), 7.22 (d, 2H, J=8.1 Hz), 3.90 (s, 3H), 2.37 (s, 3H).
  • D) 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxopiperidin-1-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid
  • To a stirred solution of methyl 5-amino-4′-methylbiphenyl-3-carboxylate (410 mg, 1.7 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (30 mL) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (0.44 mL, 2.5 mmol) at 0° C. was added 5-bromopentanoyl chloride (370 mg, 1.9 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight and then washed with aq. Na2CO3 solution and brine, dried (Na2SO4), and concentrated. The residue was dissolved in THF (30 mL) and cooled to 0° C. Sodium tert-butoxide (200 mg, 2.0 mmol) was added and the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 3 h. LC-MS indicated the cyclization reaction was complete. MeOH (20 mL) and water (10 mL) were added followed by lithium hydroxide (120 mg, 5.1 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature for another 3 h, and LC-MS indicated the saponification was complete. The mixture was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was treated with water and acidified to pH 2-3 with 1N HCl, extracted with EtOAc (3×50 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4), and concentrated to afford a white solid. LC-MS: 310.1 [M+1]+.
  • Intermediate C 3-(5-Methylpyridin-2-yl)-5-(3-oxomorpholino)benzoic acid
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00064
  • A) Methyl 3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate
  • A microwave vial was charged with methyl 3-bromo-5-iodobenzoate (2.00 g, 5.87 mmol), 5-methyl-2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine (2.24 g, 5.87 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (339 mg, 0.29 mmol) and 1,4-dioxane (30 mL). The reaction mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation at 120° C. for 1 hour. The reaction was filtered through Celite and the filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography to afford the product as a white solid.
  • 1H NMR (400 Hz, DMSO-d6): 8.64 (t, J=1.51 Hz, 1H), 8.55 (m, 1H), 8.52 (t, J=1.89 Hz, 1H), 8.07 (t, J=1.89 Hz, 1H), 8.03 (d, J=8.31 Hz, 1H), 7.75 (dd, J=8.31 & 2.27 Hz, 1H), 3.91 (s, 1H), 2.36 (s, 1H).
  • B) Methyl 3-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-5-(3-oxomorpholino)benzoate
  • A microwave vial was charged with methyl 3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate (100 mg, 0.33 mmol), morpholin-3-one (42 mg, 0.41 mmol), palladium acetate (4 mg), cesium carbonate (169 mg, 0.52 mmol), xantphos (3 mg), and 1,4-dioxane (1 mL). The reaction mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation at 110° C. for 15 min. The reaction mixture was filtered and the filterate was concentrated under reduced pressure. The resultant residue was purified by preparative HPLC to get the product as a yellow solid.
  • C) 3-(5-Methylpyridin-2-yl)-5-(3-oxomorpholino)benzoic acid
  • A round bottom flask was charged with methyl 3-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-5-(3-oxomorpholino)benzoate (50 mg, 0.15 mmol), methanol (1.2 mL) and lithium hydroxide (11 mg, 0.46 mmol) and the reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 1 h. The reaction mixture was acidified to pH=5 and concentrated under reduced pressure to get the title compound-LiCl mixture as a white solid.
  • Intermediate D 3-Bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoic acid
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00065
  • A round bottom flask was charged with methyl 3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate (300 mg, 0.98 mmol), tetrahydrofuran (15 mL) and lithium hydroxide (70 mg, 2.94 mmol) and the reaction mixture was stirred at 50° C. overnight. After cooling, the reaction mixture was acidified to pH=5 and concentrated under reduced pressure to get the title compound-LiCl mixture.
  • Intermediate E 2′,3′-difluoro-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00066
  • A) Methyl 3-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)benzoate
  • To a mixture of methyl 3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate (901 mg, 2.94 mmol), bis(pinacolato)diboron (1.1 g, 4.4 mmol), potassium acetate (1.445 g, 14.72 mmol), and N,N-dimethylformamide (0.63 mL, 8.1 mmol) under argon was added [1,1′-dis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocene]dichloropalladium(II), complex with dichloromethane (1:1) (216 mg, 0.26 mmol). The mixture was heated under argon at 80° C. overnight, and then cooled to rt. Water (50 mL) was added and the mixture was extracted with EtOAc (50 mL×3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4), and evaporated. The residue was purified by silica gel column (0-50% EtOAc-hexane) to yield a light green solid.
  • B) Methyl 2′,3′-difluoro-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylate
  • Into a 5 mL microwave vial were charged with methyl 3-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)benzoate (250 mg, 0.71 mmol), 1-bromo-2,3-difluorobenzene (273 mg, 1.42 mmol), cesium carbonate (1.15 g, 3.54 mmol), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (261 mg, 0.71 mmol), POPd (35 mg, 0.071 mmol), water (0.5 mL) and N,N-dimethylformamide (3 mL). The reaction mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation at 150° C. for 10 mins. After cooling, the reaction mixture was extracted with ethylacetate. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried, and concentrated under reduced pressure to give the residue which was purified by silica gel column to yield the title compound.
  • C) 2′,3′-Difluoro-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid
  • A round bottom flask was charged with methyl 2′,3′-difluoro-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylate (297 mg, 0.87 mmol), potassium carbonate (303 mg, 2.19 mmol) and methanol (5 mL) and few drops of water. The reaction was stirred at room temperature for 24 hours, then acidified to pH=5 and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford the title compound-LiCl mixture.
  • Intermediate F 2′-Cyano-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-5′-(trifluoromethyl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00067
  • A) Methyl 2′-cyano-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-5′-(trifluoromethyl)biphenyl-3-carboxylate
  • Into a 5 mL microwave vial were charged methyl 3-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)benzoate (300 mg, 0.85 mmol), 2-bromo-4-(trifluoromethyl)benzonitrile (425 mg, 1.70 mmol), cesium carbonate (1.38 g, 4.25 mmol), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (314 mg, 0.85 mmol), POPd (43 mg, 0.085 mmol), water (0.6 mL) and N,N-dimethylformamide (3 mL). The reaction mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation at 150° C. for 10 mins. After cooling, the reaction mixture was extracted with ethylacetate. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried, and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford the residue which was purified by silica gel column to yield the title compound.
  • B) 2′-Cyano-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-5′-(trifluoromethyl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid
  • A round bottom flask was charged with methyl 2′-cyano-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-5′-(trifluoromethyl)biphenyl-3-carboxylate (106 mg, 0.27 mmol), lithium hydroxide (19 mg, 0.81 mmol), methanol (4.0 mL) and a few drops of water. The reaction was stirred at room temperature for 1 day, and then acidified to pH=5 and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford the title compound-LiCl mixture.
  • Intermediate G 2′-Cyano-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-5′-(trifluoromethyl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00068
  • A) Methyl 5-bromo-2′-cyano-4′-methylbiphenyl-3-carboxylate
  • Into a microwave vial were charged methyl 3-bromo-5-iodobenzoate (1.3 g, 3.8 mmol), 5-methyl-2-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)benzonitrile (1.1 g, 4.6 mmol), cesium carbonate (3.1 g, 9.5 mmol), and tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (44 q mg, 0.38 mmol), water (3 mL) and toluene (8 mL). The reaction mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation at 100° C. for 1 h. After cooling, the reaction was filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by reversed phase HPLC (acetonitrile:water gradient) to the title compound as a white solid. LC-MS: 331.1 [M+1]+; 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3): 8.16 (s, 1H), 8.03 (t, J=1.3 Hz, 1H), 7.76 (t, J=1.8 Hz, 1H), 7.53 (s, 1H), 7.33 (dd, J=1.6, 9.4 Hz, 1H), 7.25 9 d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H), 3.93 (s, 3H), 2.43 (s, 3H).
  • B) Methyl 2′-cyano-4′-methyl-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylate
  • To a mixture of methyl 5-bromo-2′-cyano-4′-methylbiphenyl-3-carboxylate (1.0 g, 3.0 mol), bis(pinacolato)diboron (1.1 g, 4.5 mmol), Potassium acetate (1.486 g, 15.1 mmol), and N,N-dimethylformamide (12 mL) under argon was added [1,1′-Bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocene]dichloropalladium(II), complex with dichloromethane (1:1) (223 mg, 0.27 mmol). The mixture was heated under argon at 80° C. overnight, and then cooled to rt. Water (50 mL) was added and the mixture was extracted with EtOAc (50 mL×3). The combined organic layers were washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4), and evaporated. The residue was purified by silica gel column (0-50% EtOAc-hexane) to give a white solid.
  • C) 2′-Cyano-5-(4-cyanopyridin-3-yl)-4′-methylbiphenyl-3-carboxylic acid
  • Into a 5 mL microwave vial were charged methyl 2′-cyano-4′-methyl-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylate (150 mg, 0.36 mmol), 3-bromoisonicotinonitrile (131 mg, 0.72 mmol), cesium carbonate (583 mg, 1.79 mmol), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (132 mg, 0.36 mmol), POPd (18 mg, 0.036 mmol), water (0.3 mL) and N,N-dimethylformamide (1 mL). The reaction mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation at 150° C. for 10 mins. The reaction mixture was purified by HPLC to afford the title compound.
  • Intermediate H 2-Cyano-2″-hydroxymethyl-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid methyl ester
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00069
  • Into a 5 mL microwave vial were charged methyl 5-bromo-2′-cyano-4′-methylbiphenyl-3-carboxylate (95 mg, 0.29 mmol), 2-(hydroxymethyl)phenylboronic acid (87 mg, 0.57 mmol), cesium carbonate (466 mg, 1.43 mmol), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (106 mg, 0.29 mmol), POPd (14 mg, 0.029 mmol), water (0.2 mL) and N,N-dimethylformamide (1 mL). The reaction mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation for 10 mins at 150° C. After cooling, the reaction mixture was extracted with ethylacetate. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried, and concentrated under reduced pressure to give the residue which was purified by HPLC to yield the title compound.
  • Intermediate J (2-Methylpyrimidin-5-yl)methanamine
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00070
  • a. (2-Methylpyrimidin-5-yl)methanol
  • A solution of 2-methylpyrimidine-5-carbaldehyde (7.5 g, 0.058 mol) in methanol (370 mL, 9.1 mol) was cooled to 0° C. and treated with sodium tetrahydroborate (3.4 g, 0.090 mol). After 30 min, the reaction was quenched with eq H2O (200 mL) and extracted with ethyl acetate. The organic layer was dried over MgSO4 and concentrated to give the title compound as a yellow solid.
  • b. 5-(Azidomethyl)-2-methylpyrimidine
  • A solution of (2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)methanol (0.82 g, 6.6 mmol) in toluene (30 mL, 300 mmol) and methylene chloride (40 mL, 600 mmol) at 0° C. was treated with diphenylphosphonic azide (2.8 mL, 13 mmol) followed by 1,8-diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene (2.0 mL, 13 mmol) and stirred for 2 h at 0° C. After being further stirred at rt for 16 h, the reaction mixture was diluted with water (50 mL) and DCM (50 mL). The organic layer was separated and washed with brine; dried (Mg2SO4), filtered, and concentration. The residue was purified by column to give the product as a colorless oil.
  • LC/MS m/e 148.0 (M−H+)
  • (2-Methylpyrimidin-5-yl)methanamine
  • A mixture of 5-(azidomethyl)-2-methylpyrimidine (55 mg, 0.00037 mol) in ethyl acetate (20 mL, 0.2 mol), and 10% Pd—C (70 mg) was stirred under H2 (1 atm) for 2 hr. The catalyst was filtered off and filtrate was concentrated in vacuo to afford a white solid. LC/MS m/e 124.3 (M+H+)
  • Intermediate K 5-Bromo-4′-methyl-N-((2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)methyl)biphenyl-3-carboxamide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00071
  • A round bottom flask was charged with 5-bromo-4′-methylbiphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (1.00 g, 2.75 mmol), (2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)methanamine (0.406 g, 3.30 mmol), N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyl-O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)uroniumh (2.40 g, 6.32 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (1.91 mL, 11.0 mmol) and N,N-dimethylformamide (10 mL, 100 mmol) and the reaction stirred for 3 hours. The reaction was then quenched with water and extracted with ethyl acetate and washed with brine. The solvents were removed under reduced pressure and the residue purified by flash chromatograpy followed by prep HPLC to get the product as light yellow solid.
  • 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): δ 9.27 (t, J=5.62 Hz, 1H), 8.67 (s, 2H), 8.12 (t, J=1.57 Hz, 1H), 8.00 (t, J=1.84 Hz, 1H), 7.98 (t, J=1.84 Hz, 1H), 7.66 (d, J=8.13 Hz, 2H), 7.31 (d, J=8.15 Hz, 2H), 4.47 (d, J=5.69 Hz, 2H), 2.59 (s, 3H), 2.35 (s, 3H).
  • Synthesis of Representative Compounds Compound 1 4′-Methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl)-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00072
  • A mixture of 5-bromo-4′-methyl-N-((2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)methyl)biphenyl-3-carboxamide (40.00 mg, 0.09084 mmol), 5-methyl-2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine (0.05 g, 0.0001 mol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (2 mg, 0.000002 mol) and toluene (0.4 mL, 0.004 mol) was heated in the microwave at 120° C. for 1 hour. The mixture was cooled to room temperature and the reaction mixture filtered over celite and solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by prep HPLC to get the product as white solid.
  • LC/MS m/e=409.4.
  • Compound 2 4′-Methyl-5-pyrimidin-2-yl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl)-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00073
  • A mixture of 5-bromo-4′-methyl-N-((2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)methyl)biphenyl-3-carboxamide (100 mg, 0.0002 mol), 2-(tributylstannyl)pyrimidine (0.1 g, 0.0003 mol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (6 mg, 0.000005 mol) and toluene (1 mL, 0.009 mol) was heated in the microwave at 120° C. for 1 hour. LC/MS showed the desired product, LC/MS m/e=396.3. The mixture was cooled to room temperature and the reaction mixture filtered over celite and solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by reverse phase prep HPLC to get the product as white solid.
  • 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): δ 9.23 (t, J=1.45 Hz, 1H), 8.97 (d, J=4.70 Hz, 2H), 8.87 (t, J=1.45 Hz, 1H), 8.77 (t, J=1.45 Hz, 1H), 8.70 (s, 2H), 8.29 (t, J=1.45 Hz, 1H), 7.71 (d, J=8.38 Hz, 2H), 7.65-7.62 (m, 1H), 7.35 (d, J=7.74 Hz, 2H), 4.52 (d, J=4.84 Hz, 2H), 2.60 (s, 3H), 2.37 (s, 3H).
  • Compound 15 2′-Fluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00074
  • a. 3-Bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)benzamide
  • A round bottom flask was charged with 3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoic acid (450.00 mg, 1.5404 mmol), (6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methanamine (225.83 mg, 1.8485 mmol), N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyl-O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)uronium hexafluorophosphate (1171.4 mg, 3.0808 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (0.93910 mL, 5.3915 mmol) and N,N-dimethylformamide (5.00 mL, 64.6 mmol) and the reaction stirred at room temperature for 1 hour. The reaction was poured into brine and extracted with ethyl acetate to get the product as brown solid
  • b. 2′-Fluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide
  • In a 5 mL microwave vial, 3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)benzamide (20 mg, 0.05 mmol), 2-fluorophenylboronic acid (14.16 mg, 0.1012 mmol), cesium carbonate (82.42 mg, 0.2530 mmol), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (18.69 mg, 0.05060 mmol), and POPd (2.538 mg, 0.005060 mmol) were dissolved in Water (0.04 mL, 2 mmol) and N,N-dimethylformamide (0.2 mL, 2 mmol). The reaction mixture was microwaved for 20 mins at 150 degrees. The reaction was purified directly by reversed phase HPLC (acetonitrile:water gradient) at pH10. The combined pure fractions were reduced invacuo to afford the title compound as colorless oil.
  • 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): 9.28 (t, J=5.77 Hz, 1H), 8.58 (t, J=1.91 Hz, 1H), 8.55 (bs, 1H), 8.45 9 bs, 1H), 8.37 (q, J=1.76 Hz, 1H), 8.07 (q, J=1.76 Hz, 1H), 8.02 (d, J=8.34 Hz, 1H), 7.75 (dd, J=7.85 & 2.02 Hz, 1H), 7.70-7.63 (m, 2H), 7.51-7.46 (m, 1H), 7.39-7.34 (m, 2H), 7.22 (d, J=7.96 Hz, 1H), 4.50 (d, J=5.66 Hz, 2H), 2.44 (s, 3H), 2.36 (s, 3H)
  • Compound 18 2′-Methoxy-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00075
  • In a 5 mL microwave vial, 3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)benzamide (20 mg, 0.05 mmol), 2-methoxyphenylboronic acid (15.38 mg, 0.1012 mmol), cesium carbonate (82.42 mg, 0.2530 mmol), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (18.69 mg, 0.05060 mmol), and POPd (2.538 mg, 0.005060 mmol) were dissolved in Water (0.04 mL, 2 mmol) and N,N-dimethylformamide (0.2 mL, 2 mmol). The reaction mixture was microwaved for 20 mins at 150 degrees. The reaction was purified directly by reversed phase HPLC (acetonitrile:water gradient) at pH10. The combined pure fractions were reduced invacuo to afford the title compound as colorless oil.
  • Compound 22 4′-Methyl-5-pyridin-4-yl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00076
  • In a 5 mL microwave vial, 5-Bromo-4′-methyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide (20 mg, 0.05 mmol), Pyridine-4-boronic acid (12.44 mg, 0.1012 mmol), cesium carbonate (82.42 mg, 0.2530 mmol), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (18.69 mg, 0.05060 mmol), and POPd (2.538 mg, 0.005060 mmol) were dissolved in Water (0.04 mL, 2 mmol) and N,N-dimethylformamide (0.2 mL, 2 mmol). The reaction mixture was microwaved for 20 mins at 150 degrees. The reaction was purified directly by reversed phase HPLC (acetonitrile:water gradient) at pH10. The combined pure fractions were reduced invacuo to afford the title compound as an off white solid.
  • Compound 28 2′-Dimethylaminomethyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00077
  • In a 5 mL microwave vial, 3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)benzamide (15.00 mg, 0.03785 mmol), Unnamed (13.55 mg, 0.07570 mmol), cesium carbonate (61.66 mg, 0.1892 mmol), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (13.98 mg, 0.03785 mmol), and POPd (1.899 mg, 0.003785 mmol) were dissolved in Water (0.03 mL, 2 mmol) and N,N-dimethylformamide (0.1 mL, 2 mmol). The reaction mixture was microwaved for 20 mins at 150 degrees. The reaction was purified directly by reversed phase HPLC (acetonitrile:water gradient) at pH10. The combined pure fractions were reduced in vacuo to afford the title compound as a colorless oil.
  • 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): 9.21 (t, J=5.83 Hz, 1H), 8.57 (t, J=1.72 Hz, 1H), 8.54 (d, J=2.12 HZ, 1H), 8.44 (d, J=2.12 HZ, 1H), 8.28 (t, J=1.55 HZ, 1H), 7.97 (d, J=8.22 HZ, 1H), 7.93 (t, J=1.55 Hz, 1H), 7.74 (dd, J=8.06 & 2.02 Hz, 1H), 7.64 (dd, J=8.06 & 2.24 Hz, 1H), 7.52 (d, J=6.94 Hz, 1H), 7.43-7.34 (m, 3H), 7.21 (d, J=8.06 HZ, 1H), 4.48 (d, J=6.22 HZ, 2H), 2.43 (s, d3H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.07 (s, 6H).
  • Compound 30 4-Methyl-2″-trifluoromethyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00078
  • In a 5 mL microwave vial, 5-Bromo-4′-methyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide (30.00 mg, 0.07589 mmol), 2-(trifluoromethyl)phenylboronic acid (28.83 mg, 0.1518 mmol), cesium carbonate (123.6 mg, 0.3795 mmol), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (28.03 mg, 0.07589 mmol), and POPd (3.808 mg, 0.007589 mmol) were dissolved in Water (0.06 mL, 3 mmol) and N,N-dimethylformamide (0.3 mL, 4 mmol). The reaction mixture was microwaved for 20 mins at 150 degrees. The reaction was purified directly by reversed phase chromatography.
  • Compound 31 2′-Cyano-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00079
  • In a 5 mL microwave vial, (R)-3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-N-(1-(2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)ethyl)benzamide (50.00 mg, 0.1216 mmol), 2-cyanophenylboronic acid (35.72 mg, 0.2431 mmol), cesium carbonate (198.0 mg, 0.6078 mmol), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (44.90 mg, 0.1216 mmol), and POPd (6.100 mg, 0.01216 mmol) were dissolved in Water (0.09 mL, 5 mmol) and N,N-dimethylformamide (0.4 mL, 6 mmol). The reaction mixture was microwaved for 20 mins at 150 degrees. The reaction was purified directly by reversed phase HPLC (acetonitrile:water gradient) at pH10. The combined pure fractions were reduced invacuo to afford the title compound as white solid.
  • 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): 9.13 (d, J=7.43 Hz, 1H), 8.74 (s, 2H), 8.64 (t, J=1.75 Hz, 1H), 8.56 (d, J+2.18 Hz, 1H), 8.42 (t, J=1.44 Hz, 1H), 8.09 (t, J=1.60 Hz, 1H), 8.02 (t, J=8.17 Hz, 2H), 7.86 (t, J=7.64 Hz, 1H), 7.80-7.76 (m, 2H), 7.65 (t, J=7.81 Hz, 1H0, 5.26-5.19 (m, 1H), 2.59 (s, 3H), 2.36 (s, 3H), 1.56 (d, J=7.02 Hz, 3H).
  • Compound 37 4′-Methyl-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)-5-(2-oxopiperidin-1-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxamide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00080
  • To a mixture of 4′-methyl-5-(2-oxopiperidin-1-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (45 mg, 0.14 mmol), N-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-N′-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (56 mg, 0.29 mmol), 1-hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (22 mg, 0.14 mmol), and CH2Cl2 (3 mL) were added (6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methanamine (27 mg, 0.22 mmol) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (51 μL, 0.29 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight and then concentrated. The residue was purified by preparative HPLC (100×20.2 mm, C18 column; 30-80% CH3CN-water [10 mM Et2NH]) to afford a white foam.
  • LC-MS: 414.5 [M+1]+; 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): 9.19 (t, 1H, J=6.0 Hz), 8.43 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.03 (t, 1H, J=1.6 Hz), 7.72 (d, 2H, J=1.6 Hz), 7.65-7.60 (m, 3H), 7.30 (d, 2H, J=8.0 Hz), 7.21 (d, 1H, J=7.6 Hz), 4.47 (d, 2H, J=5.6 Hz), 3.69 (t, 2H, J=5.6 Hz), 2.44 (s, 3H), 2.41 (t, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 2.36 (s, 3H), 1.94-1.80 (m, 4H).
  • Compound 38 4′-Methyl-N-((2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)methyl)-5-(2-oxopiperidin-1-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxamide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00081
  • To a mixture of 4′-methyl-5-(2-oxopiperidin-1-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (45 mg, 0.14 mmol), N-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-N′-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (56 mg, 0.29 mmol), 1-hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (22 mg, 0.14 mmol), and CH2Cl2 (3 mL) were added (2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)methanamine (27 mg, 0.22 mmol) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (51 μL, 0.29 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight and then concentrated. The residue was purified by preparative HPLC (100×20.2 mm, C18 column; 30-80% CH3CN-water[10 mM Et2NH]) to afford a white foam.
  • LC-MS: 415.2 [M+1]+; 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): 9.21 (t, 1H, J=5.6 Hz), 8.67 (s, 2H), 8.01 (s, 1H), 7.72 (s, 1H), 7.71 (s, 1H), 7.63 (d, 2H, J=8.0 Hz), 7.30 (d, 2H, J=8.4 Hz), 4.48 (d, 2H, J=5.2 Hz), 3.69 (t, 2H, J=5.6 Hz), 2.59 (s, 3H), 2.42 (t, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 2.36 (s, 3H), 1.95-1.80 (m, 4H).
  • Compound 39 (R)-4′-Methyl-N-(1-(2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)ethyl)-5-(2-oxopiperidin-1-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxamide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00082
  • To a mixture of 4′-methyl-5-(2-oxopiperidin-1-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (45 mg, 0.14 mmol), N-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-N′-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (56 mg, 0.29 mmol), 1-hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (22 mg, 0.15 mmol), and CH2Cl2 (3 mL) were added (R)-1-(2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)ethanamine (30 mg, 0.22 mmol) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (51 μL, 0.29 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight and then concentrated. The residue was purified by preparative HPLC (100×20.2 mm, C18 column; 30-80% CH3CN-water[10 mM Et2NH]) to afford a white foam.
  • LC-MS: 429.1 [M+1]+; 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): 8.99 (d, 1H, J=7.6 Hz), 8.72 (s, 2H), 8.01 (t, 1H, J=1.6 Hz), 7.72 (t, 1H, J=1.6 Hz), 7.70 (t, 1H, J=1.6 Hz), 7.63 (d, 2H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.31 (d, 214, J=8.0 Hz), 5.20 (m, 1H), 3.69 (t, 2H, J=5.6 Hz), 2.59 (s, 3H), 2.42 (t, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 2.36 (s, 3H), 1.95-1.80 (m, 4H), 1.55 (d, 3H, J=7.2 Hz).
  • Compound 40
  • (R)-4′-Methyl-N-(1-(6-methylpyridin-3-yl)ethyl)-5-(2-oxopiperidin-1-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxamide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00083
  • To a mixture of 4′-methyl-5-(2-oxopiperidin-1-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (45 mg, 0.14 mmol), N-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-N′-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (56 mg, 0.29 mmol), 1-hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (22 mg, 0.14 mmol), and CH2Cl2 (3 mL) were added (R)-1-(6-methylpyridin-3-yl)ethanamine hydrochloride (38 mg, 0.22 mmol) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (51 μL, 0.29 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight and then concentrated. The residue was purified by preparative HPLC (100×20.2 mm, C18 column; 30-80% CH3CN-water[10 mM Et2NH]) to afford a white foam.
  • LC-MS: 428.0 [M+1]+; 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): 8.95 (d, 1H, J=8.0 Hz), 8.48 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz), 8.02 (t, 1H, J=1.6 Hz), 7.71 (d, 2H, J=1.2 Hz), 7.68 (dd, 1H, J=8.0, 2.4 Hz), 7.63 (d, 2H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.31 (d, 2H, J=7.6 Hz), 7.21 (d, 1H, J=8.0 Hz), 5.20 (m, 1H), 3.69 (t, 2H, J=5.6 Hz), 2.43 (s, 3H), 2.42 (t, 2H, J=6.4 Hz), 2.36 (s, 3H), 1.95-1.80 (m, 4H), 1.52 (d, 3H, J=7.2 Hz).
  • Compound 45 2′-Methoxymethyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00084
  • In a 5 mL microwave vial, (R)-3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-N-(1-(2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)ethyl)benzamide (50.00 mg, 0.1216 mmol), 2-(methoxymethyl)phenylboronic acid (40.36 mg, 0.2431 mmol), cesium carbonate (198.0 mg, 0.6078 mmol), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (44.90 mg, 0.1216 mmol), and POPd (6.100 mg, 0.01216 mmol) were dissolved in Water (0.09 mL, 5 mmol) and N,N-dimethylformamide (0.4 mL, 6 mmol). The reaction mixture was microwaved for 20 mins at 150 degrees. The reaction was purified directly by reversed phase HPLC (acetonitrile:water gradient) at pH10. The combined pure fractions were reduced invacuo to afford the title compound as white solid.
  • 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): 9.06 (d, J=7.66 HZ, 1H), 8.73 (s, 2H), 8.56-8.54 (m, 2H), 8.22 (t, J=1.49 Hz, 1H), 8.01 (d, J=8.06 Hz, 1H), 7.93 (t, J=1.49 Hz, 1H), 7.74 (dd, J=8.36 & 2.39 Hz, 1H), 7.55-7.52 (m, 1H), 7.45-7.40 (m, 3H), 5.22 (qt, J=8.24 Hz, 1H), 4.29 (s, 2H), 3.22 (s, 3H), 2.59 (s, 3H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 1.55 (d, J=7.29 Hz, 3H).
  • Compound 46 3-(4-Cyano-pyridin-3-yl)-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-benzamide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00085
  • Into a 5 ml microwave vial was combined 3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)benzamide (25.00 mg, 0.06309 mmol) 3-(5,5-Dimethyl-[1,3,2]dioxaborinan-2-yl)-isonicotinonitrile (20.4 mg, 0.0946 mmol), potassium carbonate (26.2 mg, 0.189 mmol) POPd (3.16 mg, 0.00631 mmol) and isopropyl alcohol (0.483 mL, 6.31 mmol) The mixture was heated via microwave irradiation for 10 min at 150 degrees. The mixture was purified directly by reversed phase HPLC (acetonitrile:water gradient) at pH 10. The combined pure fractions were reduced invacuo to afford the title compound.
  • Compound 48 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid [(R)-1-(2-methyl-pyrimidin-5-yl)-ethyl]-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00086
  • To a solution of 4′-methyl-5-(2-oxopyrrolidin-1-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (58.0 mg, 0.000167 mol) in N,N-dimethylformamide (1 mL, 0.01 mol) was added (R)-1-(2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)ethanamine (50.0 mg, 0.000364 mol), N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyl-O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)uronium hexafluorophosphate (150.0 mg, 0.0003945 mol) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (150.0 uL, 0.0008612 mol). The reaction mixture was stirred for 16 hours at 25° C. Checked LC/MS, the reaction was completed. The DMF reaction solution was directly applied to prep. HPLC. The final product was yield a light color foam.
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): 9.00 (d, 1H, J=7.5 Hz), 8.72 (s, 2H), 8.11 (t, 1H, J=1.7 Hz), 7.99 (t, 1H, J=1.6 Hz), 7.89 (t, 1H, J=1.4 Hz), 7.63 (d, 2H, J=8.1 Hz), 7.32 (d, 2H, J=8.0 Hz), 5.19 (m, 1H), 3.94 (t, 2H, J=7.1 Hz), 2.59 (s, 3H), 2.53 (m, 2H), 2.36 (s, 3H), 2.09 (m, 2H), 1.55 (d, 3H, J=7.1 Hz).
  • Compound 49 4′-Methyl-5-(2-oxo-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00087
  • To a solution of 4′-methyl-5-(2-oxopyrrolidin-1-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (53.0 mg, 0.000152 mol) in N,N-dimethylformamide (1 mL, 0.01 mol) was added (6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methanamine (45.0 mg, 0.000368 mol), N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyl-O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)uronium hexafluorophosphate (150.0 mg, 0.0003945 mol) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (150.0 uL, 0.0008612 mol). The reaction mixture was stirred for 16 hours at 25° C. Checked LC/MS, the reaction was completed. The DMF reaction solution was directly applied to prep. HPLC. The final product was yield a light color foam.
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): 9.18 (t, 1H, J=5.8 Hz), 8.44 (d, 1H, J=2.0 Hz), 8.13 (t, 1H, J=1.7 Hz), 8.02 (t, 1H, J=1.6 Hz), 7.90 (bs, 1H), 7.65-7.60 (m, 3H), 7.31 (d, 2H, J=8.0 Hz), 7.22 (d, 1H, J=8.0 Hz), 4.48 (d, 2H, J=5.8 Hz), 3.94 (t, 2H, J=6.9 Hz), 2.53 (m, 2H), 2.44 (s, 3H), 2.36 (s, 3H), 2.09 (m, 2H).
  • Compound 58 (R)-3-(5-Methylpyridin-2-yl)-N-(1-(2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)ethyl)-5-(2-oxopyrrolidin-1-yl)benzamide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00088
  • A) Methyl 3-bromo-5-iodobenzoate
  • A round bottom flask was charged with 3-bromo-5-iodo-benzoic acid (8.00 g, 24.5 mmol) and methanol (50 mL). Thionyl chloride (5.36 mL, 73.4 mmol) was slowly added and the reaction mixture was heated at 65° C. for 1 h. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate and washed with aq. NaHCO3. Removal of the solvent under reduced pressure gave the product as a white solid.
  • B) Methyl 3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate
  • A microwave vial was charged with methyl 3-bromo-5-iodobenzoate (2.00 g, 5.87 mmol), 5-methyl-2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine (2.24 g, 5.87 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (340 mg, 0.30 mmol) and 1,4-dioxane (30 mL). The reaction mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation at 120° C. for 1 hour. After cooling, the mixture was filtered through Celite and the filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography to afford the product as a white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): 8.64 (t, J=1.51 Hz, 1H), 8.55 (m, 1H), 8.52 (t, J=1.89 Hz, 1H), 8.07 (t, J=1.89 Hz, 1H), 8.03 (d, J=8.31 Hz, 1H), 7.75 (dd, J=8.31 & 2.27 Hz, 1H), 3.91 (s, 1H), 2.36 (s, 1H).
  • C) 3-Bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoic acid
  • A round bottom flask was charged with methyl 3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate (300 mg, 0.98 mmol), tetrahydrofuran (15 mL) and lithium hydroxide (70 mg, 2.94 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at 50° C. overnight, and then filtered through sodium sulfate. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to afford the product as a white solid.
  • D) (R)-3-Bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-N-(1-(2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)ethyl)benzamide
  • A round bottom flask was charged with 3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoic acid (250 mg, 0.86 mmol), (R)-1-(2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)ethanamine (141 mg, 1.03 mmol), N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyl-O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)uronium hexafluorophosphate (651 mg, 1.71 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (0.60 mL, 3.42 mmol), and N,N-dimethylformamide (6 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight, and then washed with brine and extracted with ethyl acetate. The organic layer was dried and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford a light brown oil.
  • E) (R)-3-(5-Methylpyridin-2-yl)-N-(1-(2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)ethyl)-5-(2-oxopyrrolidin-1-yl)benzamide
  • Into a 5 mL microwave vial was charged (R)-3-bromo-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-N-(1-(2-methylpyrimidin-5-yl)ethyl)benzamide (20 mg, 0.05 mmol), 2-pyrrolidinone (7 mg, 0.08 mmol) xantphos (3 mg, 0.005 mmol), tris(dibenzylideneacetone)dipalladium(0) (2 mg, 0.002 mmol), cesium carbonate (50 mg, 0.1 mmol), and 1,4-dioxane (0.8 mL). The mixture was subjected to microwave irradiation at 130° C. for 10 min. The cooled mixture was diluted with 3 mL of methanol and purified by reverse phase HPLC to afford the title compound.
  • Compound 59 (S)-5-(2-(Hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-4′-methyl-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)biphenyl-3-carboxamide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00089
  • A) 3-Bromo-5-iodo-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)benzamide
  • To a stirred mixture of 3-bromo-5-iodo-benzoic acid (1.4 g, 4.4 mmol), N-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-N′-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (1.7 g, 8.8 mmol), 1-hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (0.20 g, 1.3 mmol), and CH2Cl2 (50 mL) were added (6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methanamine (0.65 g, 5.3 mmol) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (1.5 mL, 8.8 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight and then concentrated in vacuo. The precipitated solid was washed with water and ethyl ether and dried to afford the product as a white solid. LC-MS: 432.7 [M+1]+.
  • B) (S)-3-Bromo-5-(2-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)benzamide
  • A mixture of 3-bromo-5-iodo-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)benzamide (250 mg, 0.58 mmol), L-prolinol (88 mg, 0.87 mmol), potassium carbonate (160 mg, 1.2 mmol), L-proline (13 mg, 0.12 mmol), and copper(I) iodide (11 mg, 0.058 mmol) in dimethyl sulfoxide (2 mL) under nitrogen was stirred at 90° C. for 10 h. The cooled mixture was partitioned between water and ethyl acetate. The organic layer was separated, and the aqueous layer was extracted with ethyl acetate. The combined organic layers were washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4), and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by silica gel column (EtOAc/hexane: 0-100%) to afford a white foam.
  • LC-MS: 405.8 [M+1]+; 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): 9.01 (t, 1H, J=6.0 Hz), 8.39 (d, 1H, J=1.6 Hz), 7.59 (dd, 1H, J=8.0, 2.4 Hz), 7.21 (d, 1H, J=8.0 Hz), 7.20 (s, 1H), 7.04 (t, 1H, J=1.6 Hz), 6.87 (t, 1H, J=1.6 Hz), 4.83 (t, 1H, J=6.0 Hz), 4.41 (d, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 3.74 (m, 1H), 3.41 (m, 2H), 3.20 (m, 1H), 3.08 (m, 1H), 2.43 (s, 3H), 2.03-1.80 (m, 4H).
  • C) (S)-5-(2-(Hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-4′-methyl-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)biphenyl-3-carboxamide
  • To a mixture of (S)-3-bromo-5-(2-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)benzamide (65 mg, 0.16 mmol), p-tolylboronic acid (24 mg, 0.18 mmol), toluene (4 mL), cesium carbonate (57 mg, 0.18 mmol), and water (0.2 mL) under argon was added tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (9.2 mg, 0.0080 mmol). The reaction mixture was heated under reflux for 5 h. After cooling, the mixture was filtered through Celite and the filter cake was washed with EtOAc. The filtrate was washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4), and concentrated. The residue was purified by preparative HPLC (100×21.2 mm C18 column, 30-80% CH3CN/water[10 mM Et2NH]) to afford a white foam.
  • LC-MS: 416.2 [M+1]+; 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): 9.01 (t, 1H, J=6.0 Hz), 8.42 (d, 1H, J=2.0 Hz), 7.61 (dd, 1H, J=8.0, 2.4 Hz), 7.58 (d, 2H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.34 (s, 1H), 7.27 (d, 2H, J=8.0 Hz), 7.21 (d, 1H, J=8.4 Hz), 7.05 (s, 1H), 6.92 (s, 1H), 4.83 (t, 1H, J=6.0 Hz), 4.45 (d, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 3.81 (m, 1H), 3.57-3.42 (m, 2H), 3.26-3.09 (m, 2H), 2.43 (s, 3H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.10-1.80 (m, 4H).
  • Compound 62 5-((R)-2-Hydroxymethyl-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-4′-methyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00090
  • To a mixture of (R)-3-bromo-5-(2-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)benzamide (45 mg, 0.11 mmol), p-tolylboronic acid (16 mg, 0.12 mmol), Toluene (3 mL, 30 mmol), cesium carbonate (4.0E1 mg, 0.12 mmol), and Water (0.2 mL, 8 mmol) under argon was added Tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (6.4 mg, 0.0055 mmol). The mixture was heated under reflux for 5 h. After cooling, the mixture was filtered through Celite and the filter cake was washed with EtOAc. The filtrate was washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4), and concentrated. The residue was purified by preparative HPLC (100×21.2 mm C18 column, 30-80% CH3CN/water[10 mM Et2NH]) to afford a white foam. LC-MS: 2.09 min, 416.5 [M+1]+; HPLC: 9.12 min.
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): 9.01 (t, 1H, J=6.0 Hz), 8.42 (d, 1H, J=1.6 Hz), 7.61 (dd, 1H, J=8.0, 2.4 Hz), 7.58 (d, 2H, J=8.0 Hz), 7.34 (s, 1H), 7.27 (d, 2H, J=7.6 Hz), 7.21 (d, 1H, J=8.0 Hz), 7.05 (s, 1H), 6.92 (s, 1H), 4.83 (t, 1H, J=5.6 Hz), 4.45 (d, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 3.81 (m, 1H), 3.57-3.42 (m, 2H), 3.26-3.09 (m, 2H), 2.43 (s, 3H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 2.10-1.80 (m, 4H).
  • Compound 63 3-((R)-2-Hydroxymethyl-pyrrolidin-1-yl)-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-N-(6-methyl-pyridin-3-ylmethyl)-benzamide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00091
  • A mixture of (R)-3-bromo-5-(2-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)-N-((6-methylpyridin-3-yl)methyl)benzamide (55 mg, 0.14 mmol), 5-methyl-2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine (65 mg, 0.16 mmol), Tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (7.8 mg, 0.0068 mmol) and Toluene (1.5 mL, 14 mmol) under argon was subjected to microwave irradiation at 160° C. for 1 hour. The mixture was cooled to room temperature. Solvent was removed in vacuo and the residue was rinsed with hexane and then dissolved in MeOH and filtered. The filtrate was purified by preparative HPLC (100×21.2 mm C18 column, 20-70% CH3CN/water[10 mM Et2NH]) to afford a white foam. LC-MS: 1.64 min, 417.3 [M+1]+; HPLC: 6.76 min.
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): 9.05 (t, 1H, J=6.0 Hz), 8.51 (d, 1H, J=2.0 Hz), 8.43 (d, 1H, J=2.0 Hz), 7.87 (d, 1H, J=8.0 Hz), 7.73 (s, 1H), 7.71 (dd, 1H, J=8.0, 2.0 Hz), 7.62 (dd, 1H, J=8.0, 2.4 Hz), 7.42 (s, 1H), 7.21 (d, 1H, J=7.6 Hz), 7.12 (s, 1H), 4.84 (t, 1H, J=5.6 Hz), 4.45 (d, 2H, J=6.0 Hz), 3.83 (m, 1H), 3.57-3.44 (m, 2H), 3.27-3.11 (m, 2H), 2.44 (s, 3H), 2.34 (s, 3H), 2.10-1.80 (m, 4H).
  • Compound 70 2′,3′-Difluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00092
  • A. 2′,3′-difluoro-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid
  • In a 5 mL microwave vial, methyl 3-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)benzoate (250 mg, 0.71 mmol), 1-bromo-2,3-difluorobenzene (273.2 mg, 1.416 mmol), cesium carbonate (1153 mg, 3.539 mmol), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (261.4 mg, 0.7078 mmol), and POPd (35.51 mg, 0.07078 mmol) were dissolved in Water (0.5 mL, 30 mmol) and N,N-dimethylformamide (3 mL, 30 mmol). The reaction mixture was microwaved for 10 mins at 150 degrees. The reaction mixture was extracted with ethylacetate and washed repeatedly with brine. The solvent removed under reduced pressure and used in the next reaction without further purification.
  • B. 2′,3′-Difluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide
  • A round bottom flask was charged with 2′,3′-difluoro-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (30.00 mg, 0.09222 mmol), (2S)-2-Aminopropan-1-ol (8.3119 mg, 0.11066 mmol), N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyl-O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)uronium hexafluorophosphate (0.087662 g, 0.23055 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (0.064252 mL, 0.36888 mmol), N,N-dimethylformamide (0.157 mL, 2.03 mmol) and the reaction stirred over night at room temperrature. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue purified by prep HPLC to get the compound as white solid.
  • 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): 8.58 (t, J=1.670 HZ, 1H), 8.56 (d, J=1.87 Hz, 1H), 8.38-8.36 (m, 2H), 8.06 (d, J=1.47 Hz, 1H), 8.03 (d, J=8.25 Hz, 1H), 7.76 (dd, J=8.27 Hz, & 2.23 Hz, 1H), 7.55-7.48 (m, 2H), 7.40-7.34 (m, 1H), 4.76 (t, J=6.75 Hz, 1H), 4.12-4.02 (m, 1H), 3.52-3.47 (m, 1H), 3.41-3.35 (m, 1H), 2.36 (s, 3H), 2.18 (s, 3H), 1.16 (d, J=6.75 Hz, 3H).
  • Compound 71 2′-Cyano-5′-methyl-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00093
  • A round bottom flask was charged with 2′-cyano-5′-methyl-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (30.0 mg, 0.0914 mmol), (2S)-2-Aminopropan-1-ol (13.724 mg, 0.18272 mmol), N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyl-O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)uronium hexafluorophosphate (0.14474 g, 0.38068 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (0.10609 mL, 0.60908 mmol), N,N-dimethylformamide (0.260 mL, 3.35 mmol) and the reaction stirred over night at room temperrature. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue purified by prep HPLC to get the compound as white solid.
  • 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): 8.61 (t, J=1.670 HZ, 1H), 8.56 (d, J=2.57 Hz, 1H), 8.38-8.36 (m, 2H), 8.05-8.02 (m, 2H) 8.16 (t, J=1.40 Hz, 1H), 8.03 (d, J=7.69 Hz, 1H), 7.86 (t, J=1.62 HZ, 1H), 7.81 (d, J=7.96 Hz, 1H), 7.76 (dd, J=8.44 Hz, & 2.17 Hz, 1H), 7.71 (d, J=7.72 Hz, 1H), 4.76 (t, J=6.75 Hz, 1H), 4.12-4.02 (m, 1H), 3.52-3.47 (m, 1H), 3.41-3.35 (m, 1H), 2.36 (s, 3H), 2.18 (s, 3H), 1.16 (d, J=6.75 Hz, 3H).
  • Compound 77 (R)-2′,3′-difluoro-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-N-(1-morpholinopropan-2-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxamide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00094
  • A round bottom flask was charged with 2′,3′-difluoro-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (30 mg, 0.092 mmol), (R)-1-morpholinopropan-2-amine hydrochloride (20 mg, 0.11 mmol), N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyl-O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)uronium hexafluorophosphate (88 mg, 0.23 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (64 μL, 0.37 mmol), N,N-dimethylformamide (0.5 mL) and the reaction was stirred overnight at room temperrature. The mixture was purified by HPLC to afford the title compound as a light orange solid.
  • LC-MS: 452.1 [M+1]+; 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): 8.56 (t, J=1.46 HZ, 2H), 8.42-8.37 (m, 2H), 8.05-8.02 (m, 2H) 7.77 (dd, J=8.30 Hz, & 2.43 Hz, 1H), 7.52-7.48 (m, 2H), 7.40-7.33 (m, 1H) 4.31-4.23 (m, 1H), 3.55 (t, J=4.57 Hz, 4H), 2.43-2.40 (m, 4H) 2.37 (s, 3H), 1.91 (d, J=6.97 Hz, 3H).
  • Compound 80 (R)-2′-cyano-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-N-(1-morpholinopropan-2-yl)-5′-(trifluoromethyl)biphenyl-3-carboxamide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00095
  • A round bottom flask was charged with 2′-cyano-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-5′-(trifluoromethyl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (30 mg, 0.078 mmol), (R)-1-morpholinopropan-2-amine hydrochloride (33 mg, 0.18 mmol), N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyl-O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)uronium hexafluorophosphate (145 mg, 0.38 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (106 μL, 0.61 mmol), N,N-dimethylformamide (0.5 mL) and the reaction was stirred overnight at room temperrature. The mixture was purified by HPLC to afford the title compound as a light orange solid.
  • LC-MS: 509.2 [M+1]+; 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): 8.65 (t, J=1.62 Hz, 1H), 8.57 (d, J=2.56 Hz, 1H), 8.46 (t, J=2.13 Hz, 1H), 8.40 (d, J=8.10 Hz, 1H), 8.28 (d, J=8.10 Hz, 1H), 8.14 (s, 1H), 8.1 (t, J=1.67 Hz, 1H), 8.06-8.02 (m, 2H), 7.78 (dd, J=8.07 & 2.31 Hz, 1H), 4.32-4.24 (m, 1H), 3.55 (t, J=4.37 Hz, 4H), 3.18-3.13 (m, 1H), 2.43-2.42 (m, 4H), 2.37 (s, 3H), 2.35-2.30 (m, 1H), 1.19 (d, J=6.44 Hz, 3H).
  • Compound 83 2′-Fluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-6′-trifluoromethyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((R)-1-methyl-2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00096
  • A. Methyl 2′-fluoro-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-6′-(trifluoromethyl)biphenyl-3-carboxylate
  • In a 5 mL microwave vial, methyl 3-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-5-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)benzoate (300.0 mg, 0.8493 mmol), 2-bromo-1-fluoro-3-(trifluoromethyl)benzene (412.8 mg, 1.699 mmol), cesium carbonate (1384 mg, 4.247 mmol), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (313.7 mg, 0.8493 mmol), and POPd (42.61 mg, 0.08493 mmol) were dissolved in Water (0.6 mL, 40 mmol) and N,N-dimethylformamide (3 mL, 40 mmol). The reaction mixture was microwaved for 10 mins at 150 degrees. The reaction mixture was extracted with ethylacetate and washed repeatedly with brine. The solvent removed under reduced pressure (yellow oil) and used in the next reaction without further purification.
  • B. 2′-Fluoro-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-6′-(trifluoromethyl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid
  • A round bottom flask was charged with methyl 2′-fluoro-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-6′-(trifluoromethyl)biphenyl-3-carboxylate (200.00 mg, 0.51368 mmol), Tetrahydrofuran (7.8 mL, 97 mmol) and Lithium hydroxide (36.906 mg, 1.5410 mmol) and the reaction stirred at room temperature over night and at 50° C. for two days. The reaction mixture was filtered over Sodium sulfate and the solvent removed under reduced pressure to get the acid as brown solid.
  • C. 2′-Fluoro-5-(5-methyl-pyridin-2-yl)-6′-trifluoromethyl-biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid ((R)-1-methyl-2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-amide
  • A round bottom flask was charged with 2′-fluoro-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-6′-(trifluoromethyl)biphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (100.00 mg, 0.26644 mmol), (S)-1-morpholinopropan-2-amine hydrochloride (112.10 mg, 0.62047 mmol), N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyl-O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)uronium hexafluorophosphate (0.49150 g, 1.2926 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (0.36025 mL, 2.0682 mmol), N,N-dimethylformamide (0.882 mL, 11.4 mmol) and the reaction stirred over night at room temperrature. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue purified by prep HPLC to get the compound as white solid.
  • 1H NMR (DMSO-d6) 8.60 (bs, 1H), 8.54 (d, J=2.35 Hz, 1H), 8.38 (d, J=8.63 Hz, 1H0, 8.16 (bs, 1H0, 7.98 (d, J=7.97 Hz, 1H), 7.82 (bs, 1H), 7.77-7.72 (m, 3H), 4.30-4.22 (m, 1H0, 3.54 (m, 3H), 2.40 (m, 3H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 1.17 (d, J=6.20 Hz, 3H).
  • Compound 87 (R)-2′-Cyano-5-(4-cyanopyridin-3-yl)-4′-methyl-N-(1-morpholinopropan-2-yl)biphenyl-3-carboxamide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00097
  • A round bottom flask was charged with 2′-cyano-5-(4-cyanopyridin-3-yl)-4′-methylbiphenyl-3-carboxylic acid (20 mg, 0.059 mmol), (R)-1-morpholinopropan-2-amine hydrochloride (112 mg, 0.62 mmol), N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyl-O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)uronium hexafluorophosphate (49 mg, 0.13 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (360 μL, 2.1 mmol), N,N-dimethylformamide (0.555 mL) and the reaction was stirred overnight at room temperrature. The mixture was purified by HPLC to get the title compound as a light yellow solid.
  • LC-MS: 466.1 [M+1]+; 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 9.06 (d, J=0.7 Hz, 1H), 8.90 (d, J=5.0 Hz, 1H), 8.39 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H), 8.20 (dt, J=10.7, 1.6 Hz, 2H), 8.08-8.01 (m, 2H), 7.86 (s, 1H), 7.73-7.65 (m, 2H), 4.27 (dt, J=14.1, 6.9 Hz, 1H), 3.54 (t, J=4.6 Hz, 4H), 2.47-2.36 (m, 8H), 2.31 (dd, J=12.3, 6.6 Hz, 1H), 1.18 (d, J=6.6 Hz, 3H).
  • Compound 88 2-Cyano-2″-hydroxymethyl-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid ((S)-2-hydroxy-1-methyl-ethyl)-amide
  • Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00098
  • A reaction vial was charged with 2-Cyano-2″-hydroxymethyl-4-methyl-[1,1′;3′,1″]terphenyl-5′-carboxylic acid (50.00 mg, 0.1456 mmol), (2S)-2-aminopropan-1-ol (13.12 mg, 0.1747 mmol), N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyl-O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)uronium hexafluorophosphate (110.7 mg, 0.2912 mmol), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (0.06341 mL, 0.3640 mmol) and N,N-dimethylformamide (5.0 mL, 64 mmol) and the reaction stirred at room temperature over night. The reaction mixture was then purified by prep HPLC to get the compound as white solid.
  • 1H NMR (DMSO-d6): 8.27 (d, J=7.44 HZ, 1H), 8.01 (t, J=1.64 HZ, 1H), 7.90 (t, J=1.64 Hz, 1H), 7.81 (s, 1H), 7.72 (t, J=1.64 HZ, 1H), 7.65-7.59 (m, 3H), 7.46-7.32 (m, 3H0, 5.17 (t, J=5.65 HZ, 1H0, 4.74 (t, J=5.65 HZ, 1H), 4.45 (d, J=5.12 Hz, 1H), 4.05 (qt, J=7.32 HZ, 1H), 3.50-3.43 (m, 1H0, 3.38-3.33 (m, 1H), 2.41 (s, 3H), 1.13 (d, J=6.56 Hz, 3H).
  • The syntheses of representative compounds of this invention can be carried out in accordance with the methods set forth above and using the appropriate reagents, starting materials, and purification methods known to those skilled in the art.
  • Assays
  • Compounds provided herein can be evaluated using cell-based assays, such as calcium influx or electrophysiological assays, using biochemical assays, such as binding assays to P2X2 and P2X3 receptors, or can be evaluated in animal models of pain or urinary function. Examples of assays are described below.
  • The purinergic receptors P2X2 and P2X3 are expressed in a variety of tissues including various sensory and sympathetic ganglia, such as the dorsal root (DRG), nodose (ND), trigeminal (TG), and superior cervical ganglia (SCG) and also in smooth muscle cells (Burnstock, Trends Pharmacol. Sci. 27:166-76, 2006). In several regions, P2X2 and P2X3 receptors are coexpressed and functional studies have demonstrated the presence of heteromeric P2X2/3 receptors whose properties differ from those of either homomeric receptor. In addition, chimeric P2X2/3 receptors, containing the N-terminal cytoplasmic domain of P2X2 fused to the first transmembrane domain of P2X3 have been described; these chimeric channels retain the pharmacological profile of homomeric P2X3 receptors, while gaining the non-desensitizing phenotype of the homomeric P2X2 receptor (Neelands et al., Br. J. Pharmacol. 140:202-10, 2003). The non-desensitizing behavior of the chimeric receptor is especially useful for screening.
  • Members of the P2X family are ligand-gated non-selective cation channels whose activity can be characterized by using electrophysiological methods, or by measuring calcium ion influx using calcium-sensitive fluorescent dyes. Applications of agonists such as ATP, or an ATP analog such as α,β-Methyleneadenosine 5′-triphosphate (αβMeATP, Sigma-Aldrich), causes channel opening, resulting in current flow and calcium influx (Bianchi et al., Eur. J. Pharmacol. 376:127-38, 1999).
  • The compounds provided herein can be tested for antagonist activity at P2X3 and P2X2/3 receptors by measuring their ability to affect channel opening by ATP, αβMeATP, or other agonists. Functional tests of receptor activity include but are not limited to: (i) calcium ion influx measured by fluorescence of a calcium-sensitive dye and; (ii) ion flux resulting from channel opening measured by electrophysiological methods. These methods can be used to evaluate channel function when the relevant receptor is heterologously expressed in mammalian or amphibian cells. These methods can also be used to evaluate compounds provided herein in rodent primary neurons and other mammalian primary cells and cell lines that normally express the receptor of interest.
  • Compounds can further be evaluated for their ability to bind P2X3 and P2X2/3 receptors using biochemical approaches.
  • Compounds can also be evaluated for their ability to modify sensory and autonomic nervous system signaling where the receptors are known to have a role (e.g., urinary bladder afferent signaling, sensory nerve pain sensation). Finally, compounds provided herein can be tested in vivo in relevant animal models known to one skilled in the art, such as, for example, models of neuropathic, inflammatory, or visceral pain, or models of urinary incontinence.
  • The following biological examples are offered to illustrate the compounds, pharmaceutical compositions and methods provided herein and are not to be construed in any way as limiting the scope thereof.
  • Calcium Uptake Assay Clones and Cell Lines:
  • Human P2X3 (Accession no. NM002559), P2X2 (Accession no. NM170682) and Rat P2X3 (Accession no. NM031075) and P2X2 (Accession no. NM053656) are cloned into a mammalian expression vector (e.g., pcDNA5/TO or pcDNA3 Invitrogen). The human P2X2/3 chimera clone is created as described by Neelands et al, and then cloned into an expression vector as above. Receptors are expressed in cells (e.g., HEK293 or 1321N1 (obtained from the ECACC)) via transient transfection using standard lipid mediated transfection, or by creation of stable transfectants for each receptor. For expression of the P2X2/3 heteromeric receptor, the P2X3 expression vector is stably transfected into a cell line already stably expressing P2X2. P2X2/3 heteromer function is isolated using pharmacological methods. Cell lines are maintained in DMEM+5% Glutamax, the appropriate level of selective antibiotic, and 10% heat inactivated FBS.
  • P2X Antagonist Assay:
  • Functional activity of compounds at the P2X receptor is determined by measuring their ability to inhibit agonist-induced calcium influx. Compounds are tested for antagonist activity against the P2X2/3 chimera, the P2X3 homomer, or the P2X2/3 heteromer. At the start of each screening day, the agonist EC50 is determined. Compound % inhibition or IC50s are subsequently determined using a pre-determined agonist concentration (EC50-90 depending on cell line) as a stimulus. The agonists used are αβMeATP, ATP, or other ATP analogs. Compounds may be tested at concentrations ranging from 1 pM to 10 μM.
  • To test for antagonist activity, cells expressing the appropriate receptor are seeded onto 96 or 384 well plates 18-24 hours prior to assay. On the day of the assay, cells are loaded with calcium-sensitive fluorescent dye (e.g., Fluo-4 no wash reagent-Invitrogen cat# F36206, or the BD™ PBX Calcium Assay Kit-BD cat# 640175) in Hank's Buffered Salt Solution (HBSS) with up to 10 mM supplemental CaCl2. Plates are incubated at 37° C. and then equilibrated at room temperature. Antagonism of agonist-induced calcium influx is measured using a fluorescent imaging plate reader (e.g. FLIPRTETRA, Molecular Devices, Sunnyvale, Calif.). The assay comprises two stages: a pre-treatment phase followed by a treatment phase. Compounds may be tested as follows: For the pre-treatment phase, 50 μL of 3× concentration of test compound in HBSS is added to cells containing 100 μL of dye loading media to achieve a final concentration of 1× test compound. For the treatment phase, at a set interval after pre-treatment (1-30 minutes), 50 μL of 1× test compound plus 4× agonist solution is added, resulting in a final concentration of 1× compound and 1× agonist. Fluorescence is measured at 0.1-3 second intervals—with an excitation wavelength of 494 nM and an emission wavelength of 515 nM. Responses are measured as (peak fluorescence after agonist addition) minus (baseline fluorescence prior to treatment). Percent inhibition is calculated as follows:
  • Percentage inhibition = 1 - ( Compound Response - Control Resonse ) ( Agonist Response - Control Response ) × 100
  • IC50 values are determined by analyzing dose response data in a 4 parameter logistic fit using GraphPad Prizm.
  • Electrophysiological Experiments Whole Cell Patch Clamp:
  • Whole cell recordings are made using the Multiclamp700A patch-clamp amplifier and Clampex acquisition program (Molecular Devices Corporation). Whole-cell recordings are obtained from 1321N1 or HEK cells stably or transiently transfected with P2X3 and/or P2X2 expression vectors. Solutions are either applied for periods of 1 to 3s by a gravity flow, 8-valve delivery system, or for periods of milliseconds using the quick-change Dynaflow perfusion system (Cellectricon Inc.). The internal pipette solution may include 140 mM Cesium-Chloride, 10 mM EGTA, and 5 mM Hepes at pH 7.2; normal external solution is 140 mM NaCl, 5 mM KCl, 1 mM CaCl2, 2 mM MgCl2, 25 mM Hepes, and 10 mM glucose. Concentration-response curves are obtained by recording currents in response to brief applications of agonist at 1-3 min intervals where regular external solution is perfused during the intervals. To obtain inhibition curves, antagonists are pre-applied to the cells for a defined time period before a short application of the agonist+ antagonist. The periods of antagonist pre-application and agonist+ antagonist applications are constant for the entire test concentration series. Agonist evoked currents are measured in cells that are voltage clamped at −60 or −80 millivolts. IC50 values are determined by analyzing dose response data in a 4 parameter logistic fit using GraphPad Prizm or Origin.
  • Automated Two-Electrode Voltage Clamp Recording:
  • Xenopus oocytes (Nalco) are isolated by enzymatic dissociation using collagenase (Worthington, 2 mg/ml). Oocytes are then individually injected with P2X3, P2X2, or a combination of P2X2 and P2X3 mRNA. Each oocyte receives ˜64 nl of RNA solution in water at a concentration of ˜0.01 μg/μl. Injected oocytes are stored in standard oocyte incubation solution, ND96, containing (in mM) 96 NaCl, 2 KCl, 1 MgCl2, 1-5 CaCl2 and 50 μg/ml Gentamicin at 16° C. Agonist-induced-current caused by P2X channel opening is observed in oocytes 1-5 days after injection. For automated recordings, 8 oocytes are placed in the recording chambers. Each oocyte is impaled by 2 glass electrodes having resistances of 0.5 to 1 MOhm when filled with a 3 M KCl solution. Electrode advancement and oocyte impalement are under software control (OPUSXPRESS 1.1, Molecular devices Corporation). The solutions are prepared in 96 well plates and robotically pipetted into the oocyte recording chambers by an 8 channel pipettor. Inhibition by antagonists is determined by calculating % current remaining when oocytes are stimulated with agonist in the presence of test compound compared to the peak current in the presence of agonist alone. The sequence of solution application to the oocyte is as follows: a specific concentration (e.g., EC50, EC80, or EC90) of the agonist is added first to elicit the maximal response. After the pulse, oocytes are washed for several minutes with ND96. The test compound is then added at a particular concentration, followed by the compound at the same concentration along with the agonist. Concentrations for the compounds may range from 0.3 to 10,000 nM. IC50 values are determined by analyzing dose response data using a 4 parameter logistic fit using GraphPad Prizm or Origin software.
  • Manual Two-Electrode Voltage Clamp:
  • Individual oocytes are impaled manually with 2 electrodes and agonist evoked current are measured using an Oocyte clamp amplifier (Warner Instrument Corp.) and Clampex (Molecular Devices Corporation) acquisition software. Solutions are delivered using gravity flow and applied as above. The agonist induced current is measured in the absence and presence of antagonist. Antagonists are tested in a concentration series to obtain an inhibition curve as described above.
  • Selectivity Screens:
  • Compounds that inhibit P2X3 and/or P2X2/3 activation will be tested for activity against other P2X receptors to determine their selectivity for specific P2X family members. The list of receptors to be assayed includes, but is not restricted to P2X1, P2X2, P2X4, P2X5, P2X6, and P2X7. The types of assay used for selectivity determination may include: 1) Agonist-induced Calcium influx in cells heterologously expressing the relevant receptor, 2) Electrophysiological determination of receptor inhibition in either mammalian cells or Xenopus oocytes heterologously expressing the receptor of interest. Methods and data analysis are similar to those described above for P2X3 and P2X2/3.
  • Radioligand Binding:
  • Radioligand experiments are done to determine the affinity of test compounds for P2X3 homomeric and P2X2/3 heteromeric receptors. These studies also provide valuable insights into the mechanism of action of antagonism. The general methodologies used for radioligand binding experiments for P2X3 and P2X2/3 receptors are described by Jarvis et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 10:407-16, 2004.
  • Briefly, cell membranes are prepared from cells transiently or stably expressing P2X3 or P2X2/3 receptors. Cells are grown to confluence, washed, isolated, and stored as pellets at −80° C. until use. Some studies may require the addition of Apyrase or hexokinase (Sigma-Aldrich) during membrane preparation to minimize ATP-mediated receptor desensitization during membrane preparation. Membranes are prepared by resuspending the cell pellet in homogenization buffer, homogenizing, and centrifuging to obtain a membrane pellet. Total protein concentrations are determined using standard methods.
  • Displacement binding studies are conducted using procedures adapted from Jarvis et al. Under optimized conditions, ligand competition experiments are conducted using radioligand ([3H]A-317491, Abbott), or other high affinity radioligands and a range of different concentrations of test compounds in binding buffer. Ligand saturation studies are conducted using a range of concentrations of radioligand. All binding reactions are terminated by rapid filtration through a glass fiber filter. Membranes are washed, incubated in scintillant, and counted in a scintillation counter. IC50 values are determined using a four-parameter logistic Hill equation.
  • Drug Metabolism and Pharmacokinetics
  • Caco-2 permeability:
    Caco-2 permeability is measured according to the method described in Yee, Pharm. Res. 14:763-6, 1997. Caco-2 cells are grown on filter supports (Falcon HTS multiwell insert system) for 14 days. Culture medium is removed from both the apical and basolateral compartments and the monolayers are preincubated with pre-warmed 0.3 ml apical buffer and 1.0 ml basolateral buffer for 0.75 hour at 37° C. in a shaker water bath at 50 cycles/min. The apical buffer consists of Hanks Balanced Salt Solution, 25 mM D-glucose monohydrate, 20 mM MES Biological Buffer, 1.25 mM CaCl2 and 0.5 in M MgCl2 (pH 6.5). The basolateral buffer consists of Hanks Balanced Salt Solution, 25 mM D-glucose monohydrate, 20 mM HEPES Biological Buffer, 1.25 mM CaCl2 and 0.5 mM MgCl2 (pH 7.4). At the end of the preincubation, the media is removed and test compound solution (10 μM) in buffer is added to the apical compartment. The inserts are moved to wells containing fresh basolateral buffer and incubated for 1 hr. Drug concentration in the buffer is measured by LC/MS analysis.
  • Flux rate (F, mass/time) is calculated from the slope of cumulative appearance of substrate on the receiver side and apparent permeability coefficient (Papp) is calculated from the following equation:
  • Papp(cm/sec)=(F*VD)/(SA*MD)
    where SA is surface area for transport (0.3 cm2), VD is the donor volume (0.3 ml), MD is the total amount of drug on the donor side at t=0. All data represent the mean of 2 inserts. Monolayer integrity is determined by Lucifer Yellow transport.
  • Human Dofetilide Binding:
  • Cell paste of HEK-293 cells expressing the HERG product can be suspended in 10-fold volume of 50 mM Tris buffer adjusted at pH 7.5 at 25° C. with 2 M HCl containing 1 mM MgCl2, 10 mM KCl. The cells are homogenized using a Polytron homogenizer (at the maximum power for 20 seconds) and centrifuged at 48,000 g for 20 minutes at 4° C. The pellet is resuspended, homogenized and centrifuged once more in the same manner. The resultant supernatant is discarded and the final pellet was resuspended (10-fold volume of 50 mM Tris buffer) and homogenized at the maximum power for 20 seconds. The membrane homogenate is aliquoted and stored at −80° C. until use. An aliquot is used for protein concentration determination using a Protein Assay Rapid Kit and ARVO SX plate reader (Wallac). All the manipulation, stock solution and equipment are kept on ice at all time. For saturation assays, experiments are conducted in a total volume of 200 μl. Saturation is determined by incubating 20 μl of [3H]-dofetilide and 160 μl of membrane homogenates (20-30 μg protein per well) for 60 min at room temperature in the absence or presence of 10 μM dofetilide at final concentrations (20 μl) for total or nonspecific binding, respectively. All incubations are terminated by rapid vacuum filtration over polyetherimide (PEI) soaked glass fiber filter papers using Skatron cell harvester followed by two washes with 50 mM Tris buffer (pH 7.5 at 25° C.). Receptor-bound radioactivity is quantified by liquid scintillation counting using Packard LS counter.
  • For the competition assay, compounds are diluted in 96 well polypropylene plates as 4-point dilutions in semi-log format. All dilutions are performed in DMSO first and then transferred into 50 mM Tris buffer (pH 7.5 at 25° C.) containing 1 mM MgCl2, 10 mM KCl so that the final DMSO concentration became equal to 1%. Compounds are dispensed in triplicate in assay plates (4 μl). Total binding and nonspecific binding wells are set up in 6 wells as vehicle and 10 μM dofetilide at final concentration, respectively. The radioligand was prepared at 5.6× final concentration and this solution is added to each well (36 μl). The assay is initiated by addition of YSi poly-L-lysine Scintillation Proximity Assay (SPA) beads (50 μl, 1 mg/well) and membranes (110 μA, 20 μg/well). Incubation is continued for 60 min at room temperature. Plates are incubated for a further 3 hours at room temperature for beads to settle. Receptor-bound radioactivity is quantified by counting WALLAC MICROBETA plate counter.
  • HERG Assay:
  • HEK 293 cells which stably express the HERG potassium channel are used for electrophysiological study. The methodology for stable transfection of this channel in HEK cells can be found elsewhere (Zhou et al., Biophys. J. 74:230-41, 1998). Before the day of experimentation, the cells are harvested from culture flasks and plated onto glass coverslips in a standard Minimum Essential Medium (MEM) medium with 10% Fetal Calf Serum (FCS). The plated cells are stored in an incubator at 37° C. maintained in an atmosphere of 95% O2/5% CO2. Cells are studied between 15-28 hrs after harvest.
  • HERG currents are studied using standard patch clamp techniques in the whole-cell mode. During the experiment the cells are superfused with a standard external solution of the following composition (mM); NaCl, 130; KCl, 4; CaCl2, 2; MgCl2, 1; Glucose, 10; HEPES, 5; pH 7.4 with NaOH. Whole-cell recordings are made using a patch clamp amplifier and patch pipettes which have a resistance of 1-3 MOhm when filled with the standard internal solution of the following composition (mho); KCl, 130; MgATP, 5; MgCl2, 1.0; HEPES, 10; EGTA 5, pH 7.2 with KOH. Only those cells with access resistances below 15 MOhm and seal resistances >1 GOhm are accepted for further experimentation. Series resistance compensation was applied up to a maximum of 80%. No leak subtraction is done. However, acceptable access resistance depended on the size of the recorded currents and the level of series resistance compensation that can safely be used. Following the achievement of whole cell configuration and sufficient time for cell dialysis with pipette solution (>5 min), a standard voltage protocol is applied to the cell to evoke membrane currents. The voltage protocol is as follows. The membrane is depolarized from a holding potential of −80 mV to +40 mV for 1000 ms. This was followed by a descending voltage ramp (rate 0.5 mV msec-1) back to the holding potential. The voltage protocol is applied to a cell continuously throughout the experiment every 4 seconds (0.25 Hz). The amplitude of the peak current elicited around −40 mV during the ramp is measured. Once stable evoked current responses are obtained in the external solution, vehicle (0.5% DMSO in the standard external solution) is applied for 10-20 min by a peristalic pump. Provided there were minimal changes in the amplitude of the evoked current response in the vehicle control condition, the test compound of either 0.3, 1, 3, or 10 mM is applied for a 10 min period. The 10 min period included the time which supplying solution was passing through the tube from solution reservoir to the recording chamber via the pump. Exposing time of cells to the compound solution was more than 5 min after the drug concentration in the chamber well reached the attempting concentration. There is a subsequent wash period of a 10-20 min to assess reversibility. Finally, the cells is exposed to high dose of dofetilide (5 mM), a specific IKr blocker, to evaluate the insensitive endogenous current.
  • All experiments are performed at room temperature (23±1° C.). Evoked membrane currents were recorded on-line on a computer, filtered at 500-1 KHz (Bessel −3 dB) and sampled at 1-2 KHz using the patch clamp amplifier and a specific data analyzing software. Peak current amplitude, which occurred at around −40 mV, is measured off line on the computer.
  • The arithmetic mean of the ten values of amplitude is calculated under vehicle control conditions and in the presence of drug. Percent decrease of IN in each experiment was obtained by the normalized current value using the following formula: IN=(1−ID/IC)×100, where ID is the mean current value in the presence of drug and IC is the mean current value under control conditions. Separate experiments are performed for each drug concentration or time-matched control, and arithmetic mean in each experiment is defined as the result of the study.
  • Half-Life in Human Liver Microsomes (HLM):
  • Test compounds (1 μM) are incubated with 3.3 mM MgCl2 and 0.78 mg/mL HLM (HL101) in 100 mM potassium phosphate buffer (pH 7.4) at 37° C. on the 96-deep well plate. The reaction mixture is split into two groups, a non-P450 and a P450 group. NADPH is only added to the reaction mixture of the P450 group. An aliquot of samples of P450 group is collected at 0, 10, 30, and 60 min time point, where 0 min time point indicated the time when NADPH was added into the reaction mixture of P450 group. An aliquot of samples of non-P450 group is collected at −10 and 65 min time point. Collected aliquots are extracted with acetonitrile solution containing an internal standard. The precipitated protein is spun down in centrifuge (2000 rpm, 15 min). The compound concentration in supernatant is measured by LC/MS/MS system. The half-life value is obtained by plotting the natural logarithm of the peak area ratio of compounds/internal standard versus time. The slope of the line of best fit through the points yields the rate of metabolism (k). This is converted to a half-life value using following equation:

  • Half-life=ln 2/k.
  • In Vivo Efficacy Assays
  • P2X3, P2X2/3 antagonists may be tested in various animal models of human diseases, including models of neuropathic, inflammatory, and visceral pain, and models of bladder function. P2X3 antagonists may be administered prior to or post-induction of the model depending upon the specific model and the compound PK characteristics. The route of administration may include intraperitoneal, (i.p.), subcutaneous (s.c.), oral (p.o.), intravenous (i.v.), intrathecal (i.t.), or intraplantar. The endpoints for these studies may include mechanical allodynia, thermal hyperalgesia, cold allodynia, decreased formalin-induced pain responses, decreased writhing and contractions or altered bladder mechanosensation as appropriate for the model as described below.
  • Formalin Model:
  • Test compounds are administered at various times prior to intraplantar administration of formalin. A dilute solution of formalin (25-50 μL of 1-2.5% formaldehyde/saline) is administered s.c. into the plantar surface of the left hind paw under light restraint. Immediately following injection, animals are placed on a mesh stand inside a clear observation chamber large enough to allow for free movement of the animals during the study. Behaviors are scored using manual scoring or automated scoring.
  • Manual scoring: Using a three channel timer, the observer records the time (t in seconds) of decreased weight-bearing (t1), paw lifting (t2), and licking/biting/shaking (t3). Results are weighted according to the method of Dubuisson and Dennis, Pain, 4:161-174, 1977, using the formula t1+2t2+3t3/180 where 180 s is the evaluation time for each increment. Behaviors are acquired in alternating 3 min increments starting at time=0 min (i.e. 0-3 min, 6-9 min etc.) and ending at 60 min.
  • Automated scoring: A small metal band weighing 0.5 g is placed on the left paw. Formalin is administered and the animal placed unrestrained inside an observation chamber over an electromagnetic detector system (Automated Nociception Analyzer, University of California, San Diego). The number of paw flinches is electronically recorded.
  • ATP and αβ-Methylene ATP (αβ meATP)-Induced Inflammatory Pain:
  • Rats are administered up to 1 μMol αβmeATP, ATP, adenosine, or PBS in a volume up to 100 μL subcutaneously into the dorsal surface of the hindpaw. Immediately after injection, animals are placed on a stand inside a clear observation chamber large enough to allow for free movement of the animals. The duration of flinching and licking are recorded over a 20 minute interval to evaluate nocifensive behavior. Responses are measured using the either the manual or automated methods described above for the Formalin test. Additional behavioral testing may include assessment of mechanical allodynia and thermal hyperalgesia. For testing, compounds are administered prior to agonist injection.
  • Complete Freund's Adjuvant Model (CFA):
  • Animals receive an s.c. injection of 100 μL complete Freund's adjuvant containing 100 μg Mycobacterium tuberculosis strain H37Ra into the plantar surface of the right hind paw under isoflurane anesthesia. Swelling and inflammation are visible within 1 h after administration. Nociceptive testing may begin 24 h post CFA administration. Compounds are generally administered 0.5-12 hrs before testing.
  • Carageenan Induced Acute Pain:
  • Animals receive a subcutaneous injection of 100 μL, of 2% carrageenan into the plantar surface of the right hind paw under isoflurane anesthesia. Swelling and inflammation are visible within 1 h after administration. Nociceptive testing may start 3-24 h post carageenan administration (Hargreaves et al., Pain, 32:77-88, 1988). Compounds are generally administered 0.5-12 hrs before testing.
  • Chronic Constriction Injury Model (CCI or Bennett model):
  • The CCI model is performed according to the method described by Bennett and Xie, Pain, 33:87-107, 1988. Briefly, under isoflurane anesthesia, the right sciatic nerve is exposed at mid-thigh level via blunt dissection through the biceps femoris. Proximal to the bifurcation of the sciatic nerve, about 7 mm of nerve is freed of adhering tissue and 4 loose ligatures of 4.0 chromic gut are tied around the nerve. Spacing between ligatures is approximately 1 mm. The wound is closed in layers, and the skin closed with staples or non-silk sutures. Sham operated animals are treated identically with the exception that the sciatic nerve will not be ligated. Nociceptive testing can be done 7-21 days post surgery. Compounds are generally administered 0.5-12 hrs before testing.
  • Spinal Nerve Transection (SNT or Chung model):
  • Under anesthesia, rats are placed in a prone position on a flat, sterile surface. A midline incision from L4-S2 is made and the left paraspinal muscles are separated from the spinous processes. The L5 and L6 spinal nerves are tightly ligated with a 4-0 silicon-treated silk suture, according to the method described by Kim and Chung, Pain, 50:355-363, 1992. The L4 spinal nerve is carefully preserved from being surgically injured. The skin is closed with wound clips and animals are returned to their home cages. Rats exhibiting prolonged postoperative neurological deficits or poor grooming are excluded from the experiments. The animals are assessed for nociceptive responses prior to surgery (baseline), then at various timepoints after administration of test compounds. Nociceptive testing can be done 7-21 days post surgery. Compounds are generally administered 0.5-12 hrs before testing.
  • Chemotherapy-Induced Painful Neuropathy:
  • Chemotherapy neuropathy is induced by i.p. administration of 1 mg/kg Taxol administered once/day on 4 alternating days (total dose=4 mg/kg) (Polomano et al., Pain, 94:293-304, 2001). Nociceptive testing can be done 9-30 days after the start of Taxol administration. Compounds are generally administered 0.5-12 hrs before testing.
  • Nociceptive Testing:
  • Mechanical Allodynia: Mechanical allodynia testing is performed using the up-down method of Dixon, Ann. Rev. Pharmacol. Toxicol. 20:441-462, 1980, modified for mechanical thresholds by Chaplan et al., J. Neurosci. Methods 53:55-63, 1994. To assess tactile allodynia, rats are placed in clear, plexiglass compartments with a wire mesh floor and allowed to habituate for a period of at least 15 minutes. After habituation, a series of von Frey monofilaments are presented to the plantar surface of the left (operated) foot of each rat. Each presentation lasts for a period of 4-8 seconds or until a nociceptive withdrawal behavior is observed. Flinching, paw withdrawal or licking of the paw are considered nociceptive behavioral responses. The 50% withdrawal threshold will be calculated using the method described by Chaplan et al., J. Neurosci. Methods 53:55-63, 1994
  • Thermal Hyperalgesia: Hind paw withdrawal latencies to a noxious thermal stimulus are determined using a plantar test apparatus (Ugo Basile) following the technique described by Hargreaves et al., Pain 32: 77-88, 1988. The radiant heat sourced is focused onto the plantar surface of the ipsilateral paw, and the paw withdrawal latency is determined. An increase latency of paw withdrawal demonstrates reversal of hyperalgesia.
  • Mechanical Hyperalgesia: The paw pressure assay can be used to assess mechanical hyperalgesia. For this assay, hind paw withdrawal thresholds (PWT) to a noxious mechanical stimulus are determined using an analgesymeter (Ugo Basile) as described in Stein et al., Pharmacol. Biochem. Behav. 31:451-455, 1988. The maximum weight that can be applied to the hind paw is set at 250 g and the end point is taken as complete withdrawal of the paw. PWT is determined once for each rat at each time point.
  • Cold allodynia: To measure cold allodynia, a drop of acetone is applied to the plantar surface of the paw through the underside of the grating on which the animals are standing using a 50 Hamilton syringe. The process is performed 5 times with a 3 min interval between each time. Vigorous shaking will be recorded as a positive response, and the time spent shaking is recorded. Alternatively, cold allodynia may be tested using the cold water bath method in which animals are placed into a cold water bath with water at a depth of 1.5-2.0 cm and at a temperature of 3-4 degrees centigrade and the number of paw lifts counted.
  • Colo-Rectal Distension (CRD):
  • Prior to induction of the model, animals are deprived of food but allowed access to water ad libitum for 16 h prior to the induction of the model. A 5 cm latex balloon is attached to a barostat system composed of a flow meter and pressure control program by a length of tubing. Under isoflurane anesthesia, the balloon is inserted into the distal colon via the anus at a distance of 5 cm from the anus and taped to the base of the tail. Post-anesthesia, the animal is placed unrestrained into a clean polypropylene cage and allowed to acclimate for 30 mins. The balloon is progressively inflated from 0-75 mmHg in 5 mm increments every 30 s. The colonic reaction threshold is defined as the pressure inducing the first abdominal contraction. Abdominal contraction indicative of visceral pain correlates with hunching, hump-backed position, licking of the lower abdomen, repeated waves of contraction of the ipsilateral oblique musculature with inward turning of the ipsilateral hindlimb, stretching, squashing of the lower abdomen against the floor (Wesselman, Neurosci. Lett., 246:73-76, 1998). Alternatively, electrodes may be placed into the external oblique musculature for eletromyographic recordings of abdominal contractions. In this case, EMG activity is quantified during colonic balloon inflation. Compounds are generally administered 0.5-12 hrs before testing.
  • Acetic Acid Writhing Test:
  • A 0.6% solution of acetic acid (10 ml/kg) is administered i.p. to rats and the number of abdominal constrictions within 30 min are counted. Compounds are generally administered 0.5-12 hrs before testing.
  • Bladder Afferent Nerve Recordings:
  • In order to determine the precise role of inhibition of P2X3 and P2X2/3 receptors in the micturition response, test compounds will be examined for their ability to modulate afferent signaling from the urinary bladder. Compounds are evaluated in the urinary bladder/pelvic nerve preparation described by Vlaskovska et al., J. Neuroscience, 21:5670-7, 2001, and Cockayne et al., J. Physiol. 567:621-39, 2005. Briefly, the whole urinary tract attached to the lower vertebrae and surrounding tissues is isolated en bloc and superfused in a recording chamber with oxygenated (5% CO2 and 95% O2) Krebs solution. The bladder is catheterized through the urethra for intraluminal infusion. A second double lumen catheter is inserted into the bladder to measure intraluminal pressure and to drain the bladder. After the bladder is prepared, the pelvic nerve exiting the vertebrae is dissected and impaled with a suction glass electrode. Nerve activity is measured using standard electrophysiological methods. Following a 60 min stabilization period, repeated ramp distensions are performed until the afferent response stabilizes. This stabilized afferent response was used for comparing mechanosensitivity of bladder afferents between different treatment groups.
  • Isovolumetric Bladder Contraction Assay:
  • Female Sprague dawley rats are anesthetized, tracheotomized, and cannulated in the carotid artery and femoral vein. The urinary bladder is accessed via an abdominal incision, and the ureters ligated and transected. For fluid infusion and pressure measurements, the urinary bladder is cannulated.
  • Post surgery, the bladder is infused with saline until stable volume-induced bladder contractions are elicited. Once stable threshold volumes and contraction frequencies are obtained, the animal is dosed with compound and contraction frequency is measured.
  • Refill and Cystitis Models of Bladder Function:
  • Animals are anaesthetized, and transurethral closed cystometry was conducted as previously described (Dmitrieva et al., Neuroscience 78:449-59, 1997; Cockayne et al., Nature 407:1011-5, 2000). The bladder is catheterized transurethrally with a PE-10 polypropylene catheter. Each cystometrogram consists of slowly filling the bladder with normal saline via the transurethral catheter, and then recording the pressure associated with filling via a pressure transducer. Contractions greater than a predetermined threshold value are interpreted as micturition contractions. For each cystometrogram, the volume at which active contractions occurred (micturition threshold) and the number of contractions per cystometrogram are recorded. The effects of compounds are then determined.
  • Cystometrograms may also be obtained in animals cystitis models in which bladders are irritated by injection of cyclophosphamide (150 mg/kg, i.p.) 24 hrs prior to cystometry, or by infusion of up to 1% acetic acid during cystometry.
  • The synthetic and biological examples described in this application are offered to illustrate the compounds, pharmaceutical compositions and methods provided herein and are not to be construed in any way as limiting their scope. In the examples, all temperatures are in degrees Celsius (unless otherwise indicated). Compounds that can be prepared in accordance with the methods provided herein along with their biological activity data are presented in the following Table. The syntheses of these representative compounds are carried out in accordance with the methods set forth above.
  • Exemplary Compounds Provided Herein
  • The following compounds have been or can be prepared according to the synthetic methods described herein. A calcium uptake assay was performed as described above and the activity of each compound is expressed as follows:
  • TABLE 1
    Ca Influx IC50 of Exemplary Compounds
    MW MW IC50 hP2X2/3H IC50 hP2X3
    ID Structure (Calcd) (Obs) (nM) (nM)
     1
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00099
    408.5  409.2  87.6  58.8
     2
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00100
    395.46 396.3  406.6  78.5
     3
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00101
    406.53 406.7
     4
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00102
    422.53 423.2 1062.0  305.6
     5
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00103
    428.48 428.8 8305.0 1960.0
     6
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00104
    410.49 411    417.6  341.6
     7
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00105
    422.53 423.2 9197.0 2456.0
     8
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00106
    422.53 423.2  115.8  182.4
     9
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00107
    452.55 453.2  415.4  483.8
    10
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00108
    452.55 453.2 1269.0  759.1
    11
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00109
    422.53 423.8 1062.0  484.9
    12
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00110
    424.5  424.9  291.0  291.6
    13
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00111
    423.51 424.2  12.9   9.0
    14
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00112
    477.48 478.2  171.9  317.9
    15
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00113
    411.48 412.2  54.9  73.2
    16
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00114
    425.49 426.2  268.7  95.6
    17
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00115
    418.5  419.2  24.5  21.6
    18
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00116
    423.51 424.3  70.9  53.5
    19
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00117
    394.48 395.4  238.0  61.4
    20
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00118
    394.48 395.4  70.5  38.5
    21
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00119
    393.49 394.2  913.6  192.4
    22
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00120
    393.49 394.2  142.6  191.1
    23
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00121
    435.57 435.8 4161.0  430.8
    24
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00122
    417.51 417.2  625.8
    25
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00123
    428.48 429.2
    26
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00124
    422.53 423.2  503.2  309.2
    27
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00125
    417.51 416.4  142.3  195.3
    28
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00126
    450.58 451.3  83.5  66.0
    29
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00127
    409.49 410.3  219.3  25.8
    30
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00128
    460.5  461.1
    31
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00129
    433.51 434.4  17.6  14.2
    32
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00130
    394.48 395.4  996.6  58.0
    33
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00131
    429.47 430.3  98.7  122.0
    34
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00132
    438.53 439.3  18.4  21.1
    35
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00133
    432.52 433.3  35.6  50.8
    36
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00134
    444.48 445.2  32.8  65.4
    37
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00135
    413.52 414.5  122.1  48.6
    38
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00136
    414.51 415.2  226.2  80.7
    39
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00137
    428.53 429.1  82.0  38.8
    40
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00138
    427.55 428    52.7  26.3
    41
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00139
    410.48 411.1  169.4  23.8
    42
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00140
    419.49 420.1  50.5  15.1
    43
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00141
    419.49 420.1  126.5  24.1
    44
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00142
    424.5  425.2  292.6  91.6
    45
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00143
    452.56 453.2  13.4  14.6
    46
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00144
    419.49 420.1   8.8   7.3
    47
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00145
    451.53 452.3  36.8  29.1
    48
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00146
    414.51 415.2  33.2  16.5
    49
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00147
    399.49 400.2  205.4  34.1
    50
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00148
    400.48 401.4  428.4  25.9
    51
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00149
    413.52 414.1  37.0  23.8
    52
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00150
    451.5  452.1  37.5  26.2
    53
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00151
    438.53 439.3  295.3  62.6
    54
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00152
    479.58 480.2  509.3  55.2
    55
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00153
    434.5  435.2  27.5  12.7
    56
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00154
    429.52 430.1  418.4  95.9
    57
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00155
    431.49 432.1  527.0  89.2
    58
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00156
    415.49 416.2  193.6  35.3
    59
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00157
    415.53 416.2  127.1  65.8
    60
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00158
    352.43 353.3 8681.0  206.8
    61
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00159
    414.51 415.4 2352.0  268.5
    62
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00160
    415.53 416.5  47.4  45.7
    63
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00161
    416.52 417.3  25.7  11.8
    64
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00162
    441.49 442.2  254.5  33.2
    65
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00163
    439.52 439.8 1063.0  117.4
    66
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00164
    440.5  441.2  728.6  85.8
    67
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00165
    453.54 454    667.4  101.5
    68
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00166
    429.53 429   1386.0  370.5
    69
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00167
    410.46 411.3
    70
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00168
    382.41 383.2  43.2
    71
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00169
    385.46 386.3  240.0  43.6
    72
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00170
    385.46 386.5  59.4
    73
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00171
    454.57 455.4  339.7  103.8
    74
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00172
    415.49 416.3 5582.0  138.1
    75
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00173
    413.52
    76
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00174
    385.46 386.4  77.7
    77
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00175
    451.51 452.1  372.9  99.5
    78
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00176
    412.43 413.2 7169.0  220.9
    79
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00177
    439.44 440.3  444.4  71.8
    80
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00178
    508.54 509.2  217.9  351.1
    81
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00179
    415.41 416.3 1224.0  48.7
    82
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00180
    376.45 377.2  33.2
    83
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00181
    501.52 502.3  26.0  72.1
    84
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00182
    372.43 373.2  850.0  10.3
    85
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00183
    406.43 407.2 1355.0  31.9
    86
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00184
    396.45 397.2  28.1   2.2
    87
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00185
    465.55 466.1  18.6  22.2
    88
    Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00186
    400.48 401.1   7.1
  • From the foregoing description, various modifications and changes in the compositions and methods provided herein will occur to those skilled in the art. All such modifications coming within the scope of the appended claims are intended to be included therein.
  • All publications, including but not limited to patents and patent applications, cited in this specification are herein incorporated by reference as if each individual publication were specifically and individually indicated to be incorporated by reference herein as though fully set forth.
  • At least some of the chemical names of compounds of the invention as given and set forth in this application, may have been generated on an automated basis by use of a commercially available chemical naming software program, and have not been independently verified. Representative programs performing this function include the Lexichem naming tool sold by Open Eye Software, Inc. and the Autonom Software tool sold by MDL, Inc. In the instance where the indicated chemical name and the depicted structure differ, the depicted structure will control.
  • Chemical structures shown herein were prepared using ISIS®/DRAW. Any open valency appearing on a carbon, oxygen or nitrogen atom in the structures herein indicates the presence of a hydrogen atom. Where a chiral center exists in a structure but no specific stereochemistry is shown for the chiral center, both enantiomers associated with the chiral structure are encompassed by the structure.

Claims (85)

1. A compound having a formula 1:
Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00187
wherein
each of A, B, and W are independently selected from CR4 and N; provided that not all A, B, and W are N at the same time;
X′ is selected from CR4a and N;
L is substituted or unsubstituted C1-C9 alkylene or C1-C9 heteroalkylene;
R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, aryl, and heteroaryl;
R3 is substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered aryl, or substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered heteroaryl; or
R3 is substituted or unsubstituted N containing heterocycloalkyl; and the heterocycloalkyl is attached to the core group via the N;
each R4 is independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, substituted or unsubstituted amino, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, nitro, and thiol;
each R4a, and R4b is independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyloxy, substituted or unsubstituted amino, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol; and subscript m′ is selected from 0-4;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
2. (canceled)
3. (canceled)
4. (canceled)
5. A compound according to claim 1, wherein the compound is according to formula 2:
Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00188
wherein
X′, L, R1, R3, R4a; R4b, and m′ are as in claim 1;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
6. (canceled)
7. (canceled)
8. (canceled)
9. A compound according formula 2a:
Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00189
wherein
X′ is selected from CR4a and N;
R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, aryl, and heteroaryl;
each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, haloalkyl, and halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms;
R3 is substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered aryl, or substituted or unsubstituted 6-10 membered heteroaryl; and when R3 is 6,5 fused bicyclic heteroaryl then R3 is joined to the core group via the 6 membered ring;
R3 is N containing heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo; and the heterocycloalkyl is attached to the core group via the N;
each R4a, and R4b is independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyloxy, substituted or unsubstituted amino, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol; and subscript m′ is selected from 0-4; and the subscript n2 is 0 or 1;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof;
provided that
a) when n2 is 0, R1 is other than Me; or
b) the compound is other than
i) 3,5-di(4-fluorophenyl)benzoic acid N-[1-methyl-2-[4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)piperazin-1-yl]ethyl]amide;
ii) 3,5-di(4-fluorophenyl)benzoic acid N-[1-methyl-2-(4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl)ethyl]amide;
iii) 3-(3-fluoro-2-pyridinyl)-N-[2-hydroxy-1-(3-methyl-1,2,4-oxadiazol-5-yl)propyl]-5-(5-methyl-2-pyridinyl)-benzamide;
iv) 3-(5-methyl-2-pyridinyl)-5-(1-piperidinyl)-N-[(1S)-1-(1H-1,2,4-triazol-5-yl)ethyl]-benzamide;
v) N-[(1R)-1-(3-fluoro-2-pyridinyl)ethyl]-3-(5-methyl-2-pyridinyl)-5-(1-piperidinyl)-benzamide;
vii) 5-(2,4-dioxo-1-imidazolidinyl)-2′-fluoro-4′-methyl-N-(1-methylethyl)-[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-carboxamide;
viii) N-(3,3-dimethylbutyl)-γ-hydroxy-α-methyl-δ-[[[5-(2-oxo-1-pyrrolidinyl) [1,1′-biphenyl]-3-yl]carbonyl]amino]-,(αR,δS,γS)-benzenehexanamide;
ix) 2-[[3′-[(2R)-2-[(dimethylamino)carbonyl]-1-pyrrolidinyl]-5′-[[[(1S)-1-[(dimethylamino)methyl]-2-phenylethyl]amino]carbonyl]-2-methoxy[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-yl]methyl]-4-[(1S)-1-hydroxyethyl]-5-(hydroxymethyl)-N-[(1S,2S,3S,5R)-2,6,6-trimethylbicyclo[3.1.1]hept-3-yl]-, (3S,4R,5R)-3-isoxazolidinecarboxamide; or
x) N-(3,3-dimethylbutyl)-γ-hydroxy-α-methyl-δ-[[[5-(2-oxo-1-pyrrolidinyl)[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-yl]carbonyl]amino]-(αR,δS,γS)-benzenehexanamide.
10. (canceled)
11. (canceled)
12. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R3 is substituted or unsubstituted phenyl, substituted or unsubstituted pyridyl, pyrazinyl or unsubstituted pyrimidinyl, substituted or unsubstituted quinolinol, isoquinolinyl, methylenedioxyphenyl, imidazopyridyl, benzoxazolyl, and indolyl.
13. (canceled)
14. (canceled)
15. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R3 is
Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00190
and wherein subscript n1 is selected from 1-5 and each R5a is independently selected from hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, aryloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, substituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, arylalkyloxy, substituted arylalkyloxy, amino, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol.
16. A compound according to claim 1, of formula 3, 4, or 5:
Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00191
wherein
X′ is selected from CR4a and N;
R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted aryl, and heteroaryl; or
R1 is substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl; or
R1 is selected from alkyl, and hydroxyalkyl; or
R1 is heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo;
each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, haloalkyl, and halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms;
each R4a, and R4b is independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyloxy, substituted or unsubstituted amino, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol; and subscript m′ is selected from 0-4;
each R5a is independently selected from hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, aryloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, substituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, arylalkyloxy, substituted arylalkyloxy, amino, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol; the subscript n1 is selected from 1-5; and the subscript n2 is 0 or 1;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof;
provided that
a) when n2 is 0, R1 is other than Me; or
b) the compound is other than
i) 3-(3-fluoro-2-pyridinyl)-N-[2-hydroxy-1-(3-methyl-1,2,4-oxadiazol-5-yl)propyl]-5-(5-methyl-2-pyridinyl)-benzamide.
17. (canceled)
18. (canceled)
19. A compound according to claim 16, wherein the compound is according to formula 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, or 11:
Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00192
Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00193
wherein
R1, R2a, R2b, R4a, R4b, R5a, n1 and n2 are as in claim 16;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
20. (canceled)
21. (canceled)
22. (canceled)
23. (canceled)
24. (canceled)
25. (canceled)
26. A compound according to claim 1, of formula 2a:
Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00194
wherein
X′ is selected from CR4a and N;
R1 is selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, aryl, and heteroaryl;
each of R2a and R2b is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C4 alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, alkylaminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, haloalkyl, and halo; or R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl ring of 3-7 atoms;
R3 is N containing heterocycloalkyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo; and the heterocycloalkyl is attached to the core group via the N;
each R4a, and R4b is independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyloxy, substituted or unsubstituted amino, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol; subscript m′ is selected from 0-4; and the subscript n2 is 0 or 1;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof;
provided that the compound is other than
i) 3-(5-methyl-2-pyridinyl)-5-(1-piperidinyl)-N-[(1S)-1-(1H-1,2,4-triazol-5-yl)ethyl]-benzamide;
ii) N-[(1R)-1-(3-fluoro-2-pyridinyl)ethyl]-3-(5-methyl-2-pyridinyl)-5-(1-piperidinyl)-benzamide;
iii) 5-(2,4-dioxo-1-imidazolidinyl)-2′-fluoro-4′-methyl-N-(1-methylethyl)-[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-carboxamide;
iv) N-(3,3-dimethylbutyl)-γ-hydroxy-α-methyl-δ-[[[5-(2-oxo-1-pyrrolidinyl)[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-yl]carbonyl]amino]-,(αR,δS,γS)-benzenehexanamide;
v) 2-[[3′-[(2R)-2-[(dimethylamino)carbonyl]-1-pyrrolidinyl]-5′-[[[(1S)-1-[(dimethylamino)methyl]-2-phenylethyl]amino]carbonyl]-2-methoxy[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-yl]methyl]-4-[(1S)-1-hydroxyethyl]-5-(hydroxymethyl)-N-[(1S,2S,3S,5R)-2,6,6-trimethylbicyclo[3.1.1]hept-3-yl]-,(3S,4R,5R)-3-isoxazolidinecarboxamide; or
vi) N-(3,3-dimethylbutyl)-γ-hydroxy-α-methyl-δ-[[[5-(2-oxo-1-pyrrolidinyl)[1,1′-biphenyl]-3-yl]carbonyl]amino]-(αR,δS,γS)-benzenehexanamide.
27. (canceled)
28. (canceled)
29. (canceled)
30. (canceled)
31. (canceled)
32. (canceled)
33. A compound according to claim 26, wherein the compound is according to formula 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, or 23:
Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00195
Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00196
wherein
X′, R1, R2a, R2b, R4b; and n2 are as in claim 26; and R3a is hydrogen, or substituted or unsubstituted alkyl;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
34. (canceled)
35. (canceled)
36. (canceled)
37. (canceled)
38. (canceled)
39. (canceled)
40. (canceled)
41. A compound according to claim 16, wherein
each of R2a and R2b is hydrogen; or
one of R2a and R2b is methyl, hydroxymethyl or hydroxyethyl; or
each of R2a and R2b is methyl; or
R2a and R2b join together to form a cycloalkyl ring.
42. (canceled)
43. (canceled)
44. (canceled)
45. (canceled)
46. (canceled)
47. (canceled)
48. (canceled)
49. (canceled)
50. (canceled)
51. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R1 is selected from unsubstituted pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl.
52. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, unsubstituted or substituted with one or more groups selected from alkyl, halo, haloalkyl, alkoxyalkyl, aminoalkyl, dialkylaminoalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, and oxo.
53. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R1 is selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperazinyl, and azepinyl, substituted with oxo.
54. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R1 is selected from morpholinyl, and 1,1-dioxo-thiomorpholinyl.
55. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R1 is Et, i-Pr, or t-Bu.
56. (canceled)
57. (canceled)
58. (canceled)
59. (canceled)
60. (canceled)
61. A compound according to claim 1, wherein R1 is
Figure US20110237578A1-20110929-C00197
and wherein subscript n3 is selected from 1-5 and each R5b is independently selected from hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted acyl, substituted or unsubstituted acylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkylamino, substituted or unsubstituted alkythio, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxy, aryloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, substituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylarylamino, arylalkyloxy, substituted arylalkyloxy, amino, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, sulfo, substituted sulfo, substituted sulfinyl, substituted sulfonyl, substituted sulfanyl, substituted or unsubstituted aminosulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkylsulfonyl, substituted or unsubstituted arylsulfonyl, azido, substituted or unsubstituted carbamoyl, carboxyl, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted dialkylamino, halo, heteroaryloxy, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, hydroxy, nitro, and thiol.
62. (canceled)
63. (canceled)
64. (canceled)
65. (canceled)
66. (canceled)
67. (canceled)
68. A compound according to claim 1, selected from compounds exemplified in Table 1; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, prodrug, stereoisomer, tautomer or isotopic variant thereof.
69. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier and a pharmaceutically effective amount of a compound of claim 1.
70. (canceled)
71. (canceled)
72. (canceled)
73. A method for preventing or treating in a mammal in need thereof a disease or condition which comprises administering to the mammal an effective disease-treating or condition-treating amount of a compound according to claim 1.
74. (canceled)
75. (canceled)
76. (canceled)
77. (canceled)
78. (canceled)
79. (canceled)
80. (canceled)
81. (canceled)
82. (canceled)
83. A method of treating a mammal suffering from at least one symptom selected from the group consisting of symptoms of exposure to capsaicin, symptoms of burns or irritation due to exposure to heat, symptoms of burns or irritation due to exposure to light, symptoms of burns, bronchoconstriction or irritation due to exposure to tear gas, and symptoms of burns or irritation due to exposure to acid, which comprises administering to the mammal an effective symptom-treating amount of a compound according to claim 1.
84. (canceled)
85. The method of claim 73, wherein the disease or condition is selected from: pain including acute, inflammatory and neuropathic pain, chronic pain, dental pain and headache including migraine, cluster headache and tension headache, Parkinson's disease, Alzheimer's disease and multiple sclerosis; diseases and disorders which are mediated by or result in neuroinflammation, encephalitis; centrally-mediated neuropsychiatric diseases and disorders, depression mania, bipolar disease, anxiety, schizophrenia, eating disorders, sleep disorders and cognition disorders; neurological and neurodegenerative diseases and disorders; epilepsy and seizure disorders; prostate, bladder and bowel dysfunction, urinary incontinence, urinary hesitancy, rectal hypersensitivity, fecal incontinence, benign prostatic hypertrophy and inflammatory bowel disease; respiratory and airway disease and disorders, allergic rhinitis, asthma and reactive airway disease and chronic obstructive pulmonary disease; diseases and disorders which are mediated by or result in inflammation, arthritis, rheumatoid arthritis and osteoarthritis, myocardial infarction, autoimmune diseases and disorders, itch/pruritus, psoriasis; obesity; lipid disorders; cancer; and renal disorders.
US13/119,947 2008-09-18 2009-09-14 Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof Abandoned US20110237578A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US13/119,947 US20110237578A1 (en) 2008-09-18 2009-09-14 Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof

Applications Claiming Priority (5)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US19258108P 2008-09-18 2008-09-18
US11822808P 2008-11-26 2008-11-26
US18091509P 2009-05-25 2009-05-25
US13/119,947 US20110237578A1 (en) 2008-09-18 2009-09-14 Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof
PCT/US2009/005119 WO2010033168A2 (en) 2008-09-18 2009-09-14 Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US2009/005119 A-371-Of-International WO2010033168A2 (en) 2008-09-18 2009-09-14 Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US14/327,442 Division US9133122B2 (en) 2008-09-18 2014-07-09 Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20110237578A1 true US20110237578A1 (en) 2011-09-29

Family

ID=41328566

Family Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US13/119,947 Abandoned US20110237578A1 (en) 2008-09-18 2009-09-14 Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof
US14/327,442 Expired - Fee Related US9133122B2 (en) 2008-09-18 2014-07-09 Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof

Family Applications After (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US14/327,442 Expired - Fee Related US9133122B2 (en) 2008-09-18 2014-07-09 Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof

Country Status (5)

Country Link
US (2) US20110237578A1 (en)
EP (1) EP2346825A2 (en)
JP (1) JP5608655B2 (en)
CA (1) CA2737038A1 (en)
WO (1) WO2010033168A2 (en)

Cited By (6)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2015161011A1 (en) * 2014-04-17 2015-10-22 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Benzamide cgrp receptor antagonists
US9550763B2 (en) 2012-02-09 2017-01-24 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Heterocyclic ring and carbocyclic derivative
US9688643B2 (en) 2009-02-13 2017-06-27 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Triazine derivative and pharmaceutical composition comprising the same
US9718790B2 (en) 2010-08-10 2017-08-01 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Triazine derivative and pharmaceutical composition having an analgesic activity comprising the same
US9732060B2 (en) 2013-06-14 2017-08-15 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Aminotriazine derivative and pharmaceutical composition comprising the same
CN115397813A (en) * 2020-04-16 2022-11-25 豪夫迈·罗氏有限公司 Biphenyl derivatives

Families Citing this family (24)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2009110985A2 (en) * 2008-02-29 2009-09-11 Renovis, Inc. Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof
CN102438989B (en) * 2009-06-22 2015-05-27 霍夫曼-拉罗奇有限公司 Novel oxazolone and pyrrolidinone-substituted arylamides
WO2016084922A1 (en) * 2014-11-28 2016-06-02 塩野義製薬株式会社 1,2,4-triazine derivative and pharmaceutical composition thereof
KR20230098368A (en) 2014-12-09 2023-07-03 바이엘 악티엔게젤샤프트 1,3-thiazol-2-yl substituted benzamides
US10183937B2 (en) 2014-12-09 2019-01-22 Bayer Aktiengesellschaft 1,3-thiazol-2-yl substituted benzamides
JP6518789B2 (en) 2015-04-23 2019-05-22 エフ.ホフマン−ラ ロシュ アーゲーF. Hoffmann−La Roche Aktiengesellschaft Tetrazole derivative for use in the treatment of mental disorders
CN107709311B (en) * 2015-07-14 2020-09-25 豪夫迈·罗氏有限公司 2-phenyl-6-imidazolyl-pyridine-4-carboxamide derivatives and their use as EAAT3 inhibitors
WO2017025523A1 (en) * 2015-08-12 2017-02-16 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Pyridine and pyrimidine derivatives
EP3359537B1 (en) * 2015-10-06 2020-03-25 H. Hoffnabb-La Roche Ag Triazole derivatives
WO2018069362A1 (en) 2016-10-14 2018-04-19 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Imidazole compounds as eaat3 inhibitors
JP7323179B2 (en) 2017-03-10 2023-08-08 ラトガーズ, ザ ステイト ユニバーシティ オブ ニュー ジャージー Indole derivatives as efflux pump inhibitors
US11938114B2 (en) 2017-03-10 2024-03-26 Rutgers, The State University Of New Jersey Bacterial efflux pump inhibitors
WO2018165612A1 (en) 2017-03-10 2018-09-13 Rutgers, The State University Of New Jersey Bacterial efflux pump inhibitors
CN111163774A (en) 2017-05-26 2020-05-15 罗格斯新泽西州立大学 Bacterial efflux pump inhibitors
WO2019005841A1 (en) * 2017-06-26 2019-01-03 Rutgers, The State University Of New Jersey Therapeutic compounds and methods to treat infection
IL277071B2 (en) 2018-03-08 2024-07-01 Incyte Corp AMINOPYRAZINE DIOL COMPOUNDS AS PI3K-y INHIBITORS
US11046658B2 (en) 2018-07-02 2021-06-29 Incyte Corporation Aminopyrazine derivatives as PI3K-γ inhibitors
MX2021003987A (en) * 2018-10-10 2021-06-23 Bellus Health Cough Inc Treatment of pruritus with p2x3 antagonists.
CN111377970B (en) * 2018-12-28 2022-12-23 广东阿格蕾雅光电材料有限公司 Preparation and application of N 'C' N type tetradentate platinum (II) complex
CA3139019A1 (en) 2019-05-31 2020-12-03 Chiesi Farmaceutici S.P.A. Amino quinazoline derivatives as p2x3 inhibitors
CA3136024A1 (en) 2019-05-31 2020-12-03 Chiesi Farmaceutici S.P.A. Pyridopyrimidines derivatives as p2x3 inhibitors
EP4251620A1 (en) 2020-11-27 2023-10-04 Chiesi Farmaceutici S.p.A. Amino quinazoline derivatives as p2x3 inhibitors
JP2023550830A (en) 2020-11-27 2023-12-05 キエシ・フアルマチエウテイチ・ソチエタ・ペル・アチオニ (Aza)quinoline 4-amine derivatives as P2X3 inhibitors
WO2022112493A1 (en) 2020-11-27 2022-06-02 Chiesi Farmaceutici S.P.A. Phthalazine derivatives as p2x3 inhibitors

Citations (6)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US2731469A (en) * 1953-10-23 1956-01-17 Searle & Co N-dialkylaminoalkyl derivatives of diarylisonicotinamides
US4916145A (en) * 1987-07-10 1990-04-10 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Substituted n-[(pyridyl)alkyl]aryl-carboxamide
US7491821B2 (en) * 2005-08-15 2009-02-17 Roche Palo Alto Llc Inhibitors of P2X3
US20100168070A1 (en) * 2005-08-11 2010-07-01 Niklas Heine Compounds for the treatment of alzheimer's disease
US7838676B2 (en) * 2005-11-21 2010-11-23 Amgen Inc. Beta-secretase modulators and methods of use
US8247401B2 (en) * 2007-10-31 2012-08-21 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. P2X3 receptor antagonists for treatment of pain

Family Cites Families (34)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JPS6413083A (en) * 1987-07-07 1989-01-17 Akishiro Nakamura Streptonigrin derivative and medicinal composition
GB9600063D0 (en) 1996-01-03 1996-03-06 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co Guaridine derivatives
US6037324A (en) * 1996-01-04 2000-03-14 Leukosite, Inc. Inhibitors of MAdCAM-1-mediated interactions and methods of use therefor
AU2001294557A1 (en) 2000-09-11 2002-03-26 Merck And Co., Inc. Thrombin inhibitors
WO2002070469A2 (en) 2001-03-05 2002-09-12 Icos Corporation Selective pde3b inhibitors and use of the same in therapy
WO2002094767A2 (en) 2001-05-18 2002-11-28 Abbott Laboratories Trisubstituted-n-[(1s)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-1-naphthalenyl] benzamides which inhibit p2x3 and p2x2/3 containing receptors
US20090286791A1 (en) * 2001-11-27 2009-11-19 Takeda Pharmaceutical Company Limited Amide Compounds
TW200304374A (en) 2001-11-30 2003-10-01 Smithkline Beecham Plc Novel compounds
CA2484011A1 (en) * 2002-05-14 2003-11-27 Axys Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Cysteine protease inhibitors
AU2003298740A1 (en) * 2002-12-05 2004-06-30 Axys Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Cyanomethyl derivatives as cysteine protease inhibitors
WO2005032471A2 (en) 2003-10-03 2005-04-14 Merck & Co., Inc. Benzylether and benzylamino beta-secretase inhibitors for the treatment of alzheimer's disease
US20050282824A1 (en) * 2004-05-07 2005-12-22 Xiaobing Li Substituted pyrimidines as inhibitors of bacterial type III protein secretion systems
CN1964940A (en) 2004-05-13 2007-05-16 默克公司 Phenyl carboxamide compounds useful as beta-secretase inhibitors for the treatment of alzheimer's disease
TW200640877A (en) * 2005-04-28 2006-12-01 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd Pyrimidine derivatives
WO2007017511A2 (en) 2005-08-11 2007-02-15 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Compounds for treating alzheimer's disease
CA2652109A1 (en) 2006-04-10 2007-10-18 Painceptor Pharma Corporation Compositions and methods for modulating gated ion channels
AU2007263809B2 (en) 2006-06-29 2013-07-18 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Tetrazole-substituted arylamides
MX2009002046A (en) * 2006-08-24 2009-03-06 Astrazeneca Ab Morpholino pyrimidine derivatives useful in the treatment of proliferative disorders.
AR063258A1 (en) * 2006-10-13 2009-01-14 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd DERIVATIVES OF 2-AMINOCARBONIL-PYRIDINE, A PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION THAT CONTAINS THEM AND ITS USE IN THE PREPARATION OF A MEDICINAL PRODUCT FOR THE TREATMENT OF OCLUSIVE VASCULAR DISORDERS.
BRPI0718714B8 (en) * 2006-11-09 2021-05-25 Hoffmann La Roche thiazole and oxazole substituted arylamides, their use and pharmaceutical composition comprising them
WO2008119773A1 (en) 2007-03-30 2008-10-09 Medivir Ab Amide derivatives as inhibitors of aspartyl proteases
ES2553412T3 (en) 2007-10-31 2015-12-09 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. P2X3 receptor antagonists for pain management
CN101903355B (en) 2007-12-17 2014-05-14 霍夫曼-拉罗奇有限公司 Imidazole-substituted arylamides
US7989454B2 (en) 2007-12-17 2011-08-02 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Leukotriene B4 inhibitors
ES2541662T3 (en) 2007-12-17 2015-07-23 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Ariamide derivatives substituted with triazole and use thereof as antagonists of purinergic receptors P2X3 and / or P2X2 / 3
AU2008337665B2 (en) 2007-12-17 2014-01-16 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Tetrazole-substituted arylamide derivatives and their use as P2x3 and/or P2x2/3 purinergic receptor antagonists
EP2234976B1 (en) 2007-12-17 2013-04-10 F. Hoffmann-La Roche AG Novel pyrazole-substituted arylamides
WO2010051188A1 (en) 2008-10-31 2010-05-06 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. P2x3, receptor antagonists for treatment of pain
SG172190A1 (en) 2008-12-16 2011-07-28 Hoffmann La Roche Thiadiazole-substituted arylamides
CA2755768A1 (en) 2009-03-23 2010-09-30 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. P2x3, receptor antagonists for treatment of pain
US8946231B2 (en) 2009-03-23 2015-02-03 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. P2X3, receptor antagonists for treatment of pain
EP2410857B1 (en) 2009-03-23 2014-01-29 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. P2x3, receptor antagonists for treatment of pain
CA2764956A1 (en) 2009-06-22 2010-12-29 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Novel biphenyl and phenyl-pyridine amides
CN102438989B (en) 2009-06-22 2015-05-27 霍夫曼-拉罗奇有限公司 Novel oxazolone and pyrrolidinone-substituted arylamides

Patent Citations (6)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US2731469A (en) * 1953-10-23 1956-01-17 Searle & Co N-dialkylaminoalkyl derivatives of diarylisonicotinamides
US4916145A (en) * 1987-07-10 1990-04-10 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Substituted n-[(pyridyl)alkyl]aryl-carboxamide
US20100168070A1 (en) * 2005-08-11 2010-07-01 Niklas Heine Compounds for the treatment of alzheimer's disease
US7491821B2 (en) * 2005-08-15 2009-02-17 Roche Palo Alto Llc Inhibitors of P2X3
US7838676B2 (en) * 2005-11-21 2010-11-23 Amgen Inc. Beta-secretase modulators and methods of use
US8247401B2 (en) * 2007-10-31 2012-08-21 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. P2X3 receptor antagonists for treatment of pain

Non-Patent Citations (12)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
Banker, G.S. et al, "Modern Pharmaceutices, 3ed.", Marcel Dekker, New York. 1996, pages 451 and 596. *
Baraldi et al., European Journal of Medicinal Chemistry 38: 367-382, 2003. *
Cecil Textbook of Medicine, edited by Bennet, J.C., and Plum F., 20th edition,Volume 1, 1004-101 O, 1996. *
Dermer et al., Bio/Technology, 1994, 12:320. *
Freshney et al.,Culture of Animal Cells, A Manual of Basic Technique, Alan R. Liss, Inc., 1983, New York, p4. *
Gao et al., Expert. Opin. Emerging Drugs 12(3): 479-492, 2008. *
Gever et al., British Journal of Pharmacology (2010), 160, 1387-1398. *
Golub et al., Science, 286, 531-537, 1999. *
Hulikal, V. Deuterium Labeled Compounds in Drug Discovery Process, 2010. Abstract provided-see alsowww. hwb.gov.in/htmldocs/nahwd201 O/L15.pdf *
Pimlott SL., Nucl. Med. Commun. 26(3): 183-188, 2005 (PubMed Abstract provided). *
Sitkovsky et al., British Journal of Pharmacology, 153, 5457-5464, 2008. *
Wolff Manfred E. "Burger's Medicinal Chemistry, 5ed, Part 1", John Wiley & Sons, 1995, pages 975-977. *

Cited By (7)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US9688643B2 (en) 2009-02-13 2017-06-27 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Triazine derivative and pharmaceutical composition comprising the same
US9718790B2 (en) 2010-08-10 2017-08-01 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Triazine derivative and pharmaceutical composition having an analgesic activity comprising the same
US9550763B2 (en) 2012-02-09 2017-01-24 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Heterocyclic ring and carbocyclic derivative
US9732060B2 (en) 2013-06-14 2017-08-15 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Aminotriazine derivative and pharmaceutical composition comprising the same
US10065941B2 (en) 2013-06-14 2018-09-04 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Aminotriazine derivative and pharmaceutical composition comprising the same
WO2015161011A1 (en) * 2014-04-17 2015-10-22 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Benzamide cgrp receptor antagonists
CN115397813A (en) * 2020-04-16 2022-11-25 豪夫迈·罗氏有限公司 Biphenyl derivatives

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
JP5608655B2 (en) 2014-10-15
CA2737038A1 (en) 2010-03-25
US9133122B2 (en) 2015-09-15
JP2012502986A (en) 2012-02-02
WO2010033168A2 (en) 2010-03-25
EP2346825A2 (en) 2011-07-27
WO2010033168A3 (en) 2010-11-18
US20140323532A1 (en) 2014-10-30

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US9133122B2 (en) Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof
US8946439B2 (en) Amide compounds, compositions and uses thereof
US8076345B2 (en) 2-cyanophenyl-7,8-dihydro-5H-pyrido[4,3-d]pyrimidine compounds, compositions and uses thereof
US7338950B2 (en) Amide compounds as ion channel ligands and uses thereof
US7745451B2 (en) Tetrahydronaphthyridine and tetrahydropyrido[4,3-d]pyrimidine compounds and compositions thereof useful in the treatment of conditions associated with neurological and inflammatory disorders and dysfunctions
US8653091B2 (en) Pyrid-2yl fused heterocyclic compounds, and compositions and uses thereof
US20080312237A1 (en) Amide derivatives as ion-channel ligands and pharmaceutical compositions and methods of using the same
JP2009538358A (en) Oxazolyl piperidine modulator of fatty acid amide hydrolase
JP2024501641A (en) Substituted Macrocycles and Related Treatment Methods
WO2023057414A1 (en) Certain octahydrofuro[3,4- b]pyrazines as glp-1 receptor modulators
JP2008544982A (en) Thiophene-2-carboxamide derivatives as alpha 7 nicotinic receptor modulators
EA041031B1 (en) DEUTERATED PYRIDONAMIDES AND THEIR PRODRUGS AS SODIUM CHANNELS MODULATORS

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AS Assignment

Owner name: EVOTEC AG, GERMANY

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:WEI, ZHI-LIANG;GOWLUGARI, SUMITHRA;KAUB, CARL;AND OTHERS;SIGNING DATES FROM 20110414 TO 20110421;REEL/FRAME:026467/0213

STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION